HP Hewlett Packard Tablet FB359UA User Manual

U S E R G U I D E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
47 Copy files between your device and your  
48 Overview: Get your personal data onto your  
25 Create a new item such as a message, calendar  
Contents  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
166 Bluetooth® wireless technology  
4
Contents  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6
Contents  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1 Welcome  
Seamless interoperability with many HP webOS smartphones, including  
call management directly from your HP TouchPad.  
Your HP TouchPad puts HP webOS—a multitasking, gesture-based  
operating system—inside a thin, beautiful device with a virtual keyboard  
that you can bring up whenever you need it. Here are a few highlights of  
your new device.  
Your HP TouchPad  
Gestures: On your HP TouchPad, you move around and manage your  
applications and info by making simple gestures on the touchscreen. For  
more information, see Use gestures: Tap, swipe, drag, flick, pinch. Carry  
the Navigation Guide (included in the box with your HP TouchPad)  
around with you and you’ll soon know the most important gestures by  
heart.  
NOTE When referring to the company that makes your HP TouchPad, this  
document uses both the terms HP and Palm. HP and Palm are the same  
company; the use of both terms reflects company terminology.  
In one compact and indispensable device, you now have all of the  
following:  
Multitasking: You can have many applications open at once and easily  
move among them. Go to the Launcher to open apps. See the lineup of  
your open apps in Card view. Tap an app to bring it into the foreground  
and work with it. For more information, see Open applications.  
An advanced wireless device running the HP webOS platform  
A large 9.7 inch (246.3mm) screen for easy, full-color viewing of photos  
and videos, web pages, email messages, and more  
A full suite of organizer applications, including Contacts, Calendar,  
and Memos  
Wi-Fi capability  
A front-facing camera for video calling  
GPS functionality  
Just Type: Need to look up Ed’s work number? Just go to Card view, tap  
Just type, and type ed. If he’s listed in your Contacts, you can get his  
numbers from the search results. Just Type works just as fast when you  
need to search the web, find info in an application on your device, start  
an action such as creating an email message or memo, or update your  
status on social networking sites such as Facebook or Twitter. For more  
information, see Just Type.  
Applications to view and manage Microsoft Office and Adobe PDF files  
HP webOS App Catalog, from which you can download applications  
designed for your device; select from an ever-expanding list of  
applications  
The HP Synergy feature: The HP Synergy feature works in the background  
to gather your information from the various online sources where you keep  
it and then display that information in a single view on your device. You  
can access your info quickly without having to remember where you  
stored it.  
Chapter 1 : Welcome  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
For example, suppose you have a Google account for personal email,  
contacts, and calendar events, and an Exchange account for your  
corporate email, contacts, and events. The Email, Contacts, and Calendar  
applications on your HP TouchPad all provide a view in which you can  
see information from both of those accounts in one place—but even  
though the information is brought into one view, the sources of that  
information are kept separate. For more information, read about linked  
contacts, layered calendars, and the single inbox for your email in  
What’s in the box?  
All of the following items are included in the device box.  
Hardware  
NOTE See Online accounts available for webOS devices for the current list of  
online accounts that you can set up on your device and for information about  
the behavior of these accounts.  
Sync: Your HP TouchPad gives you synchronization without a cable. You  
can sync with online services so that you can store and sync your info in  
online accounts. For more information, see Get data from an online  
Your HP webOS Account: When you set up your device, you create an HP  
webOS Account by entering a valid email address. Use this account to  
create and store contacts and calendar events. Your HP webOS Account  
also gives you access to services like automatic updates and automatic,  
frequent backups of any of your info that is stored only on your device  
and isn’t synchronized with an online account (see What information is  
HP TouchPad  
USB cable (charging and data transfer cable)  
AC charger  
Screen cleaning cloth  
Standard lithium-ion battery (installed and nonremovable)  
Touch to Share: If you have a web page open on your HP TouchPad or on  
a webOS smartphone, simply touch the devices to transfer the page from  
one device to the other. If your smartphone and your HP TouchPad use the  
same HP webOS Account, you can also touch the two to create a  
Bluetooth pairing between them. After the devices are paired, not only  
can you touch to share web pages, but you can also make and receive  
calls, and send and receive text messages, right on your HP TouchPad  
(see Touch to Share).  
DID YOU KNOW? The USB cable included with your device is used both to  
charge your device battery (see Charge the battery) and to connect your device  
to your computer as a removable USB drive (see Copy files between your device  
and your computer). To simplify charging, you can purchase an HP Touchstone  
(sold separately).  
WARNING Please refer to Important safety and legal information for  
information that helps you safely use your device. Failure to read and follow the  
important safety information in this guide may result in property damage,  
serious bodily injury, or death.  
8
Chapter 1 : Welcome  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
To view Help topics for a single application: Open the  
application, open the application menu, and tap Help. Here is an  
example from the Web app:  
Print material  
Getting Started guide  
Navigation Guide  
Limited Warranty  
General User Guide: Important Safety and Legal Information  
Where can I learn more?  
On-device Help: Read short how-tos and watch animations on your new  
device.  
To view all Help: Open Help  
.
Tools available from online support: Visit hpwebos.com/support to  
access the 200+ page User Guide (this guide) detailing every facet of  
your device. On the support site you can also edit your HP webOS  
Account settings and watch how-to animations.  
TIP If you’re at a computer, we recommend using the User Guide to get  
information about your device. If you’re working on your HP TouchPad, use the  
on-device Help.  
Peer-to-peer support: Visit forums.hpwebos.com to share your  
experiences and get help and advice from fellow customers.  
Self-paced learning guides: Visit learning.hpwebos.com to take a free  
online tutorial about your new device. Available in English only.  
Chapter 1 : Welcome  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
10  
Chapter 1 : Welcome  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 Basics  
Get to know your device  
Front view  
1 Stereo speakers  
2 Front-facing camera  
3 Volume  
4 Touchscreen: Tap and make other gestures directly on the screen. See Touchscreen.  
5 Center: Press to display Card view. see Manage applications in Card view.  
6 Charger/microUSB connector: Connect the small end of the USB cable to charge your  
device battery (see Charge the battery) or copy files (see Copy files between your device  
Chapter 2 : Basics  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
3 Quick Launch: Bar containing up to five icons for the apps you use most, plus an icon to  
open the Launcher. You can customize the apps that appear in Quick Launch. See Open  
NOTE The volume you set for each individual audio component is saved  
automatically, whether the audio component is a wired headset, a wireless  
headset that uses Bluetooth® wireless technology, the built-in stereo speakers,  
and so on. When you return to using an audio component, the audio plays at  
the volume you left it the last time you used that component.  
The Launcher  
Touchscreen  
TIP Be careful not to scratch, crush, or apply too much pressure on the  
touchscreen. Do not store your device in a place where other items might  
damage it. Do not use harsh chemicals, cleaning solvents, or aerosols to clean  
the device or its accessories. Do not expose your device to extreme heat or cold  
(see Specifications for temperature info).  
Card view  
1 Application name: Displays the name of the currently open application. Drag down over  
or tap the app name to open the application menu.  
2 Page name: Tap a name to jump to a different page.  
4 Quick Launch: Bar containing up to five icons for the apps you use most, plus an icon to  
open the Launcher. You can customize the apps that appear in Quick Launch. See Open  
5 System icons: Show the status of wireless service connections, battery strength, and other  
system functions (see Icons in the title bar). Drag down over or tap the icons to open the  
6 Notification icons: Show new email messages, alarms, and more. Drag down over or tap  
the icons to view notification details. See View and work with notifications.  
1 Just Type field: Tap here and then type some text to look for, create, or use information on  
your device, without needing to go to a specific app. See Just Type.  
2 Wallpaper: The background image in Card view. You can customize your wallpaper. See  
12  
Chapter 2 : Basics  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Icons in the title bar  
Top view  
Table 1. Title bar icons and descriptions  
Item  
Description  
The battery is being charged.  
1 3.5mm headset jack  
The battery is fully charged.  
2 Power: Press to wake up or turn off the screen. Press and hold to turn wireless services on  
and off or turn your device completely on and off.  
3 Microphone  
The battery is low. See Charge the battery.  
Airplane mode is turned on. This means that the Wi-Fi,  
VPN, and Bluetooth® wireless technology features are off.  
Charge the battery  
Wi-Fi is turned on. The number of filled-in bars denotes  
signal strength. See Wi-Fi.  
When the battery is very low, the battery  
of the screen changes to red. When the battery is fully charged, the icon  
appears full and changes to green  
icon in the upper-right corner  
The device is searching for a Wi-Fi network.  
Bluetooth® wireless technology is turned on. See  
.
Before you begin the setup process, we recommend that you charge your  
A Bluetooth connection is in progress.  
A Bluetooth connection has been made.  
device until the battery  
icon in the upper-right corner of the screen is  
full to ensure that the battery is fully charged.  
Your device is performing a search on the characters you  
entered. If you accessed Just Type from Card view, your  
device conducts a global search on your device (see Just  
Type). If you are in an application such as Contacts or  
Memos, your device searches for items within the app that  
match the search term you entered.  
WARNING Use only chargers that are approved by HP with your device.  
Failure to use a charger approved by HP may increase the risk that your device  
will overheat, catch fire, or explode, resulting in property damage, serious  
bodily injury, or death. Use of unapproved third-party power supply accessories  
may damage the device and void the Limited Warranty for the product.  
Rotation lock is turned on (see Use the system menu).  
System sounds are turned off (see Use the system menu).  
WARNING Never remove the back cover of your HP TouchPad. The battery is  
built in to your device and is not removable.  
See Maximizing battery life for tips on making your battery’s power last  
longer.  
Chapter 2 : Basics  
13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
1
Attach the small end of the USB cable to the charger/microUSB  
connector. The silver circle on the cable faces the front of the device.  
Shut down the device completely when you won’t be using it for an  
extended period of time (see Shut down your device).  
TIP If you think that the battery needs to be replaced, see I need to replace the  
battery for instructions.  
Set up your device  
BEFORE YOU BEGIN Make sure the battery is fully charged (see Charge the  
2
3
Connect the other end of the USB cable to the AC charger.  
Plug the AC charger into a working outlet.  
battery).  
1
Press and hold the power button on the upper-right corner of your  
device until you see a logo on the screen (approximately five  
seconds).  
Maximizing battery life  
2
Follow the onscreen instructions to complete setup. If you need to  
start setup over, tap Start Over in the lower-left corner of any screen.  
The battery in your device cannot be removed.  
Battery life depends on how you use your device. You can maximize the  
life of your battery by following a few easy guidelines:  
NOTE At the beginning of setup, you select a language for your device. This  
language sets the default formats for currency, date and time, and so on. If your  
country is not displayed, or you want to use a different format, complete setup  
and then do the following: Open Regional Settings. Tap Formats and select  
your region. For more information, see Change the display formats.  
Charge your device whenever you can. Charge it overnight.  
Set your screen to turn off automatically after a shorter period of  
Keep your battery away from direct sunlight and other sources of heat.  
Temperatures over 104 degrees Fahrenheit (40 degrees Celsius) can  
permanently reduce the capacity and life span of any lithium-ion  
battery.  
If you set up an email account in the Email application, set the interval  
to automatically download email to every two hours or less frequently  
3
4
When the list of available Wi-Fi networks appears, tap the network  
you want. If prompted, enter the network username and/or  
password and tap Sign In. If the network name doesn’t appear, see  
Connect to a new secure network for instructions on connecting to a  
hidden network.  
When the HP webOS Account screen appears, do one of the  
following:  
Lower the screen brightness (see Turn auto dim on/off).  
Keep in mind that frequent use of instant messaging (IM) can reduce  
battery life. Sign out of your IM account when you are not using it (see  
If you are a new user: Tap Create New Account. To create an HP  
webOS Account, enter a working email address, create a  
password for your account, and select and answer a security  
question.  
14  
Chapter 2 : Basics  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
What is an HP webOS Account?  
IMPORTANT You must enter a valid email address to access all the features  
available on your device. Note that entering an email address here does not set  
up your device to send and receive messages from that email account; you must  
do that separately (see Email).  
If you create a new HP webOS Account, write down the email  
address and password that you enter; you will need them later. Later,  
look for an email at the address you used to create your HP webOS  
Account. Click the link in the email to verify your HP webOS  
Account.  
Your HP webOS Account gives you the following benefits:  
If you have an HP webOS Account that you use with another HP  
webOS device, and you want to use it on your HP TouchPad: Enter  
the email address and password for your existing account, and  
tap Sign In.  
Automatic system and software updates are sent to your device.  
An HP webOS Account is automatically created for you on your device.  
In this account you can store Contacts and Calendar info that you don’t  
store in online accounts like Google or Exchange.  
5
If you chose to sign in to an existing HP webOS Account: If  
prompted, select whether to do a one-time transfer of the data stored  
in the existing HP webOS Account to your new HP TouchPad. If you  
have more than one device already associated with this account,  
select the device you want to use as the source for the transfer.  
NOTE You cannot access HP webOS Account data on the account website.  
You can access the data on your device only.  
Info stored in your HP webOS Account, as well as info you have in  
applications on your device (like Memos), is automatically backed up to  
the webOS servers.  
If your device is lost or stolen, open the web browser on your computer,  
sign in to your HP webOS Account on hpwebos.com/account, and do  
a remote erase of the info on the device.  
NOTE If you use the same HP webOS Account with two devices, after the  
one-time data transfer, info you enter into the HP webOS Account on one device  
is not synchronized between the devices. You need to enter the info in both  
places.  
6
If you see a notification that an update is available, tap Install Now  
to install it. HP periodically sends updates to the applications and  
features on your device. The installation process may take up to 20  
minutes.  
NOTE If you want to erase data on your device while you are still in possession  
of the device—for example, before you give it to someone else—don’t do a  
remote erase. Instead, do a partial or full erase of the device itself (see Erase  
Your device is ready to use.  
For detailed information about your HP webOS Account, see Backup.  
Chapter 2 : Basics  
15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Although you create an HP webOS Account by entering a valid email  
address, setting up an HP webOS Account is different from setting up  
email on your device. To set up email, see Set up email. To change your  
HP webOS Account information after you set it up, see Update your HP  
Turn the screen on/off  
To turn the screen on, do one of the following:  
Press the power button. Drag  
up to unlock the screen.  
Turn your device on/off  
Your device’s screen can be turned on and off separately from its wireless  
services (which are the Wi-Fi  
app, Bluetooth®  
app, and VPN  
app). This means you can wake up the screen to use just the organizer  
features of your device (Calendar, Contacts, Memos, and so on) without  
turning on the wireless features. Also, when the screen is turned off,  
wireless services can be on.  
*
Power  
Press Center  
. Drag  
up to unlock the screen.  
To turn the screen off, press the power button.  
Why the screen goes dark  
When the device is on and idle, the screen first dims and then turns off.  
This is normal behavior, caused by the auto shut-off interval. You can  
adjust this auto shut-off interval to be as long as 10 minutes (see Set the  
as a power-saving measure. Just tap the screen to brighten it. Then, if your  
device remains inactive for the full interval you set, the screen turns itself  
off. Press the power button to turn the screen back on.  
NOTE Pressing the power button to turn the screen off also works when your  
device is placed on a Touchstone (sold separately).  
Turn wireless services off (airplane mode)  
Airplane mode turns off your device’s wireless services (which are the  
app, and Bluetooth®  
app). Use airplane  
NOTE If you can’t turn the screen back on, see The screen appears blank for  
instructions.  
Wi-Fi  
app, VPN  
mode when you are on a plane or anywhere else you need to turn off all  
wireless services. You can’t browse the web, but you can still use apps like  
Calendar, Contacts, Photos & Videos, Music, Quickoffice® mobile office  
software, and Adobe Reader.  
Do one of the following:  
Tap the upper-right corner of any screen to open the system menu. Tap  
Turn on Airplane Mode.  
Press and hold the power button and tap Airplane Mode.  
16  
Chapter 2 : Basics  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
When your device is in airplane mode, the airplane mode  
appears at the top of every screen, and Airplane Mode appears in the  
upper-left corner of the screen in the Card view.  
icon  
Shut down your device  
Usually, turning your device off and/or putting it in airplane mode is  
sufficient for normal periods when you have the device with you but you’re  
not using it. On rare occasions, however, you may want to put your  
device into deep sleep because you are not going to use it for an  
extended period. At those times, shut down the screen and wireless  
services completely by doing one of the following:  
Open Device Info  
Shut Down again.  
Press and hold the power button and tap Shut Down.  
and tap Reset Options. Tap Shut Down, and tap  
*
These indicate that wireless services are off (airplane mode).  
Turn wireless services on  
When you turn off airplane mode, any wireless services that were on  
previously are turned back on automatically.  
To turn off airplane mode, tap the upper-right corner of any screen to  
open the system menu, and tap Turn off Airplane Mode.  
Press and hold the power button and tap Turn off Airplane Mode.  
NOTE When you turn everything off, the device’s alarms and notifications are  
also turned off.  
When your device is in airplane mode, you can turn the Wi-Fi, VPN, and  
Bluetooth features on individually (see Turn Wi-Fi on/off, VPN, and Turn  
the Bluetooth feature on/off). Note that to make a VPN connection while  
your device is in airplane mode, you must first connect to a Wi-Fi network.  
To turn both the screen and wireless services back on, press and hold the  
power button until a logo appears onscreen.  
When wireless services are turned on, HP webOS appears in the  
upper-left of the screen in Card view. If Wi-Fi is turned on, the Wi-Fi  
icon also appears.  
Use gestures: Tap, swipe, drag, flick, pinch  
Gestures are an important, basic part of your device. They’re easy to  
learn, and they make working with the device fast. You make most  
gestures with one finger. For a few, you need two. Make gestures with the  
tip of your finger. Do not use your fingernail. Don’t bear down.  
You make gestures on the touchscreen.  
*
These indicate that data services are on.  
Chapter 2 : Basics  
17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
becomes transparent; an icon in the Launcher is ready to be dragged  
when a border appears around it.  
Tap  
Tap with the tip of the finger, not the fingernail. Tap fast and firmly, and  
then immediately lift your fingertip off the screen. Don’t bear down on  
what you’re tapping. Don’t wait for a response; the response comes after  
you lift your finger. Don’t linger on the gesture; a tap takes a split second  
to do.  
Flick  
This is a quick gesture, great for scrolling long lists, documents, or pages.  
Do it fast, do it lightly; as with a swipe, your fingertip just skims the  
surface. The faster you flick, the faster and farther you scroll up or down a  
list.  
Swipe  
Close an application screen: To close an application screen in Card view,  
flick the card up toward the top of the touchscreen. This is called throwing  
the card off the top of the screen.  
A swipe is a horizontal gesture, from right to left or left to right. Do it fast,  
do it lightly. In a swipe, your fingertip just skims the surface of the  
touchscreen.  
Drag  
Drag is the gesture you make for a slow scroll up and down, such as in a  
list, in a document, or on a web page. Slide your fingertip slowly along  
the surface—no need to bear down.  
Drag and drop: Tap and hold the item. Wait until you get a visual cue that  
the item is ready to be dragged, and then drag it. Lift your finger to drop  
it. For example, a card in Card view is ready to be dragged when it  
Delete a list item: In some applications, such as Email, Messaging, Music,  
and Bluetooth, you can throw a list item off the side of the screen to delete  
the item.  
18  
Chapter 2 : Basics  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Throw the item off the side of the screen. If prompted, tap Delete to  
confirm the deletion.  
Zoom out/pinch in to decrease the size of items on the screen (for  
example, in Email, Web, Photos & Videos, Quickoffice® mobile office  
software, Adobe Reader, and Maps): Place two fingers on the screen and  
bring them together.  
If you can’t delete a list item by throwing it, open the item and look in the  
application menu for a Delete menu item.  
Zoom in or out a fixed amount (for example, in Web, Photos & Videos,  
and Adobe Reader): Double-tap the screen.  
TIP To delete multiple list items, throw each one off the screen. If you get the  
Delete confirmation prompt after throwing the first item, you don’t need to tap  
it—just throw the second item, and the first deletion is confirmed automatically.  
TIP In some apps, such as Email, you can set a preference whether to show a  
confirmation screen when you delete a list item.  
Pinch (zoom gestures)  
Zoom in/pinch out to increase the size of items on the screen (for  
example, in Email, Web, Photos & Videos, Quickoffice® mobile office  
software, Adobe Reader, and Maps): Place two fingers on the screen and  
spread them slowly apart.  
Chapter 2 : Basics  
19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Scroll gestures  
Text selection gestures  
Scroll slow: Drag the screen in the desired direction.  
For information on working with text after you select it, see Cut, copy, and  
Insert the cursor in a text field: Tap the location.  
Scroll fast: Flick the screen in the desired direction.  
Select text: Tap and hold the text. Tap Select or Select All. See Cut, copy,  
and paste information for more information.  
Update the HP webOS operating system  
HP provides updates to your device’s operating system. Update  
notifications are sent to your device automatically when a system update  
is available (see Respond to a system software notification). When you  
update your device’s operating system, your personal information and  
files are not affected. In addition to receiving update notifications, you  
can manually check for operating system updates at any time (see  
Stop scrolling: Tap or drag the screen while scrolling.  
What’s more, both HP and many application developers make updates  
available for applications you installed on your device. You can check in  
Software Manager at any time for application updates (see Update a  
20  
Chapter 2 : Basics  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
2
If a message appears stating that a system update is available, do  
the following:  
Respond to a system software notification  
When you get a notification that a system update is available, do one of  
the following:  
Tap Install Now twice. When installation is complete and the device  
resets, tap Done. Installation times vary, depending on the size of the  
update. You cannot use your device while an update is being installed.  
Tap Install Later. The next time you charge your device, you receive  
another update notification. You can again choose whether to install  
the update now or later. If you do not tap Install Later within 10 minutes  
of receiving the notification, installation begins automatically.  
Here is some additional information about system updates:  
If you have Wi-Fi turned on and the battery has enough charge, your  
device automatically downloads a system update if one is available—  
you don’t have to do anything. If Wi-Fi is not turned on when the  
update becomes available, the webOS servers continue to check your  
device for Wi-Fi availability.  
If the battery does not have enough charge, you must charge the  
battery before you can download or install an update.  
If prompted, tap Download now.  
When prompted, tap Install Now.  
After installation has finished and the device resets, tap Done.  
TIP If you don’t want to install the update at this time, close System Updates by  
throwing its app card off the top of the screen (see Close an application or  
If you do not install an update immediately after downloading it, you  
are prompted to install the update the next time you charge your  
device. You can choose whether to install the update now or later. You  
have ten minutes to decide; otherwise, the update installs automatically.  
Manually check for system updates  
1
Open System Updates  
.
Chapter 2 : Basics  
21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
22  
Chapter 2 : Basics  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Just Type  
Update your Facebook or Twitter status (see Create a new item such as  
Open an app (see Open an application)  
You can also start a search by copying text in another application,  
opening Just Type, and pasting the text in the Just type field (see Cut,  
Look up a contact  
Just Type overview  
1
2
Open Card view (see Manage applications in Card view) and tap  
Just type.  
The Just Type feature lets you do almost anything you want on your  
device, without having to go to a specific app. When it crosses your mind  
to look up, do, or make note of something, just type to put your thought  
into action.  
Begin typing the contact’s first and last initials (no space), first or last  
name, phone number, or email address.  
You access Just Type from Card view by tapping the Just type field. Then,  
by just typing, you can begin doing any of the following:  
Look up a contact (see Look up a contact)  
Search the web (see Search the web)  
Search for email messages, web bookmarks, videos, and more (see  
Create a new message, memo, or other item (see Create a new item  
3
(Optional) To filter the search results to show just matching contacts,  
tap the Contacts tab.  
Chapter 3 : Just Type  
23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
4
When the contact name appears, do one of the following. If only the  
contact name is displayed, tap the name to display ways to get in  
touch.  
Tap the name to open the person’s contact information.  
Tap an email address to send a message.  
If you have set up a Skype account on your device and the contact  
is a Skype contact, tap  
to call the contact.  
3
4
(Optional) To filter the search results to show just information on your  
TIP If you are using Exchange with a corporate server, you can search your  
company’s Global Address List (GAL) for a contact by tapping Address Lookup  
in the Just Type search results. You can set a preference to have a GAL search  
take place automatically, or to manually choose whether to search your GAL  
device, tap the Content tab.  
Depending on the app you want to search in, tap one of the  
following:  
TIP If you pair your HP TouchPad with an HP webOS smartphone, you can also  
make a call or send a text message to a contact from Just Type search results  
Artists: Your device displays the number of songs whose artist name  
contains your search term, Tap Artists to view the list of songs. Tap a  
song to play it.  
Calendar Events: Your device displays the number of calendar events  
whose name contains your search term, Tap Calendar Events to view  
the list of events. Tap an event to open it.  
Find information in an application on your  
device  
Bookmarks & History: Your device displays the number of websites  
in your bookmarks list and browsing history list whose name  
contains your search term. Tap Bookmarks & History to view a list of  
the websites. Tap an entry to go to the website.  
You can search for email messages, music, web bookmarks, and websites  
you’ve visited (browsing history) on your device. You can also search for  
apps in HP webOS App Catalog.  
Email: Your device displays the number of email messages whose  
sender name or subject contains your search term. Tap Email to  
display the list of matching messages. Tap a message to view it.  
If your search term does not show results for a certain app, you may need  
to turn on a preference to include that app in a Just Type search (see  
NOTE In addition to Just Type, applications such as Contacts, Email, Memos,  
and Adobe Reader also offer the ability to search within the app for entries or  
files. When you’re in one of those apps, from the list view, type the file name; a  
few words from a memo; or a contact name, initials, address, or number. See  
the individual application sections for details. You can also enter a search term  
in the Help application to search for help content related to the term.  
1
2
Open Card view (see Manage applications in Card view) and tap  
Just type.  
Begin typing the information you want to find. Depending on which  
app you want to search, this could be the subject of an email  
message, a music artist, a bookmark name, or some other term.  
24  
Chapter 3 : Just Type  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
To search the web using a different search engine: Under Search  
Using, tap a search engine name. If the search engine is for a  
specific website, such as Wikipedia, your device searches that site  
only.  
To view your search term on a map: Under Search Using, tap  
Maps.  
Search the web  
You have several options for using Just Type to search the web.  
1
2
Open Card view (see Manage applications in Card view) and tap  
To search HP webOS App Catalog for apps that match your  
search term, tap HP App Catalog.  
Just type.  
Begin typing the search term.  
Create a new item such as a message,  
calendar event, or memo  
You can use Just Type to create a new item such as an email message or  
memo by entering all or part of the item’s text. These items are grouped in  
the Quick Actions section of the search results.  
3
4
(Optional) To filter the search results to show just matching actions  
For some Quick Actions, you need to turn on a preference to create that  
type of item from your search results (see Customize Just Type).  
(web search options and Quick Actions), tap the Actions tab.  
Do one of the following:  
1
2
Open Card view (see Manage applications in Card view) and tap  
Just type.  
To search the web using your default search engine: Tap Search  
[search engine name].  
To go directly to a website: Type the website address, such as  
hp.com. When the address appears at the top of the search  
results, tap Go to website.  
Type all or part of the item text, such as email message text or memo text.  
TIP You can also search the web using the default search engine by typing the  
search term and tapping Enter on the onscreen keyboard. Or go directly to a  
website by typing the website address and tapping Enter.  
3
(Optional) To filter the search results to show just matching actions  
(web search options and Quick Actions), tap the Actions tab.  
To view suggested search terms from your default search engine  
based on the characters you entered: Tap Suggest to the right of  
your default search engine name. Tap a suggestion to search on  
that term. If the characters you entered return no contacts,  
applications, or other items on your device, suggestions are  
displayed automatically. Tap one to search on it.  
Chapter 3 : Just Type  
25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
4
Under Quick Actions, tap New [item type]. The relevant application  
opens, displaying your text as part of a new item. Here are some  
examples:  
Use application keywords  
If you don’t know the name of the app you are searching for, you can  
enter a keyword associated with the app. This table shows the keywords  
you can use to find an app on your device.  
To create a new email message: Tap New Email. A new message  
opens with the text you entered as the message text.  
To create a calendar event: Tap Create New Event. A new event  
opens containing the text you entered.  
Table 1. Application keywords  
Application Name  
Backup  
Keywords  
Settings, Preferences  
Settings, Preferences, Wireless  
Datebook, Meetings, Events  
Clock, Settings, Preferences, Time  
Settings, Preferences, Reset  
Preferences  
Open an application  
Bluetooth  
Calendar  
Date & Time  
Device Info  
1
2
Open Card view (see Manage applications in Card view) and tap  
Just type.  
Exhibition  
Begin typing the app name or a related keyword. See Use  
application keywords for a list.  
HP App Catalog  
Location Services  
Memos  
Store  
Settings, Preferences  
Notes, Stickies, Notepad  
Text, SMS, MMS, IM, Instant, Chat  
Dial  
Messaging  
Phone & Video Calls  
Photos & Videos  
Print Manager  
Regional Settings  
Screen & Lock  
Pictures  
Preferences  
Settings, Preferences  
Wallpaper, Security, Desktop, Brightness,  
Unlock, Gestures, Settings, Preferences  
3
When the app appears, tap it.  
Sounds & Ringtones  
Audio, Music, Volume, Vibrate, Silent,  
Settings, Preferences  
System Updates  
VPN  
Preferences  
Settings, Preferences, Wireless  
Browser, Blazer, Internet  
Settings, Preferences, Wireless  
Web  
Wi-Fi  
26  
Chapter 3 : Just Type  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
term you enter. If you do not want to include contacts in Just Type  
searches, tap On to switch this setting from On to Off. If you have an  
Exchange account set up on your device, check the Start Global  
Address Lookup automatically box to have contact searches always  
include your corporate Global Address List (GAL). If you uncheck the  
box, your Just Type search results include an option to perform a  
Global Address Lookup.  
Repeat a recent search  
To search on a term you recently entered, you don’t need to enter the term  
again.  
1
2
Open Card view (see Manage applications in Card view) and tap  
Just type.  
Default Search Engine: This is the search engine your device uses to  
search the web when you enter a search term. If you do not want Just  
Type to display a default search engine, tap On to switch this setting  
from On to Off. To change the search engine, tap the currently  
displayed engine, and then tap the one you want. The list contains  
two types of search engines: Engines that search the entire web,  
such as Google, and engines that search within a specific website  
only, such as Wikipedia.  
Your recent searches are displayed. Tap a search term to repeat the  
search.  
TIP To clear your recent search history, tap Clear.  
Content: By default, Just Type returns entries from certain  
applications on your device that match the search term you enter. If  
you do not want to include application entries in Just Type searches,  
tap On to switch this setting from On to Off. To customize which  
application entries are included in searches, check or uncheck the  
box to the left of each app name.  
Customize Just Type  
You can select the types of information that are included in a search. For  
contacts, you can also turn Global Address Lookup on or off. You can  
choose which web search options to display in the search results, and  
add new search engines to the list. You can select the applications that  
you can launch directly from search results.  
Search Using: By default, Just Type lets you search the web using  
other search engines, or search using other applications on your  
device. If you do not want these alternate search engines and  
applications displayed in Just Type searches, tap On to switch this  
setting from On to Off. To customize the other web search engines  
and applications available for Just Type searches, check or uncheck  
the box to the left of each entry. Search engines are designated by  
Web—you can make any listed search engine the default search  
engine. Applications included in your searches are designated by  
App.  
1
Open Just Type  
.
TIP Alternatively, in Card view, tap the Just type field, open the application  
menu, and tap Preferences.  
2
Select any of the following options:  
Actions: By default, Just Type lets you create an item or start an  
action based on your search term. If you do not want to include  
these Quick Actions in Just Type searches, tap On to switch this  
setting from On to Off. To customize the Quick Actions included in  
Just Type searches, check or uncheck the box to the left of each  
entry.  
Applications: By default, Just Type returns any applications on your  
device that match the search term you enter. If you do not want to  
include applications in Just Type searches, tap On to switch this  
setting from On to Off.  
Contacts: By default, Just Type returns any contacts on your device  
whose name, phone number, or email address match the search  
Chapter 3 : Just Type  
27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Find More: This option lets you search App Catalog for third-party  
applications and services that you can use to perform any of the  
following Just Type functions: web search, app search, or creation of  
a new item (Quick Action). For example, you can use Find More to  
download a new web search engine. To use this feature, tap Find  
More, and then download an app from the list displayed in App  
TIP There’s another way to add a search engine to Just Type. If you open a web  
page and an additional search engine is available, a notification appears  
alerting you that you can add the search engine. If you add the search engine,  
it appears as an option in Just Type.  
28  
Chapter 3 : Just Type  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Work with applications  
2
3
Begin typing the name of the application or one of its keywords (see  
When the application icon appears in the search results, tap it.  
Open an application in the Launcher  
The Launcher contains pages that display icons for all your applications.  
You can organize the Launcher icons to group apps the way you want  
1
2
If you’re in an app, press Center  
to display Card view.  
.
In Card view, press Center or tap  
Open applications  
You can have as many applications open at one time as you like, limited  
only by the amount of memory available on your device at the time.  
Open an application using Just Type  
For detailed information on the Just Type feature, see Just Type.  
1
Open Card view (see Manage applications in Card view) and tap  
Just type.  
Chapter 4 : Work with applications  
29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
3
To find the app you want, flick up or down to see all the icons on a  
page. To see other pages, swipe right or left on the screen, or tap a  
page name at the top of the screen.  
*
Launcher page names. Tap to go to a different page.  
4
Tap the application icon.  
*
Quick Launch  
To close the Launcher, press Center  
or tap  
.
Quick Launch can display no more than six icons. By default it displays,  
from left to right, Web, Email, Calendar, Messaging, Photos & Videos,  
and the Launcher. You can change the order of icons (except the Launcher  
icon) in Quick Launch (see Reorder Quick Launch icons), or swap in  
whatever applications you like (see Line up your favorite applications in  
TIP If advanced gestures are turned on, you can make the up gesture to open  
and close the Launcher. If you’re in an app, flick up once from below the screen  
onto the screen to display Card view, and then flick again to open the Launcher.  
If Card view is displayed, just flick up once. When the Launcher is open, make  
the up gesture to close it (see Turn advanced gestures on/off).  
Resize panels/display or hide levels in an  
app  
Open an application in Quick Launch  
Quick Launch is the bar of six icons that always appears at the bottom of  
Card view and the Launcher.  
Most applications let you display different levels of the application as  
panels. For example, in the Email application you can display panels for  
three levels of the app: the list of accounts, the inbox of a specific  
account, and a message from that inbox. You can resize panels to get a  
larger view of any level, or to display more levels.  
You can customize Quick Launch to contain the icons for apps you use  
most often. To open an application from Quick Launch, just tap the icon.  
In all applications, you can resize panels by swiping on the screen. Some  
applications, such as Email and Photos & Videos, also let you resize  
panels using the drag handles  
icon.  
30  
Chapter 4 : Work with applications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
To display a panel full screen: Do one of the following:  
Use the menus  
Swipe left on the screen.  
If the drag handles  
icon is displayed, drag the icon to the left.  
Most applications have an application menu hidden in the upper-left  
corner, which provides access to additional features. There is also a  
system menu hidden in the upper-right corner, which provides access to  
systemwide features such as wireless services.  
To get the most out of your device, it’s a good idea to familiarize yourself  
with the additional features available through the menus in various  
applications.  
Use the application menu  
To resize a full-screen panel so you can see more levels in an app: Do one  
of the following:  
The application menu contains items for the application you are working  
in, such as Preferences, Help, and other application-specific menu items.  
Within an app, application menu items may be different for different  
screens—for example, the application menu items for an Inbox in Email  
are different from the items available for an open email message. Help is  
available on the application menu of every application.  
Swipe right on the screen.  
If the drag handles  
icon is displayed, drag the icon to the right.  
In applications containing material you can print (such as messages, web  
pages, photos, or documents), the application menu contains the Print  
command.  
1
In an app, do one of the following:  
Drag down from the upper-left corner of the device (above the  
screen) onto the screen.  
For example, if an email message is displayed full screen, you can resize  
the message so you can see the inbox containing the message.  
TIP In some apps displaying the drag handles icon, you can tap or swipe the  
icon to resize a panel.  
Chapter 4 : Work with applications  
31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Tap the application name in the upper-left corner of the screen.  
1
Do one of the following:  
Drag down from the upper-right corner of the device (above the  
screen) onto the screen.  
2
3
Tap a menu item to open it. If a menu item displays a right-pointing  
arrow , tap the item to display the submenu for that item. If you  
see a downward-pointing arrow  
at the bottom of the menu, scroll  
down to see additional menu items.  
Tap the upper-right corner of the screen.  
To close the menu without selecting an item, repeat one of the  
options in step 1.  
Use the system menu  
The system menu lets you control systemwide functions such as screen  
brightness and system sounds. It also lets you manage wireless services:  
Wi-Fi, VPN, and Bluetooth® wireless technology.  
2
Do one of the following:  
DID YOU KNOW? The system menu also displays the current day and date and  
To adjust the screen brightness: Drag the slider.  
the battery charge level.  
To use a wireless feature (Wi-Fi, VPN, Bluetooth): Tap a menu item  
to display a list of menu items for that feature (see Turn wireless  
services off (airplane mode)). If you see a downward-pointing  
arrow at the bottom of the menu, scroll down to see additional  
menu items.  
To turn all wireless services on or off: Tap Turn on Airplane Mode  
or Turn off Airplane Mode (see Turn wireless services off (airplane  
mode)).  
To lock or unlock the screen rotation: Tap Turn on Rotation Lock or  
Turn off Rotation Lock. When rotation lock is turned on, your  
screen orientation (portrait or landscape) does not change even if  
you turn the device.  
32  
Chapter 4 : Work with applications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
To turn system sounds on or off: Tap Mute Sound or Unmute  
Sound.  
TIP You can set up and use multiple languages and layouts for the onscreen  
TIP You can also turn system sounds on and off using the Sounds & Ringtones  
preference (see Set sound options).  
Enter uppercase letters  
3
To close the menu without selecting an item, repeat one of the  
options in step 1.  
By default, the first letter of each sentence or field is capitalized and the  
remaining text you enter is lowercase. To enter other uppercase letters, do  
one of the following:  
Enter and save information  
Tap Shift  
and tap the letter key. The Shift key changes to  
. You  
don’t need to hold Shift while you tap the letter key.  
Turn on Caps Lock: Tap Shift  
twice quickly. The Shift key changes to  
Use the onscreen keyboard  
.
Turn off Caps Lock: Tap Shift  
.
Enter symbols and alternate characters  
There are several ways to enter punctuation marks and other symbols. Do  
one of the following:  
To enter a symbol that appears on a number key: Tap Shift  
and tap  
the key. You don’t need to hold Shift while tapping the number key.  
To enter a symbol from the symbol keyboard: Tap  
symbol keyboard, and then tap a symbol key. Tap  
the alphanumeric keyboard.  
To enter other symbols or alternate keyboard characters: Tap and hold  
a letter or number key to see the symbols or characters associated with  
that key (not all keys have symbols associated with them). Tap a symbol.  
See Symbols and accented characters for a list of the available symbols  
and accented characters using the tap-and-hold method.  
to display the  
to return to  
1 Next/Prev/Tab: Tap to move among fields. The name of the key changes depending on  
the app you are using (see Enter information in a field).  
2 Layout: Tap to change between the alphanumeric keyboard and the symbol keyboard  
3 Enter: Tap to enter a line return (for example, in a memo or in an email message you are  
composing) or to accept information you entered in a field (see Enter information in a  
field).  
4 Dismiss/resize keyboard: Tap to dismiss the keyboard. To resize the keys, tap and hold,  
and then tap XS (extra small), S (small), M (medium), or L (large).  
5 Space  
Chapter 4 : Work with applications  
33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Table 1. Symbols and accented characters  
TIP The symbols and accented characters are grouped according to their  
similarity to the corresponding key. For example, to enter an é, tap and hold e.  
For the number keys, the symbols are related to either the number or the symbol  
shown on the key. For example, to type a € or other currency symbol, tap and  
hold the 4 key. Why? Because the symbol on the 4 key is $.  
Tap and hold ...  
to select…  
i
ì í î ï İ ı  
I
Ì Í Î Ï İ ı  
TIP Not all keys contain alternate characters or symbols. When you tap and  
hold a key, you see ... at the bottom of most keys. The ... means that alternate  
characters/symbols are available for those keys. If a key does not display ..., it  
does not have any alternate characters or symbols. Likewise, the keys on the  
symbol keyboard do not contain alternate characters or symbols.  
l
ł
L
Ł
m
μ
M
Μ
n
ñ ń  
Enter passwords  
N
Ñ Ń  
o
ò ó ô õ ö ø ő œ º ω  
You can see each character of a password only as you enter it, so be  
careful. Be sure Caps Lock is off unless you need it. For information on  
how to enter characters, see Enter uppercase letters and Enter symbols  
O
Ò Ó Ô Õ Ö Ø Ő Œ º Ω  
p
§ π  
P
§ Π  
r or R  
®
Symbols and accented characters  
s
š ş ß σ  
Š Ş ß Σ  
™ þ  
Table 1. Symbols and accented characters  
S
t
Tap and hold ...  
to select…  
à á â ã ä å æ ª  
À Á Â Ã Å Ä Æ ª  
ç ć © ¢  
T
™ Þ  
a
A
c
u
ù ú û ü ű  
Ù Ú Û Ü Ű  
ý ÿ  
U
y
C
d
D
e
Ç Ć © ¢  
δ † ‡  
Y
Ý Ÿ  
z
ž ź ż  
Ž Ź Ż  
\
Ð † ‡  
Z
è é ê ë ę ē  
È É Ê Ë Ę Ē  
ğ
, or /  
. or ?  
‘ or “  
- or _  
E
• … ¿  
` ‘ ’ “ ”« »  
± ¬  
g
G
Ğ
34  
Chapter 4 : Work with applications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Table 1. Symbols and accented characters  
NOTE If a Text Assist feature does not seem to be working, make sure that  
feature is turned on (see Customize Text Assist settings).  
Tap and hold ...  
1 or !  
to select…  
¹ ¼ ½ ¡  
If Text Assist recognizes a common misspelling, it auto-corrects the  
word. The word appears with a gray underline to indicate it has been  
corrected. If system sounds are turned on, a sound is played as well.  
2 or @  
3 or #  
²
³ ¾  
4 or $  
€ £ ¥ ¢ ¤  
If auto-correction doesn’t recognize a spelling, it highlights the word  
with an orange underline. Tap the word to display a list of close  
matches, and then tap the correct word. If the word is spelled correctly  
as you typed it, tap the word, and then tap + to add the word to the  
auto-correction dictionary.  
Auto-correction inserts punctuation such as apostrophes in contractions.  
So you can quickly type dont, and it appears correctly as don’t.  
5 or %  
9 or (  
[ {  
] }  
0 or )  
The auto-capitalization feature automatically capitalizes the first word of  
a sentence and other letters that would commonly be capitalized, such  
as the letter i by itself.  
The shortcut feature recognizes and expands common shorthand  
expressions, such as replacing u with you or r with are.  
Enter information in a field  
You can enter information in a field by typing or by pasting previously  
copied information (see Cut, copy, and paste information). The Text Assist  
feature works with all text fields (see Work with the Text Assist feature).  
To cancel an auto-correction, auto-capitalization, or shortcut expansion,  
tap Backspace  
. To cancel auto-correction of a misspelled word, you  
To accept the information you entered, do one of the following:  
can also tap the word and tap the original spelling.  
Tap outside the field.  
Tap Enter.  
Tap Next, Prev, or Tab in the lower-left corner of the onscreen  
keyboard. This accepts the information in the current field and moves  
the cursor to the next or previous field. The key name changes  
depending on the app you are using.  
TIP Suppose the language on your device is English and you need to write an  
email in French. To prevent Text Assist from trying to correct everything you enter,  
temporarily turn off auto-correction (see Customize Text Assist settings).  
Customize Text Assist settings  
Work with the Text Assist feature  
You can customize individual Text Assist features: auto-correction,  
auto-capitalization, and shortcuts. To customize the user dictionary, see  
Text Assist, the assisted text entry feature, works on any screen in which  
you can enter text, including email and instant messages; memos; contact  
and calendar entry screens; and more. Text Assist includes  
auto-correction, auto-capitalization, and shortcuts.  
1
Open Text Assist  
.
Chapter 4 : Work with applications  
35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
2
Do any of the following:  
4
To edit the shortcuts list, tap Shortcuts and do any of the following:  
To add a shortcut: Tap  
, enter the new shortcut and  
replacement text, and then tap Add.  
To change a shortcut and/or its replacement text: Tap the shortcut  
you want to change. Tap the Shortcut field or the Replace With  
field, and then enter the new shortcut or replacement text. Tap  
Done.  
To delete a shortcut: Throw the shortcut off the side of the screen.  
Tap Delete to confirm.  
TIP You can also delete a shortcut by tapping the shortcut and then tapping  
Delete.  
To turn Auto-Capitalization, Shortcuts, or Auto-Correction on or off:  
Tap Off or On for that entry.  
To change whether a tone plays, the device vibrates, or neither  
happens when an auto-correction takes place: In Alert, tap the  
currently displayed option, and then tap System Sound, Vibrate,  
or Mute. The Alert option is available only if auto-correction is  
turned on.  
Cut, copy, and paste information  
You can copy any selectable text, and you can cut any selectable text that  
you entered, for example, in a memo or an email you composed.  
1
2
Tap and hold the text you want to cut or copy.  
Add your own words and shortcuts  
If the text appears with a yellow highlight, it means the selection is  
ready to be copied. To expand the selection, drag the arrows at the  
beginning and end of the selected text.  
1
2
3
Open Text Assist  
.
Tap Edit User Dictionary.  
If the Select and Select All options appear, do one of the following:  
To edit the auto-correction dictionary, tap Learned Words and do  
any of the following:  
To select all text—for example, an entire memo or message: Tap  
Select All.  
To select a portion of the text: Tap Select. To expand the selection,  
To add a word: Tap  
To change the spelling of a word: Tap the word, and then type the  
correction to the word. Tap Done.  
To delete a word: Throw the word off the side of the screen. Tap  
Delete to confirm.  
, enter the new word, and then tap Add.  
drag the arrows at the beginning and end of the selected text.  
3
If the Cut and Copy options are not displayed, tap the highlighted  
text to display the options.  
36  
Chapter 4 : Work with applications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
4
Tap Cut or Copy. If the text appeared with a yellow highlight  
immediately after you tapped and held it, only the Copy option is  
available.  
5
6
7
Open the app where you want to paste the text.  
Tap and hold the insertion point where you want to paste the text.  
Tap Paste.  
TIP On screens where you cannot tap and hold to select, cut, copy, or paste, the  
application menu may have items for these tasks. To check, open the application  
menu and look for an Edit item. If Edit is displayed, tap it to open a submenu of  
options: Select All, Cut, Copy, and/or Paste. Tap an item to perform that action.  
2
Tap the list item you want.  
Select items in a list  
Lists enable you to select from a range of options. Lists are different from  
menus (see Use the menus), which give you access to additional features.  
Save information  
You information is saved automatically as you enter it. When you close an  
app or a screen, any new or changed info is retained.  
Lists are hidden until you tap the currently displayed option for that list.  
1
Tap the currently displayed option to open the list. For example,  
when creating a new event in Calendar, tap 15 minutes before to  
display the list of reminder options.  
Close an application or application screen  
If you are working on a screen with a Back or a Done button, to exit the  
screen but stay in the application, tap Back or Done.  
To close an application or a screen, in Card view (see Manage  
applications in Card view), throw the card off the top of the screen. If  
cards are in a stack (see Work with stacked cards), you can only throw  
one card at a time.  
Chapter 4 : Work with applications  
37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
If you have more than one card open for an app, throwing one of the  
cards off the top of the screen may close the entire app, or it may close  
only that screen. For example, say you have a card open for the main  
Email app screen—the one showing the list of accounts—and another  
card open for a single email message. If you throw the message card off  
the top of the screen, it does not close the Email app. But if you throw the  
main Email card off the top of the screen, it closes the app, including the  
message you had open.  
1 Just Type field  
2 Wallpaper  
3 Quick Launch  
Delete an application  
When an application fills the screen and you want to go to Card view,  
press Center  
.
Use Software Manager to delete applications that you installed on your  
Manage applications in Card view  
Card view displays open applications as small cards so that you can  
easily scroll through them and drag them to change their order.  
TIP If advanced gestures are turned on, you can make the up gesture to display  
Card view. If you’re in an app, flick up once from below the screen onto the  
screen to display Card view (see Turn advanced gestures on/off).  
When you have no open applications, your device displays Card view  
automatically. You don’t have to do anything to open Card view. When  
no cards are open, Card view shows only the Just Type field (see Just  
Type), your wallpaper (see Change your wallpaper), and Quick Launch  
38  
Chapter 4 : Work with applications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Work with stacked cards  
Change card order or unstack cards  
If you are working in an application and perform an action that opens a  
new screen or launches a second application—for example, composing a  
new email from your Inbox—your device treats the app screens as a  
group. If you minimize one of the screens, that screen and all screens  
associated with it appear as a set of stacked cards in Card view.  
1
In Card view (see Manage applications in Card view), tap and hold  
the card you want to move. This can be a single card or a card  
within a stack.  
You can also manually stack and unstack cards.  
Move among cards and stacks  
1
In Card view (see Manage applications in Card view), swipe left or  
right on the screen to see other open apps.  
2
After the card becomes transparent, drag it to another position. You  
can drag a stacked card to another position within the stack, or  
drag it out of the stack to unstack it.  
2
Tap a card to maximize the application.  
Stack cards  
Customize the app display in the Launcher  
and Quick Launch  
1
In Card view (see Manage applications in Card view), tap and hold  
a card.  
2
After the card becomes transparent, drag the card on top of another  
card. Release when the cards are positioned to be stacked.  
Reorder Launcher icons  
1
In the Launcher (see Open an application in the Launcher), tap and  
hold an icon, and wait for the visual cue that the icon is ready to be  
dragged.  
Chapter 4 : Work with applications  
39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
2
Drag the icon to a new location on any page. To drag the icon to a  
different page, drag it to the edge of the current page, and wait for  
the next page to appear.  
3
4
If Quick Launch contains six icons, tap and hold a Quick Launch  
icon, wait for the visual cue that the icon is ready to be dragged,  
and drag the icon off the Quick Launch bar. The icon is still  
available in the Launcher.  
Tap and hold the icon you want to add to Quick Launch, wait for the  
visual cue that the icon is ready to be dragged, and drag the icon  
onto any position in the Quick Launch bar.  
NOTE If Quick Launch contains fewer than six icons, you can drag the app icon  
from the Launcher between two Quick Launch icons to drop it into the blank  
space. If you simply want to remove an icon from Quick Launch without  
replacing it, tap and hold a Quick Launch icon, and drag it off the bar. The only  
one you can’t remove is the Launcher icon.  
3
Tap Done.  
TIP You can also add your favorite websites to the Launcher (see Add a web  
Reorder Quick Launch icons  
You can change the position of any Quick Launch icon except the  
Launcher icon.  
Line up your favorite applications in Quick Launch  
1
In Card view (see Manage applications in Card view) or the  
Launcher (see Open an application in the Launcher), tap and hold a  
Quick Launch icon.  
Quick Launch is a convenient lineup of your favorite apps. It contains a  
maximum of five apps, plus the Launcher. You can replace any Quick  
Launch icon (except the Launcher) with another one so that you always  
have quick access to the apps you use most.  
2
Wait for a visual cue, and then drag the icon to another location on  
the Quick Launch bar.  
If Quick Launch contains the maximum six icons, you need to remove an  
icon before you drag in a new one. When you drag an app icon into  
Quick Launch, you don’t remove it from the Launcher; you have access to  
the icon in two places.  
1
2
Open the Launcher (see Open an application in the Launcher).  
Scroll to the page containing the app icon you want to move into  
Quick Launch.  
40  
Chapter 4 : Work with applications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
To create a new Skype account, see Create a Skype account in  
Manage online accounts  
To sign in to an existing Skype account, see Sign in to a Skype account  
You can set up online accounts in the Accounts application, or in  
individual applications on your device. For most account types, the online  
account must already be set up on the web or server before you can add  
it to your device.  
You can add more accounts at any time using the Accounts app or the  
preferences in any of the applications mentioned above. See Set email  
The exception is Skype accounts. You can sign in to a Skype account you  
already have set up on the web, or you can create a new Skype account  
directly on your device.  
You can also set up your device to post photos to online accounts such as  
KEY TERM Online account An online account is a web-based or server-based  
location, such as Google, Yahoo!, or Exchange, where you keep contacts and/  
or calendar information. These accounts often have an email component as  
well. Such web-based or server-based accounts are sometimes talked about as  
being “in the cloud.”  
See Online accounts available for webOS devices for the current list of  
default online accounts that synchronize your info and those that do a  
one-way transfer of info either from the web to your device, or from your  
device to the web.  
The HP Synergy feature works in the background to get data from an online  
account onto your device. After you set up one of these accounts on your  
device, you can access the data from that online account. For some kinds of  
accounts, you can also add and change data on your device, which is then  
synchronized to the online account in the cloud.  
NOTE If you are setting up your device for the first time and downloading a  
large number of contacts or calendar events from an online account to your  
device, you may not see all your data on your device right away. Some online  
account providers such as Google set limits on the amount of data that a user  
can import in a given time frame. Also, if you have many years’ worth of data  
or thousands of entries in an online account, you may want to review the data  
and reduce the number of entries before setting up the account on your device.  
Filling your device memory with a large number of account entries can affect  
performance.  
Whether you decide to set up your online accounts in the Accounts app  
or from within an individual app, the process is the same. You can specify  
which apps should get data from the online account. For example, you  
can choose to set up your Google account so that your device displays  
your Google contacts, Google Talk instant messages, and Gmail  
messages, but not your Google calendar events.  
To set up an online account in the Accounts app: See Use the Accounts  
To set up within an individual app: The first time you open Email,  
Contacts, Calendar, or Messaging, you are given the option to enter  
settings for one or more online accounts. See Set up email, Use  
Use the Accounts application to set up an online account  
1
2
Open Accounts  
.
Tap Add an Account.  
Chapter 4 : Work with applications  
41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
3
Do one of the following:  
2
Tap the account name.  
To add one of the listed accounts: Tap the account name.  
To search for other accounts: Tap Find More. This displays a list of  
available online accounts. Tap the account you want to download  
and install it.  
4
5
Enter your username or email address and password, and tap Sign  
in.  
Depending on the account, you may be presented with options for  
which apps should download data from that account. For each app,  
tap On or Off, and then tap Create Account.  
3
Do one of the following:  
To change the account display name: Under Account Name, tap  
the current name to highlight it, and enter the new name.  
To change which applications are associated with the account: For  
each app listed, tap On or Off.  
To edit the account information: Tap Change Login Settings, enter  
the new username or email address and password, and tap Sign  
In.  
To delete the account: Tap Remove Account. Tap Remove Account  
again to confirm.  
Use the Accounts application to edit or delete an online  
account  
IMPORTANT If you delete an account from your device using the Accounts app,  
all data is removed from all apps on your device associated with the account.  
The account itself still exists online. For example, if you delete an Exchange  
account using the Accounts app, all your Exchange data is removed from Email,  
Contacts, and Calendar. If you want to delete data only from one app served  
by the account—for example, you want to delete the calendar events but keep  
the contacts—simply turn that app off for that account.  
If you change the username, email address, or password you use with an  
online account, you need to enter the new information in the account  
settings on your device. You can do that from within one of the  
applications associated with that account, or from the Accounts app.  
1
Open Accounts  
.
42  
Chapter 4 : Work with applications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Create a Skype account in Accounts  
Sign in to a Skype account in Accounts  
If you do not have a Skype account, you can create one right on your  
device in the Phone & Videos application. You can also create a Skype  
If you have a Skype account but have not yet set it up on your device, you  
do not need to create the account again on your device. Simply sign in to  
the account to start using Skype on your device.  
You can also sign in to a Skype account in Accounts (see Use the  
After you create a Skype account, you remain signed in to that account  
and can use it at any time. To sign out of a Skype account, remove it from  
your device (see Edit or delete a Skype account).  
After you sign in to a Skype account, you remain signed in and can use it  
at any time. To sign out of a Skype account, remove it from your device  
1
2
3
4
5
Open Accounts  
.
Tap Add an Account.  
Tap Skype.  
1
2
3
4
5
Open Accounts  
.
Tap Add an Account.  
Tap Create Account.  
Tap Skype.  
If prompted, tap Accept to agree to the account terms and  
conditions.  
Enter your Skype name and password, and tap Sign In.  
Tap Create Account.  
6
Enter the following details:  
Full Name: Enter your full name.  
Skype Name: Enter a name that you will use to identify yourself to  
other Skype users.  
Password: Enter a password and then enter it again.  
View and work with notifications  
Email Address: Enter your email address and then enter it again.  
Notifications show up at the top of the screen to notify you of new  
messages, upcoming appointments, application updates, and more.  
Some notifications also display app controls, such as music playback  
controls, when you are not in the app itself.  
7
8
Tap Create Account. On the next screen tap Create Account again.  
Tap Done.  
Chapter 4 : Work with applications  
43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
There are several kinds of notifications:  
Pop-up notification: This is a larger notification that you can act on right  
away. Examples of pop-up notifications are calendar appointment  
notifications, incoming phone calls, and alarms.  
Banner alert: This is a notification that appears in a small strip at the top  
of the screen. Some banner alerts appear as confirmation of an action—  
for example, that the battery is charging. Others notify you of an item you  
can act on—for example, an incoming email message. For these alerts, if  
you do not tap the alert after a few seconds, it becomes an icon in the  
upper-right portion of the screen. Tap the top of the screen or drag down  
over the icons to display the alerts as dashboard items.  
Dashboard item: The dashboard provides an expanded view of all  
notifications you can act on. For example, you can tap an app update  
notification to open Software Manager.  
NOTE By default, if a banner alert or pop-up notification arrives when the  
screen is off, the Center button blinks. You can turn this feature off (see Get  
App controls: If you are listening to songs in Music and leave the app, the  
music playback controls remain displayed at the top of the screen. This  
lets you continue to manage music playback without having to go back  
into the app.  
If the dashboard item has a number next to it, the number indicates how  
many items are included in the notification—how many email messages  
you have, and so on.  
Create and work with favorites  
Some dashboard items enable you to perform multiple actions. For  
example:  
You can quickly view and reach your closest contacts by designating them  
as favorites. Creating a favorite from a contact lets you view and touch  
base with that contact in just a few taps.  
On a calendar dashboard item, tap the calendar icon to open  
Calendar in Day view with the event displayed, or tap the event name  
to open the event details screen.  
If an item’s icon displays a number, tap the icon to open the associated  
app to the list view (such as an Email inbox), or tap the item itself to  
open that individual item (such as an email message).  
You can create and manage favorites in Contacts (see Create a favorite)  
and in Phone & Video Calls (see Create a favorite in Phone & Video  
Calls).  
To delete a dashboard item, swipe from left to right to throw it off the right  
side of the screen. If the notifications are stacked, swipe from the leftmost  
(“bottom”) notification to dismiss all the notifications, or swipe on a single  
notification to dismiss just that one and display the next one in the stack.  
You can view favorites in the following apps:  
Phone & Video Calls: To see all your favorites, tap Favorites at the top of  
the screen. In your call history list, calls to and from favorites are noted by  
44  
Chapter 4 : Work with applications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
a star. If you enter a contact name to call a contact, matching favorites  
appear at the top of the search results list and are noted by a star.  
Contacts: See all your favorites by tapping Favorites on the contacts list  
screen. On your complete contacts list, favorites are noted by a star.  
Just Type: When you enter a search term, matching favorites appear at  
the top of the contacts search results and are noted by a star.  
Email and Messaging: When you begin typing a contact name to address  
a message, matching favorites appear grouped at the top of the search  
results list and are noted by a star.  
Chapter 4 : Work with applications  
45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
46  
Chapter 4 : Work with applications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5 Copy files and sync your personal data  
IMPORTANT All files that you store on the USB drive of your device are not  
backed up to your HP webOS Account, and they cannot sync to any of your  
online accounts. So be sure to keep a copy of all such files somewhere besides  
your device just in case you lose your device or you must do a full erase of the  
info on your device.  
BEFORE YOU BEGIN Before you copy files from your computer, make sure  
you have enough storage space on your device to fit the files. Open  
Device Info  
and look at the Available field under Device.  
Copy files between your device and your  
computer  
You can't use any applications on your device while you are in USB Drive  
mode.  
1
2
Connect your device to your computer using the USB cable.  
Copy files and folders using USB Drive mode  
On your device, tap USB Drive. On your computer, your device  
appears as a removable drive.  
You can copy any type of file from a computer to your device, and from  
your device to your computer, by putting your device in USB Drive mode.  
In this mode, your device appears as a removable hard drive to your  
desktop computer. For computer system requirements for using USB Drive  
3
4
On a Windows computer, if the Found New Hardware wizard  
opens, click Cancel to close the wizard.  
Open My Computer (Windows XP), Computer (Windows Vista/  
Windows 7), or the Finder (Mac); double click the drive representing  
your device; and drag and drop files to your device. The drive  
displays folders that you can use to organize the files you copy. You  
can also create your own folders.  
After you copy a file to your device, you can open the file if your device  
has an application that supports the file type. You can open many file  
formats for photos, videos, and music; Microsoft Office files; and PDF  
files. You can also copy ringtones that you download from your  
computer’s web browser.  
Chapter 5 : Copy files and sync your personal data  
47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
5
6
End the connection safely. If you do not eject safely, your device  
resets, and may experience data loss, when you disconnect the USB  
cable:  
Sync your device with HP Play on your computer  
If you have HP Play installed on your computer, you can sync your device  
with your computer to copy music files from the HP Play library on your  
computer to the Music app on your device. See Use HP Play to sync music  
On a Windows computer, right click the drive representing your  
device and click Eject.  
On a Mac computer, from your desktop, drag the drive  
representing your device to the Trash. Trash changes to Eject.  
Copy music, photos, and videos using third-party software  
Disconnect the USB cable from the computer when the USB drive  
screen is no longer displayed on your device.  
Besides using USB Drive mode to copy your photos, videos, and DRM-free  
music between your computer and your device, you may also be able to  
use solutions available from third-party software developers (sold  
separately) that facilitate the transfer of media files to your device. For  
more information, open the browser on your computer and go to  
hpwebos.com/sync-solutions to see if there are third-party applications  
that enable you to sync your device with your computer.  
Delete files and folders using USB Drive mode  
You can't use any applications on your device while you are in USB Drive  
mode.  
1
2
Connect your device to your computer using the USB cable.  
KEY TERM DRM-free: Describes a file that is not protected by Digital Rights  
Management. DRM-free files can be copied as many times as you like and can  
be played on your HP TouchPad.  
On your device, tap USB Drive. On your computer, your device  
appears as a removable drive.  
3
4
On a Windows computer, if the Found New Hardware wizard  
opens, click Cancel to close the wizard.  
Overview: Get your personal data onto your  
device  
Open My Computer (Windows XP), Computer (Windows Vista/  
Windows 7), or Finder (Mac); double click the drive representing  
your device; and delete the files or folders.  
5
End the connection safely. If you do not eject safely, your device  
resets, and may experience data loss, when you disconnect the USB  
cable:  
Your personal data consists of the following:  
Your contact list (names, phone numbers, street and email addresses)  
Your calendar events  
Your memos/notes  
On a Windows computer, right click the drive representing your  
device and click Eject.  
On a Mac computer, from your desktop, drag the drive  
On your computer, you typically store such personal data in organizer  
software like Microsoft Outlook, Palm Desktop by ACCESS, or the Mac’s  
iCal and Address Book software.  
representing your device to the Trash. Trash changes to Eject.  
6
Disconnect the USB cable from the computer and the device when  
the USB drive screen is no longer displayed on your device.  
48  
Chapter 5 : Copy files and sync your personal data  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
It’s also likely that you store some personal data in accounts that you  
created on the web. These are called online accounts. Sometimes you’ll  
hear that data stored in online accounts is stored “in the cloud.” That’s just  
another way to say that your data is stored on a server that you access  
through the Internet. For example, if you have a Google/Gmail or a  
Yahoo! account, you have a contact list stored in the cloud. You may even  
use the calendars in these accounts to keep track of your schedule, so you  
may also have calendar events stored in the cloud.  
NOTE Data that you store in your HP webOS Account cannot be accessed  
anywhere but on your device. HP webOS Account data is backed up daily. No  
one, not even you, can see that data.  
For further information about getting personal data onto your device, see  
What do we recommend? We recommend that you set up a Google  
account and move your contacts and calendar data to the cloud. That  
way, you can access, create, and change your data on your device; in  
your Google online account; and, if you have one, on a webOS  
smartphone. The remaining personal data that you create on your  
device—memos—are automatically backed up as part of your HP webOS  
Account.  
Finally, you may have data stored in an HP webOS Account that you use  
with a webOS smartphone.  
You want to be able to access all this data on your device. This section  
explains how you can do that. The actual how-to part of getting your  
personal data on your device is pretty simple. But before you take that  
step, we recommend that you spend some time thinking about where you  
want your personal data to be stored and how you want to access it.  
Use the following table to review your options. Then click the link to learn  
how to complete the solution you choose for your personal data.  
On your device and in the cloud: You can set up a sync relationship  
between your device and an online account in the cloud. This enables  
you to create and change data in one place—on your device or in the  
online account—and have it show up in both places.  
These solutions are not mutually exclusive. Do what works best for you.  
You could potentially use all these solutions. You could, for example, sync  
several online accounts, including an Exchange account; sync data with a  
desktop organizer using a third-party solution; and store and create new  
data in your HP webOS Account.  
On your device and on your computer: You may be able to set up a sync  
relationship between your device and selected desktop organizers.  
Different kinds of sync relationships may be possible using third-party  
solutions (if available). These would enable you to create and change  
data in one place—on your device or in the desktop organizer—and  
have it show up in both places.  
On your device only: Store and create contact and calendar data in your  
HP webOS Account. It’s backed up to your HP webOS Account in the  
cloud. You cannot create, change, or look at your HP webOS Account  
data except on your device.  
Chapter 5 : Copy files and sync your personal data  
49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table 1. Data transfer and synchronization solutions for HP webOS devices  
My personal data is here  
I want to access data here  
Do this  
Learn how here  
Online account (Google,  
Yahoo!, Facebook, and so on)  
My device and my online  
account  
Set up the online account on your device.  
Corporate Exchange account  
My device and Outlook/other  
corporate email app on my  
computer  
Set up an online account for Exchange on your device.  
Desktop organizer software—  
and I want to keep using it  
My device and my desktop  
organizer  
Set up a sync relationship between the device and your  
desktop organizer using a third-party solution (if available). organizer and your device  
Desktop organizer software and My device and maybe  
I want to stop using it elsewhere  
Export your personal data to files on your computer and  
import the data from there to either a Yahoo! or Google  
account. Then set up the online account on your device.  
An existing HP webOS Account My device and my webOS  
that I am using on a webOS  
smartphone  
When setting up your device, instead of creating a new HP See Transfer data from an  
smartphone  
webOS Account, sign in to your existing one.  
Nowhere—I just want personal  
data on my device  
My device  
Create new contacts and new calendar events in your HP  
webOS Account.  
Transfer data from an existing HP webOS  
Account  
Get data from an online account in the cloud  
When setting up your device, you can choose to sign in to an existing HP  
webOS Account that you may already be using with a webOS  
smartphone (see What is an HP webOS Account?). If you decide to sign  
in to an existing account, you can choose to do a one-time transfer of the  
data stored in the existing HP webOS Account to your device.  
NOTE If you use the same HP webOS Account with two devices, after the  
one-time data transfer, info you enter into the HP webOS Account on one device  
is not synchronized between the devices. You need to enter the info in both  
places.  
50  
Chapter 5 : Copy files and sync your personal data  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
If you are already using Google, Facebook, Yahoo!, LinkedIn, and/or  
Exchange to manage your calendar and contacts, then all you need to do  
to sync data to your device is set up one or more of these accounts on  
your device. The data syncs automatically. See Manage online accounts  
for information on how to create an online account on your device.  
Both choices require you to use a third-party solution (sold separately). Go  
to hpwebos.com/sync-solutions to see if third--party solutions are  
available for your device. If there are no solutions available for your  
device, check with the developers of existing sync software for other  
webOS devices to see if they are developing a solution for your device.  
Table 2. Online account sync table  
Sync directly with your desktop organizer  
Set up your HP TouchPad to  
sync with...  
To sync this data...  
Google  
Contacts and calendar events  
Contacts and calendar events  
Contacts and calendar events  
Contacts and calendar events  
Contacts  
Exchange  
Yahoo!  
Facebook  
LinkedIn  
NOTE Changes you make in your Yahoo!, Facebook, or LinkedIn account on  
the web show up on your device. There's nothing you have to do. You can  
change Yahoo! or Facebook contacts and calendar events, and LinkedIn  
contacts, on your device, but the changes you make, or any new data you add,  
are not synced to the account on the web.  
If you prefer to sync your HP TouchPad directly to your computer without  
going through the web, using Wi-Fi, Bluetooth technology, or your  
device’s USB cable, you may be able to download a third-party  
application (sold separately) that enables synchronization of your device  
directly to your desktop.  
1
2
Go to hpwebos.com/sync-solutions to see if there are third-party  
applications that enable you to sync your device with your computer.  
Sync your desktop organizer and your device  
Follow the instructions given by the third-party vendor to install the  
app on your computer.  
If you want to continue using a desktop organizer to store your contacts  
and calendar events—iCal and Address Book on the Mac, or desktop  
Outlook® or Palm Desktop by ACCESS on Windows, and if there are  
third-party solutions available for your device—you may have two  
choices:  
NOTE You may also have to install another part of the application on your  
device. Follow the instructions of the third-party vendor.  
Sync directly with your desktop organizer, avoiding the web completely.  
Sync your desktop organizer with Google on the web, and then sync  
Google with your device.  
Chapter 5 : Copy files and sync your personal data  
51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Sync your desktop organizer to Google, and Google to your  
device  
Export data from a desktop organizer on your  
computer  
You can use the Data Export Wizard (DEW) to do a one-time, one-way  
export of data from Palm Desktop or Microsoft Outlook to files on your  
computer. You can then import these files to a Yahoo! or Google account  
online using the import options available in these accounts on the web.  
When the online account is added to your device, your personal data is  
available there.  
Table 3. DEW data export table  
Export this data from a desktop To import to this account...  
organizer...  
You may be able to download and install a third-party application (sold  
separately) that can sync your desktop app to Google. Your desktop app  
syncs with your Google account, and your device also syncs with Google.  
Contacts and/or calendar  
events  
Google  
Contacts and/or calendar  
events  
Yahoo!  
1
2
3
On your computer, set up an account on the Google website if you  
don't already have one (go to gmail.com).  
To download the DEW, and for more information, go to hpwebos.com/  
dew.  
Set up your Google account on your device. See Manage online  
Install a third-party application on your computer that enables you to  
sync with Google. Go to hpwebos.com/sync-solutions to see if there  
are third-party sync solutions available for your device.  
4
Follow the instructions given by the third-party vendor to sync the  
data in your desktop app with Google. The next time Google syncs  
with your device, your data appears on your device.  
52  
Chapter 5 : Copy files and sync your personal data  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
6 Email, text, multimedia, and instant messaging  
The HP Synergy feature (see Your HP TouchPad) provides another  
advantage: During the same process you go through to set up an email  
account, you also set up the same account for all other applications that  
can display data from that account. For details on how Synergy works for  
the current list of online accounts, see Online accounts available for  
For example, suppose you want to set up your Gmail account on your  
device. The last step in the setup is to select all the other apps that you  
want to receive data from your Google account (besides Email, you can  
include Contacts, Messaging, Calendar, and Documents). After setup is  
complete, your device begins to download your email and all data for all  
other apps you selected for synchronization.  
Email  
How do I send and receive email on my device?  
Use the Email application on your device to access the many email  
accounts you have: company (like Exchange), ISP (like Earthlink or  
Comcast), and web-based (like Gmail). You must create the account  
online before you can set it up on your device.  
If you want, you can also use your device’s web browser to view your  
web-based email—just go to the email provider’s website.  
You can set up your email accounts in either of these locations. The  
procedure is the same in both locations.  
Merged inboxes in Email  
You can set up multiple email accounts on your device. When you open  
Email, you see all your accounts in a single view on the Account List  
panel. From there, you can open the inbox of an individual account, or  
you can open the All Inboxes smart folder and see all messages from all  
your inboxes displayed in a merged view.  
The Email app  
Chapter 6 : Email, text, multimedia, and instant messaging  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
53  
     
Email Account and go to step 3, or tap Find more to find an app  
for an account type that is not listed and follow the instructions  
onscreen.  
If you have already set up an account that takes advantage of the  
Synergy feature and want to set up another one, tap Add account,  
and tap an account type or tap Email Account.  
Any other time you open Email, open the application menu, tap  
Preferences & Accounts, tap Add Account, and tap an account  
type or tap Email Account.  
If you have already set up an account that takes advantage of the  
Synergy feature and you want to use that account, tap Go. You are  
done!  
1 Number to the right of All Inboxes indicates the total number of unread email messages  
in all your email accounts.  
2 Number to the right of an individual folder name indicates the number of unread  
messages in that folder.  
3
4
Enter your email address and password, and tap Sign In.  
Depending on the account, you may be presented with options for  
which apps should download data from that account. For each app,  
tap On or Off, and then tap Create account.  
If you reply to a message when you’re working in All inboxes, the  
message is sent from the same account in which it was received. To reply  
from a different account, tap the From field and tap a different account to  
send the email from.  
5
Tap Go.  
NOTE If automatic setup fails for your email account, an error message  
appears. Tap Manual Setup or Find a Synergy Service, gather the settings info  
you need, and enter the account settings (see Set up email when automatic  
If you create a new message when you’re working in All Inboxes, the  
message goes out using the account you set as the default account (see  
Set up email  
Set up email: Microsoft Exchange and Lotus Notes  
Follow this procedure if you have a common email provider, for example,  
AOL, EarthLink, or Yahoo!. If you are setting up the Email application to  
work with your corporate email account that uses Microsoft Exchange  
ActiveSync or Lotus Notes, see Set up email: Microsoft Exchange and  
Follow this procedure to get email for Microsoft Exchange and Lotus  
Notes accounts.  
BEFORE YOU BEGIN Get this info from your email provider or system  
administrator:  
1
2
Open Email  
.
Mail server name or IP address for receiving mail  
Server domain name  
Do one of the following:  
Your username and password  
If you have not set up an account in another app that takes  
advantage of the Synergy feature, tap an account type or tap  
54  
Chapter 6 : Email, text, multimedia, and instant messaging  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Set up email when automatic setup fails  
NOTE If your corporate Exchange system utilizes policies such as remote wipe  
and password enforcement (including minimum password length, allowed  
number of failed password attempts, and other parameters), those policies are  
supported in your Exchange account on your device. Check with your system  
administrator for details.  
Follow these steps if automatic setup (see Set up email) does not work for  
your email account.  
BEFORE YOU BEGIN Get this info from your email provider or system  
administrator:  
1
2
Open Email  
.
Account type (POP or IMAP)  
Do one of the following:  
Incoming and outgoing mail server names  
Incoming mail server username and password  
Incoming and outgoing server port numbers  
Any SSL requirements for incoming and/or outgoing mail  
Any authentication (ESMTP) requirements for outgoing mail  
Root folder (IMAP accounts only)  
If you have not set up an account in another app that takes  
advantage of the Synergy feature, tap Microsoft Exchange.  
If you have already set up an account that takes advantage of the  
Synergy feature and want to set up another one, tap Add account,  
and tap Microsoft Exchange.  
Any other time you open Email, open the application menu, tap  
Preferences & Accounts, tap Add Account, and then tap Microsoft  
Exchange.  
1
If you have already started account setup and an “Unable To Sign  
In” message appears, tap Manual Setup, and skip to step 6.  
Otherwise, start at step 2.  
3
4
Enter your email address and password, and tap Manual Setup.  
2
3
Open Email  
.
Enter info for the incoming mail server as needed, based on the  
server information you got from your email provider or system  
administrator. You can enter either the server name or IP address in  
the Incoming Mail Server Domain field.  
Do one of the following:  
If you have not set up an account in another app that takes  
advantage of the Synergy feature, tap Email Account.  
5
Tap Sign In.  
If you have already set up an account that takes advantage of the  
Synergy feature and want to set up another one, tap Add account,  
and then tap Email Account.  
Any other time you open Email, open the application menu, tap  
Preferences & Accounts, tap Add Account, and then tap Email  
Account.  
To keep your Exchange account secure, you may be asked to set a  
password or PIN that is required to unlock the device. Tap Set Pin or  
Set Password. Enter a PIN or password and tap Done.  
6
7
You may be presented with options for which apps should download  
data from that account. For each app, tap On or Off, and then tap  
Create account.  
4
5
6
Enter your email address and password, and tap Manual Setup.  
Tap the Account Type field and tap your account type.  
Tap Go.  
Enter info for the incoming and outgoing mail server as needed,  
based on the server information you got from your system  
administrator.  
Chapter 6 : Email, text, multimedia, and instant messaging  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
55  
   
7
8
Tap Sign In.  
Sync deleted emails (POP accounts only): Set whether messages  
should be deleted on the server when you delete them on your  
device.  
Depending on the account, you may be presented with options for  
which apps should download data from that account. For each app,  
tap On or Off, and then tap Create account.  
Sync server to device (POP accounts only): Set whether messages  
should be deleted on your device when they are deleted on the  
server.  
9
Tap Go.  
Default Folders (IMAP accounts only): Specify the folder where  
messages you send, save as drafts, or delete are stored.  
Enter advanced account settings  
Change login settings: See Change account login settings.  
Remove from App: See Delete an email account.  
These settings apply only to the account you select in step 3.  
1
2
3
4
Open Email  
.
5
Tap Done, and tap Done again to exit Preferences & Accounts.  
Open the application menu and tap Preferences & Accounts.  
Tap the account name.  
Turn new email notifications on/off  
Set any of the following:  
The settings you select here apply to individual email accounts. You can  
apply different settings to each email account.  
Account Name: Enter the name that appears in the account list.  
Full Name: Enter the name you want to appear in the From field for  
1
2
3
4
5
Open Email  
.
messages you send.  
Open the application menu and tap Preferences & Accounts.  
Tap an account in Accounts.  
Show Icon: Set whether a notification icon appears onscreen when a  
new message arrives.  
Alert: When Show Icon is on, set whether a sound plays when a  
new message arrives (see Turn new email notifications on/off).  
In Show Icon, tap On or Off.  
Tap Alert, and tap any of the following:  
Signature: Tap to create a signature that’s added to outgoing  
Vibrate: The device vibrates with no other sound.  
System Sound: The system sound plays.  
Reply-to Address: Enter the address you want recipients to see and  
reply to on your outgoing messages, if this is different from the email  
address you send the message from.  
Ringtone: Tap Select Ringtone, and tap a ringtone name. To hear the  
ringtone, tap  
ringtone, tap  
to the right of its name. To add a song as a  
, tap the song, and tap the song again.  
Show Email: Set how many days’ worth of messages to retrieve from  
the server.  
Mute: No sound plays and the device does not vibrate.  
Get Email: Set how frequently to synchronize email for this account.  
56  
Chapter 6 : Email, text, multimedia, and instant messaging  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
3
4
Tap the account name.  
Change account login settings  
Tap Remove Account and tap Remove Account again to confirm.  
When you change your password for an online email account, remember  
to make the change in the account settings on your device.  
Work with panels in Email  
1
2
3
4
Open Email  
.
Open the application menu and tap Preferences & Accounts.  
When the Email app opens, there are three panels visible on the screen.  
For information about hiding and resizing these panels, see Resize  
Tap the account name.  
Tap Change login settings and tap the relevant fields to change the  
account information.  
Create and send an email message  
1
2
Open Email  
.
Rename an account  
Tap at the bottom of the message list panel.  
You can change the name that appears in the account list.  
TIP If you have set up an email account, you can also start writing an email from  
Card view. Tap Just type and start typing a message. Scroll down the list of  
search options, and tap New Email. The Email application opens at a new  
email message, with the text you entered in the body of the message.  
1
2
3
4
5
Open Email  
.
Open the application menu and tap Preferences & Accounts.  
Tap the account name.  
3
4
(Optional) Tap the From field to change the email account you are  
using to send the message. This option appears only if you have  
more than one email account set up on your device.  
Tap Account Name and enter a new name.  
Tap Done, and tap Done again to exit Preferences & Accounts.  
Tap the To field, and do one of the following to address the  
message:  
Delete an email account  
Enter a contact name, initials, or email address. Tap the email  
address when it appears. When you enter a contact name,  
favorites appear at the top of the search results (see Create a  
When you delete an email account from your device, it removes the  
account information from your device only. It does not affect your account  
with the email provider.  
Tap  
to open the full contact list. Tap the contact you want, or  
enter a name or address to narrow the list.  
1
2
Open Email  
.
Enter the full email address for a recipient who is not a contact.  
Open the application menu and tap Preferences & Accounts.  
Chapter 6 : Email, text, multimedia, and instant messaging  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
57  
             
Save a message as a draft  
TIP To address an email directly from Card view, tap Just type and begin typing  
the email address. If the email address is already associated with a contact, the  
contact is displayed. Tap the email address. A new email is opened, with the  
address in the To field.  
While composing a message, tap  
, and tap Save As Draft.  
Receive and read email messages  
5
(Optional) Tap To to open the Cc and Bcc fields. Tap any of these  
fields and enter an address.  
The Email application synchronizes messages anytime you open a mail  
folder. It also synchronizes messages on an automatic schedule—the  
default interval depends on the type of account you have (see Enter  
advanced account settings for information on changing the interval).  
6
7
(Optional) Repeat steps 4 and 5 to enter additional addresses.  
Tap the Subject field, enter the subject, and tap Enter. Enter the body  
text.  
Follow these steps to manually retrieve messages.  
8
9
(Optional) To set the priority for the message, tap  
, tap Mark as  
High Priority/Mark as Normal Priority.  
1
2
Open Email  
.
(Optional) To discard a message: Tap  
and tap Discard  
If the folders for the account you want are hidden, tap the account  
name in the left-hand panel to display the folders.  
Message.  
10 Tap Send.  
3
Tap the folder you want to check messages for. If synchronization  
doesn’t start, tap  
.
How can you tell if sync is happening? Look for the animated  
circular movement around the number of messages in the upper-right  
corner of the middle panel.  
Add attachments to a message  
1
2
3
4
5
While composing a message, tap  
Tap Photos, Music, or Documents.  
If required, tap to browse to a file.  
.
4
5
Tap a message in the middle panel to open it (see Work with panels  
(Optional) If the email contains links, phone numbers, or other email  
addresses you can do the following:  
Tap the file name or thumbnail and tap OK.  
To call a number: Tap the number, and tap  
to call it. This  
Repeat steps 1–4 to attach other files.  
feature is available only if your device is connected to a  
compatible HP webOS smartphone or you have a video calling  
account set up on your device (see How can I make and receive  
TIP To remove an attachment you added to an email: Throw the attachment off  
the side of the screen and tap Delete to confirm.  
To send an email: Tap the email address, enter your message, and  
tap Send.  
To go to a web address: Tap it.  
58  
Chapter 6 : Email, text, multimedia, and instant messaging  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To copy a link to a web site: Tap and hold the web address, and  
4
5
(Optional) Depending on the printer you are using, you can set the  
following printer attributes:  
tap Copy URL.  
To copy text in the body of an email so you can paste it into a  
memo or other document: Tap and hold the message text. To  
expand the selection, drag the arrows at the beginning and end of  
the selected text. Tap Copy.  
Number of Copies: Tap 1 and tap the number of copies you want to  
print.  
Color Printing: Tap On to switch color printing from On to Off.  
Tap Print.  
Print an email  
To cancel a print job, tap Cancel while the file is preparing to print,  
BEFORE YOU BEGIN Your device supports printing on all network-capable  
HP printers that support PCL page description language in the local LAN.  
These printers include new HP ePrint-capable printers–Photosmart,  
Officejet, and LaserJet–as well as legacy printers approximately five years  
old or newer. Make sure your printer is turned on and that both your  
device and the printer are connected to your local or corporate wireless  
network. For personal printers, see the instructions that came with your  
printer for information about setting up a printer on a wireless network.  
or while printing is in progress, tap  
the notification, and then tap  
Print Queue.  
at the top of the screen, tap  
to the right of the print job in the  
Open email attachments  
You can receive any kind of file sent to you in email, but you can open an  
attachment only if your device has an application that can open the file  
type.  
1
2
Open the email that you want to print.  
Tap  
at the top of the right-hand panel, or open the application  
To open a single attachment: Tap the attachment name to download the  
attachment. If the attachment is a supported file type (PDF, DOC,  
DOCX, XLS, XLSX, PPT, PPTX, TXT, GIF, PNG, BMP, or JPG), it opens  
automatically.  
menu and tap Print.  
Printers that are available on your current wireless network are  
displayed.  
To open multiple attachments: Tap the list of attachment names to view  
the attachments, and tap an attachment name to open the file.  
3
Do one of the following:  
If this is your first time using a printer on this network: If a list of  
printers is displayed, tap one.  
If you have already used a printer on this network: The last printer  
you used is remembered and is selected. If you want to select  
another printer, scroll down and tap Select Another Printer.  
To set up a printer manually or on a corporate network: Scroll  
down in the list of printers and tap Add a Printer. Tap Enter an IP  
address and enter the IP address of the printer. (Optional) Tap  
Name this printer and enter a name to identify the printer. Tap  
Done.  
Chapter 6 : Email, text, multimedia, and instant messaging  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
59  
   
To play an MP3 file attachment: Tap the attachment name to download  
the attachment. When the attachment has finished downloading, tap  
the attachment name to play. Tap the progress indicator to pause, and  
tap it again to resume playing. MP3 files you download from Email are  
not saved to USB storage, and they are not listed in Music.  
Add a contact from an email message  
You can add a contact name or email address to your Contacts list  
directly from the header or from the To or Cc field of an incoming email  
message. You can either create a new contact or add the information to  
an existing contact.  
Save attachments  
1
2
Do one of the following in a message you’ve received:  
To add a contact from the message header: Tap the name or  
email address in the header.  
To add a contact from the To or Cc field: Tap To and tap an email  
address in the list of recipients.  
You can save any attachment to your device. If an attachment is  
supported by an application on your device, you can view it at any time  
from that application.  
1
2
Open the email containing the attachment.  
Do one of the following:  
Tap one of the following:  
Add New Contact: Create a new contact for the name or address.  
If only one file is attached: Tap and hold the attachment file name  
Add to Existing: Tap the contact you want to add the name or  
address to.  
and tap Save Attachment.  
If there is more than one attachment and you want to save one of  
them: Tap the attachments, tap and hold the attachment you want  
to save, and tap Save Attachment.  
View and edit a contact from an email message  
If there is more than one attachment and you want to save all of  
them: Tap the attachments, tap and hold one of them, and tap  
Save All Attachments.  
In a message you’ve received from someone listed in the Contacts app,  
tap the name in the message header to open the contact entry. Tap Edit  
Contact to edit the contact in Contacts. Tap Done to save your changes.  
3
To open a saved attachment on your device, open the application  
that can display the attachment. The attachment appears in the list of  
available files. Tap the file to open it.  
Search for an email message  
Save an inline image  
You can search for messages in any email folder. Incoming messages  
must be fully downloaded to your device to show up in search results.  
If a message contains an inline image—an image inserted right into the  
body text—in JPG, BMP, or PNG format, you can save it to and view it in  
the Photos & Videos app.  
Do one of the following:  
In Card view, tap Just type, and type a few characters of a name, email  
address, or subject of an email. Tap Email, scroll to find the email you  
want, and tap to open it.  
Tap and hold the image file name, and then tap Copy To Photos (if  
available).  
60  
Chapter 6 : Email, text, multimedia, and instant messaging  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Open Email  
, and open the folder containing the message. Tap  
Copy messages  
Search; type a name, email address, or subject line of a message  
you're looking for; and tap  
.
You can copy the body text of a message.  
1
2
Open a message, and tap and hold the message text.  
Reply to a message  
To expand the selection, drag the arrows at the beginning and end  
of the selected text.  
1
2
Open a message.  
3
Tap Copy.  
Tap one of the following:  
: Reply to just the sender.  
Move a message to another folder  
: Reply to the sender and all other addressees.  
Enter the reply message text and tap Send.  
Do one of the following:  
3
To move a single message: Open a message, tap  
folder you want.  
, and tap the  
Forward a message  
To move more than one message: Tap  
at the bottom of the message  
list panel, tap the messages you want to move or tap Select All. Tap  
1
2
Open a message and tap  
.
and tap the folder you want.  
Address the forwarded message (see Create and send an email  
message).  
Mark a message as read or unread  
3
Enter the forwarded message text and tap Send.  
1
2
Open a message.  
Tap Mark as Read/Unread.  
Show or hide message recipients  
You can show all recipients in the To or Cc fields of an email you  
received.  
Mark all messages in a folder as read  
1
2
Open a folder.  
1
2
Open a message.  
Open the application menu, tap Mark All As Read.  
Tap the To field to show all recipients.  
Chapter 6 : Email, text, multimedia, and instant messaging  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
61  
   
Flag or unflag a message  
TIP If you change the folder where you store deleted messages for an IMAP  
account (see Enter advanced account settings), deleting messages from the  
folder removes them from your device.  
When you flag a message, a  
messages list. You might flag a message to highlight it at the top of  
Account List view as something that you need to return to.  
is placed beside the message in the  
Do one of the following:  
Add a signature to outgoing messages  
To flag a single message: Open a message and tap  
.
A signature includes information you want to add to the closing of all your  
outgoing messages—for example, your name, address, and phone  
numbers; your website; or a personal motto. You can use a different  
signature for each email account.  
To flag more than one message: Tap  
at the bottom of the message  
list panel, tap the messages you want to flag or tap Select All, and tap  
.
To remove a flag, open a message, and tap  
.
1
2
3
4
5
Open Email  
.
Open the application menu and tap Preferences & Accounts.  
Tap the account you want.  
TIP You can set a preference to show all flagged emails in a single folder,  
called All Flagged, at the top of the Account List panel (see Set email  
Tap the Signature field and enter the signature text.  
Tap Done, and then tap Done again.  
Delete a message  
Deleting a message moves it to your deleted items folder, so it’s still on  
your device. Depending on your email account, this folder is called  
Deleted Items, Deleted, Trash, or something else.  
Show or hide folders in the Accounts List panel  
The Accounts List panel contains expandable folders for Favorites and  
each of your email accounts. The Favorites folder gives you quick access  
to the inbox for each of your accounts. By default, it also contains a folder  
called All Inboxes, which contains a merged view of all your inboxes. You  
can also set a preference to add a folder called All Flagged under  
Favorites to display all your flagged messages in a single folder. To add  
or remove the All Inboxes or All Flagged folders from Favorites, see Set  
email preferences. To add any other email folder to Favorites, see Add an  
Do one of the following:  
In the message list: Throw the message off the side of the screen and  
tap Delete.  
In an open message: Tap  
and tap Delete.  
To avoid deleting a message accidentally, you can turn the Delete  
Confirmation preference on (see Set email preferences). If you do  
accidentally delete a message, you can move it back to the original folder  
(see Move a message to another folder). To remove a message from your  
device permanently, delete it from the deleted items folder. To delete all  
messages from the deleted items folder, open the application menu while  
in the folder, tap Empty Trash, and then tap Empty Trash again.  
1
2
3
Open Email  
Tap to the right of Favorites or an account name.  
Tap the folder name you want to open.  
.
62  
Chapter 6 : Email, text, multimedia, and instant messaging  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
4
(Optional) Open the application menu and tap About This Folder to  
view information such as last sync and number of messages.  
Accounts: Tap an account name to enter advanced settings or to  
change synchronization settings for email, contacts, or calendar  
account).  
Add Account: See Set up email.  
Default Account: Tap the account shown and then tap the account  
you want to set as the new default. The default account is used to  
send a message when you create a new message in the Account List  
panel or in a merged folder such as All Inboxes or All Flagged.  
5
Tap  
to hide the folders under Favorites or an account name.  
4
Tap Done.  
Add an email folder as a favorite  
Reply to meeting invitations  
Favorites appear at the top of Account List panel.  
You receive meeting invitations on your device in the same way that you  
receive email messages. You cannot create meeting invitations on your  
device.  
1
2
Open Email  
.
If the folder you want is not displayed, tap  
email account name to display the folder.  
to the right of the  
Tap to accept, tentatively accept, or decline an invitation.  
Here are the key features of meeting invitations:  
3
Tap  
to the right of the folder name.  
To remove a folder as a favorite, repeat steps 1 and 2 and tap  
right of the folder name.  
to the  
Meeting invitations appear on your device in the Email application, not  
in the Calendar application.  
From within the Email application, you can accept, decline, or  
tentatively accept a meeting invitation.  
If you accept or tentatively accept an invitation, it appears as an event  
in Calendar.  
You can reply to and forward meeting invitations in the same way as  
email messages.  
Set email preferences  
1
2
3
Open Email  
.
Open the application menu and tap Preferences & Accounts.  
Set any of the following:  
TIP If you receive an updated meeting invitation, you can again choose to  
accept, decline, or tentatively accept. If you receive a meeting cancellation,  
open the message and tap Remove From Calendar to delete the meeting from  
your calendar.  
Smart Folders: Set whether to include All Inboxes and/or All  
Flagged messages as favorites at the top of the Account List panel.  
Delete Confirmation: Tap to turn this setting On/Off. When Delete  
Confirmation is on, you are asked to confirm deletion of email  
messages.  
Chapter 6 : Email, text, multimedia, and instant messaging  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
63  
       
Send email messages from within another application  
Work with conversations  
Use the share feature in any application that supports this to send an item  
as an attachment to an email message. This feature is available in the  
Adobe Reader and Memos applications, among others. Depending on  
the app, this feature may be accessed from a menu that might be named  
Share, Send, or Email, or it might be accessed from an icon. For details,  
see the section in this guide on the specific application.  
When you exchange more than one message with a person, the  
messages are grouped into a conversation. When you start or continue a  
conversation, the upper part of Conversations view displays all messages  
you’ve exchanged with this person, and the bottom part provides the area  
where you type your next message.  
You can carry on multiple conversations at the same time.  
1
2
Open Messaging  
.
Messaging: All messages in one application  
Do one of the following:  
Start a new conversation: Create a message (see Send and  
message and reply to it.  
What kinds of messages can I send and receive?  
You can use the Messaging application to send and receive the following  
types of messages:  
Continue an existing conversation: Tap the conversation.  
3
4
Enter your message.  
Instant messages for an IM account you already have set up online (see  
available only when your device is connected to a Wi-Fi network (see  
Tap Enter.  
Text messages (see Create and send a text message). This feature is  
available only if your device is connected to a compatible HP webOS  
TIP You can copy the contents of a conversation as plain text, which you can  
paste in a memo, email message, and so on (see Copy messages).  
The Synergy feature enables the Messaging app to gather all your  
messages to and from the same contact into a single conversation  
(sometimes called a “thread”). So you can see your entire message  
history with someone regardless of the different methods you happened to  
use to communicate with that person (see Work with conversations). You  
can even switch from account to account (and, if your device is connected  
to a compatible webOS smartphone, from IM to text messaging) without  
losing the thread of your conversation (see Switch between messaging  
accounts in a conversation)—just pick the messaging account that’s most  
likely to keep you in unbroken contact with the person you’re talking to.  
TIP If your device is connected to a compatible webOS smartphone, a single  
conversation can contain text and IM messages (see Connect your device to a  
Switch between Conversations, Buddies, and Favorites lists  
The conversations list shows all of your Messaging conversations, the  
buddies list shows all of your IM buddies, and the favorites list shows all  
contacts that you have added to Favorites.  
1
Open Messaging  
.
64  
Chapter 6 : Email, text, multimedia, and instant messaging  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
2
Do one of the following:  
To see your conversations list: Tap  
.
To see your buddies list: Tap  
To see your favorites list: Tap  
.
.
Search for conversations or buddies  
1
2
Open Messaging  
.
TIP You can set a preference to show all your buddies, whether they are online  
or offline, or to hide offline buddies. Open the application menu and tap Show/  
Hide Offline Buddies.  
Do one of the following:  
To search for conversations: Tap  
, tap Search, and begin  
entering the contact name, IM address, or phone number of the  
person the conversation was with.  
Switch between messaging accounts in a conversation  
To search for buddies: Tap  
the buddy name.  
, tap Search, and begin entering  
In a single conversation, you can switch between text messaging and an  
IM account. So if you are having an IM chat with someone and he or she  
goes offline, you can send the person a text message to wrap up the  
conversation. Text messaging is available only if your device is connected  
to a compatible HP webOS smartphone (see Connect your device to a  
Add a favorite  
1
2
3
Open Messaging  
.
Tap  
and tap Add Favorite.  
1
2
In Messaging, start a new conversation or open one that’s listed in  
Conversations view.  
Tap a contact, or tap Search, begin entering a contact name, and  
tap the contact name.  
Tap the button in the upper-right corner of the screen. This button  
could be labeled Text, Mobile, or an IM account name. If available,  
the other ways to communicate with this contact appear in a list. Tap  
the account or phone number you want to use.  
4
5
Tap a contact.  
(Optional) Tap the contact name to edit the contact details in  
Contacts.  
Chapter 6 : Email, text, multimedia, and instant messaging  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
65  
 
Table 1. Supported emoticons  
Use emoticons in a message  
To display this Enter any of these keyboard character combinations...  
emoticon...  
To include an emoticon in a message, tap  
keyboard, and then tap an emoticon key. Tap  
to display the symbol  
to return to the  
^^ ^_^ ^-^ :grin :biggrin  
alphanumeric keyboard. If the emoticon you want is not available on the  
keyboard, use the table below to add keyboard character combinations  
for other emoticons. To learn about entering symbols and alternate  
characters, see Enter symbols and alternate characters. Most emoticons  
can be created by more than one combination. After you send the  
message, the emoticon image appears in the conversation on your device  
and on the recipient’s device, as long as the receiving IM application  
supports the image.  
<3 :heart  
O:) O:-) o:) o:-) :innocent :angel  
:-* :* =* =-* :kiss  
:-D :D =D =-D :laugh :lol  
>:-) >:) >:-> >:> :evil :twisted  
:| :-| :neutral :meh  
This table shows the emoticons that are supported on your device.  
NOTE Emoticon combinations that use words, such as :cool or :cry, are not  
supported in most messaging applications. Emoticons created using these  
combinations may not appear correctly on the recipient’s device.  
:-& :& =& =-& :-@ :@ =@ =-@ :sick  
:) :-) =) =-) :smile  
Table 1. Supported emoticons  
:/ :-/ :\ :-\ =/ =-/ =\ =-\ :doh  
;) ;-) :wink  
To display this Enter any of these keyboard character combinations...  
emoticon...  
>:o >:-o >:O >:-O >:( >:-( :angry :mad  
:P :-P :p :-p :b :-b =p =P =b =-b =-p  
=-P :yuck :razz  
o_O :confused  
8) 8-) B) B-) :cool  
Forward a message  
:’( =’( :cry  
1
2
3
Open Messaging  
.
:[ :-[ =[ =-[ :redface  
:S :-S :s :-s %-( %( X-( X( :eww :gross  
:! :-! :eek  
In a conversation, tap a message.  
Do one of the following:  
To forward the message through Messaging: Tap Forward, tap the  
To field, and enter the recipient’s IM address or number in the To  
:( :-( =( =-( :sad  
field, or tap  
to search for a contact.  
:O :-O :o :-o =O =-O =o =-o :surprised  
:shock :omg  
66  
Chapter 6 : Email, text, multimedia, and instant messaging  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
To forward the message in an email: Tap Forward Via Email, and  
enter the recipient’s name or email address in the To field, or tap  
to search for a contact.  
Resend a failed message  
A message might fail to be sent if your device is not connected to a Wi-Fi  
network (for IM), or to a webOS smartphone (for text messages), or if it is  
experiencing technical problems. When a message fails to be sent, a  
is displayed beside it.  
4
5
(Optional) Tap the message text, and edit the text.  
Tap Enter to send a message, or tap Send to send an email.  
1
2
Tap the message and tap View Error.  
Copy messages  
Tap Send again. Tap Cancel to close the error message.  
You can copy an individual message as plain text.  
Delete a message  
1
2
3
Open Messaging  
.
1
2
Tap  
to open Conversations view and tap a conversation.  
Tap a conversation.  
Tap a message and tap Delete.  
Tap the message and tap Copy Text.  
Delete a conversation  
Customize messaging notifications  
1
2
Tap  
to open Conversations view and tap a conversation.  
You can set your device to show a notification and/or play a sound when  
a new message arrives. These settings apply to all your Messaging  
accounts.  
If the Delete Conversation button is not visible in the right-hand  
panel, flick down on that panel to scroll to the beginning of the  
conversation.  
1
2
3
4
Open Messaging  
.
3
Tap Delete Conversation.  
Open the application menu and tap Preferences & Accounts.  
In Show Notifications, tap On or Off.  
Messaging: Instant messaging  
When Show Notifications is on, tap Alert, and tap any of the  
following:  
Set up an instant messaging (IM) account  
Vibrate: The device vibrates with no other sound.  
System Sound: The system sound plays.  
Your device supports instant messaging through popular online IM  
services, such as Google Talk and AIM. If you already have an IM  
account, you can sign in through the Messaging app or through the  
account).  
Mute: No sound plays and the device does not vibrate.  
Chapter 6 : Email, text, multimedia, and instant messaging  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
67  
             
The HP Synergy feature (see Your HP TouchPad) provides another  
advantage: During the same process you go through to set up a  
messaging account, you also set up the same account for all other  
applications that can display data from that account. For details on how  
Synergy works for the current list of online accounts, see Online accounts  
Create a Skype account in Messaging  
You do not need to have a Skype account set up before using Skype in  
Messaging—you can set one up directly from Messaging. You can also  
create a Skype account in Accounts (see Use the Accounts application to  
For example, suppose you want to set up your Google Talk account on  
your device. The last step in setup is to select all the other apps that you  
want to receive data from your Google account (besides Messaging, you  
can include Contacts, Calendar, Email, and Documents). After setup is  
complete, your device begins to download your messages and all data  
for all other apps you selected for synchronization.  
1
2
Open Messaging  
.
Do one of the following:  
If you have not set up an account in another app that takes  
advantage of the Synergy feature: Tap Skype.  
If you have already set up an account that takes advantage of the  
Synergy feature and want to set up another one: Tap Add an  
Account and tap Skype.  
1
2
Open Messaging  
.
Do one of the following:  
Any other time: Open the application menu and tap Preferences &  
Accounts. Tap Add an Account and tap Skype.  
If you have not set up an account in another app that takes  
advantage of the Synergy feature: Tap an account type and go to  
step 3, or tap Find more to find an app for an account type that is  
not listed and follow the instructions onscreen.  
If you have already set up an account that takes advantage of the  
Synergy feature and want to set up another one: Tap Add an  
Account.  
3
4
5
Tap Create Account.  
Tap Accept to agree to Skype’s terms and conditions.  
Enter the following details:  
Any other time: Open the application menu and tap Preferences &  
Accounts. Tap Add an Account.  
Full Name: Enter your full name.  
If you have already set up an account that takes advantage of the  
Synergy feature and you want to use that account: Tap Go. You  
are done!  
Skype Name: Enter a name that you will use to identify yourself to  
other Skype users.  
Password: Enter a password and then enter it again.  
Email Address: Enter your email address and then enter it again.  
3
4
5
6
If you are setting up a Skype account, tap Sign In.  
Enter your username and password.  
Tap Sign In.  
6
7
Tap Create Account, and then tap Create Account.  
Tap Done.  
Depending on the account, you may be presented with options for  
which apps should download data from that account. For each app,  
tap On or Off, and then tap Create.  
7
Tap Done.  
68  
Chapter 6 : Email, text, multimedia, and instant messaging  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Sign in to an IM account  
TIP You can include emoticons in your message (see Use emoticons in a  
message).  
1
Open Messaging  
.
4
5
When the message recipient replies, the reply appears below your  
message in the conversation. Repeat step 3 to reply to that person.  
(Optional) If the message contains links, phone numbers, or other  
email addresses you can do the following:  
2
Tap  
to the left of the text Offline and tap Available.  
To call a number: Tap the number, and tap  
. This feature is  
available only if your device is connected to a compatible HP  
webOS smartphone or you have a video calling account set up on  
To add a number to Contacts: Tap the number, and tap Add to  
Contacts.  
Sign out of an IM account  
1
2
Open Messaging  
.
Tap the status icon to the left of your online status (Available or Busy)  
and tap Offline.  
To send an email: Tap the email address.  
To go to a web address: Tap it.  
Send and receive IM messages  
Add a buddy  
BEFORE YOU BEGIN Make sure that the device is connected to a Wi-Fi  
network).  
To add a buddy to an IM account, you must send a buddy request and be  
accepted as a buddy by the invitee.  
1
2
Open Messaging  
Do one of the following to start or continue a conversation:  
Tap to see your buddies and tap a buddy name. If there’s  
more than one account for that buddy, the most recently used IM  
account is opened. To switch to another IM account, tap the IM  
account name in the upper-right, and tap an IM address.  
.
To send a buddy request:  
1
2
3
Open Messaging  
.
Tap and tap Add Buddy.  
Tap the IM Service field and tap the account in which you want to  
add the buddy.  
Tap  
to see your favorites and tap a favorite.  
Tap  
Tap  
to see your conversations and tap a conversation.  
and tap New Conversation. Tap To, enter an IM address,  
4
Do one of the following:  
and tap Enter, or tap  
to search for a contact.  
To add a Skype buddy: Tap the Buddy Name field, tap Search All  
Skype, enter the name or screen name of the buddy you want to  
3
Tap Enter message here, enter the message text, and tap Enter.  
add, and tap  
. Tap the buddy name.  
Chapter 6 : Email, text, multimedia, and instant messaging  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
69  
       
To add a buddy in any other IM account: Tap the Buddy Name  
field and enter the buddy details required by the account, for  
example, an email address or IM address.  
Delete a buddy  
1
2
3
Open Messaging  
Tap and throw the buddy’s name off the side of the screen.  
Tap Delete.  
.
5
6
(Optional, if available) Tap the Invitation Message field and enter a  
message for your buddy invitee.  
Tap Add Buddy.  
Change your online status  
Receive a buddy request  
1
2
Open Messaging  
.
1
2
3
Open Messaging  
.
Tap the status icon to the left of the status description (Available,  
Busy, or Offline), and tap your new status.  
Tap the conversation containing the invitation.  
Do one of the following:  
Change your custom message  
To accept a buddy request: Tap  
To decline a buddy request: Tap  
.
, and tap Delete.  
Your custom message is seen by your IM buddies. It appears next to your  
IM screen name and status. It can contain any text you want.  
Block a message sender  
1
2
Open Messaging  
.
You can block a person from contacting you by text or IM if you don’t  
want to receive any further messages from them.  
Do one of the following:  
If you already have a custom message, tap the current message  
and enter the new message text.  
If you’re creating a custom message for the first time, tap the status  
text (Available or Busy) and enter the custom message text.  
You cannot, however, block a person if they are on your IM buddy list. To  
block an IM buddy you first need to delete them from your buddy list (see  
1
2
Open Messaging  
.
3
Tap  
.
Tap a conversation with the person you want to block and tap Block  
Sender.  
Change your IM account username and password  
3
Tap Block Sender.  
If you change the username or password for your IM account online, you  
need to enter the updated information for the account on your device.  
1
Open Messaging  
.
70  
Chapter 6 : Email, text, multimedia, and instant messaging  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2
3
4
Open the application menu and tap Preferences & Accounts.  
Tap the account name.  
BEFORE YOU BEGIN The webOS smartphone you are connecting with must  
be discoverable. Check the documentation that came with your  
smartphone for information on making it discoverable.  
Tap a field to enter new information and tap Sign In.  
1
2
3
Open Messaging  
.
Open the application menu and tap Preferences & Accounts.  
Tap Connect Phone and do one of the following:  
Delete an IM account  
1
2
3
4
Open Messaging  
.
If the smartphone you want to connect to is listed in the Devices  
list, tap it.  
If the smartphone you want to connect to is not listed in the  
Devices list, tap Add Device, tap the Type field, and then tap  
webOS Phone. When the smartphone you want to connect to is  
found, tap it.  
Open the application menu and tap Preferences & Accounts.  
Tap the account name.  
Tap Remove Account and tap Remove Account again to confirm.  
Create and send a text message  
Messaging: Text messaging  
BEFORE YOU BEGIN  
Connect your device to a webOS smartphone (see Connect your  
Before you use your device to send or receive text messages, refer to  
your smartphone’s service plan for pricing and availability of text  
messaging.  
IMPORTANT You can view, reply to, and send text messages on your HP  
TouchPad only if the device is connected to a compatible HP webOS  
smartphone. See Connect your device to a webOS smartphone for information.  
Make sure that the smartphone your device is connected to is on and  
that you’re inside a coverage area. See the documentation that came  
with your smartphone for information about turning wireless services  
on.  
Connect your device to a webOS smartphone  
To send and receive text messages on your device, you must use Bluetooth  
to pair and connect your device and a webOS smartphone. You can do  
this manually from the Bluetooth app (see Make a pairing request to  
another device and Connect with a paired device) or, if your device and  
smartphone share the same HP webOS Account, you can use Touch to  
Share to create a Bluetooth connection (see Pair with an HP webOS  
TIP You can also use Just Type to write a text message from Card view. Tap Just  
type and start typing a message. Under Quick Actions, tap New Message. The  
Messaging application opens at a new message, with the text you entered in the  
body of the message.  
1
Open Messaging  
.
You can also make the pairing request or connection from the Messaging  
app.  
Chapter 6 : Email, text, multimedia, and instant messaging  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
71  
         
2
Tap New Conversation. Tap the To field and do one of the following  
to address the message:  
3
(Optional) Do any of the following from the body of the message:  
To call a number: Tap the number, and tap . This feature is  
Enter a contact’s first or last name or initials, screen name, phone  
number, or email address. When you enter a contact name,  
favorites appear at the top of the search results (see Create a  
favorite). Tap the phone number, IM account name, or email  
address you want to use to send the message when it appears.  
available only if your device is connected to a compatible HP  
webOS smartphone or you have a video calling account set up on  
To add a number to Contacts: Tap the number, and tap Add to  
Contacts.  
Tap  
to open your full contact list. Tap the contact you want.  
Enter a phone number for a recipient who is not a contact.  
To send an email: Tap the email address.  
To go to a web address: Tap it.  
Do you need to enter a short code that contains letters—for  
example, to text a vote to a TV poll or to make a donation to a  
charity? Use the keyboard to enter it; just tap the letter keys and  
tap the code that appears under Short Code. This is not the same  
as dialing a number that is expressed as letters—for example,  
(555) 256 TALK. To dial a number like this, you must use the  
Phone app’s dial pad and tap the numbers that correspond to the  
letters T,A,L,K— which would be 8255.  
Add a contact from a text message  
To add a message sender as a contact:  
1
In Conversations view, tap a conversation with someone who is not a  
contact.  
3
4
(Optional) Tap the To field and repeat step 2 to enter additional  
recipients.  
2
3
4
Tap the header at the top of the screen.  
Tap Add to contacts.  
Tap Enter message here, enter the message text, and tap Enter.  
TIP You can include emoticons in your message (see Use emoticons in a  
message).  
Tap one of the following:  
Add New Contact: Create a new contact for the number.  
Add To Existing: Tap the contact you want to add the number to.  
Receive and view text messages  
View a contact’s information from a message  
NOTE If your device is connected to compatible webOS smartphone and you  
receive a message that contains multimedia attachments, such as pictures,  
videos, animated GIFs, music files, or vCards, a notification is displayed, saying  
“New MMS on your phone. You must open the message on your smartphone  
to view the attachment.  
In a conversation, tap the header of a message received from a contact  
to open the contact entry.  
1
2
Open Messaging  
.
Tap a conversation to view messages.  
72  
Chapter 6 : Email, text, multimedia, and instant messaging  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7 Photos, videos, and music  
Work with panels in Photos & Videos  
When the Photos & Videos app opens, there are two panels visible on the  
screen. For information about hiding and resizing these panels, see Resize  
Photos & Videos  
Look at pictures  
To get pictures on the device, you can do any of the following:  
Use Photos & Videos for the first time  
Copy pictures from your computer (see Copy files between your device  
Receive pictures as email attachments (see Open email attachments).  
View pictures downloaded from an online account (see Set up an online  
1
2
Open Photos & Videos  
.
Do one of the following:  
To set up an online account to sync: To set up an account that is  
listed, tap the account type, and go to step 3. To set up an  
account type that is not listed, tap Find more to find an app and  
follow the instructions onscreen.  
To use Photos & Videos without creating an online account: Tap  
Done.  
Copy a picture from a web page (see Work with images on a web  
page).  
The following table shows you the picture formats that you can see on  
your device and the apps you can see them in.  
Table 1. Picture formats viewable on your device  
3
4
Enter the account information, and then tap Sign in.  
Picture format  
View in Photos &  
Videos  
Download from Email  
Depending on the account, you may be presented with options for  
which apps should download data from that account. For each app,  
tap On or Off, and then tap Create Account.  
BMP  
GIF  
(see Note)  
Tap Go.  
JPG  
PNG  
Chapter 7 : Photos, videos, and music  
73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
2
3
Tap an album.  
NOTE You can download and look at GIFs in Email, and they are saved to USB  
storage, but you can't look at GIFs in Photos & Videos or use one as wallpaper.  
Tap the thumbnail of the video you want to watch. Video thumbnails  
are identified with a  
icon.  
You can also look at pictures on the web directly in the web browser (see  
Web).  
Use YouTube to view YouTube videos (see YouTube).  
1
2
Open Photos & Videos  
.
Use video playback controls  
Tap the album containing the picture, and tap the thumbnail of the  
picture.  
Tap the video to manually display or dismiss the playback controls.  
3
4
Swipe left or right on the screen to look at other pictures in the  
album.  
Table 2. Video playback controls  
To return to the album, tap [album name]. Tap the screen if the  
album name button is not visible.  
Control Function  
Play.  
Pause.  
Watch a video  
Move forward or backward (tap and hold the slider, and  
then drag it right to move forward or left to move backward).  
BEFORE YOU BEGIN Before you put videos on your device, make sure you  
have enough storage space on your device to fit the file. Open Device  
Switch between full-screen view and the original size.  
Info  
and look at the Available field under Device.  
To get videos on your device, you can do any of the following:  
Use the volume button on the side of your device to control the sound  
level.  
Copy videos from your computer (see Copy files between your device  
Receive videos as email attachments (see Open email attachments).  
Organize your pictures and videos into albums  
You can view DRM-free videos that you receive as email attachments or  
that you copy from your computer in the MPEG-4, H.263, and H.264  
formats. Videos play on your device in landscape orientation.  
The Photos & Videos app organizes the pictures and videos you add to  
your device into predefined libraries and albums. There are two libraries,  
All Photos & Videos and My TouchPad, each containing several albums.  
The All Photos & Videos library contains all albums on your device,  
including those downloaded from online accounts. Pictures downloaded  
from online accounts are not stored on your device. The My TouchPad  
library contains only albums containing pictures and videos that are  
stored on your device. The following table tells you where to find your  
pictures and videos both in the Photos & Videos app and in your device’s  
USB Drive storage.  
KEY TERM DRM-free: A file that is not protected by Digital Rights Management.  
DRM-free video files can be copied as many times as you like and can be  
played on your HP TouchPad.  
1
Open Photos & Videos  
.
74  
Chapter 7 : Photos, videos, and music  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table 3. Picture and video locations  
Copy pictures or videos to an album  
Origin of pictures or  
videos  
Album in Photos &  
Folder in USB storage  
downloads  
1
2
3
Open Photos & Videos  
.
videos  
Email  
Downloads  
Tap the album containing the pictures or videos.  
Do one of the following:  
Copied from computer Miscellaneous  
Root level of USB  
storage  
Device  
Screen captures  
Wallpapers  
screencaptures  
wallpapers  
To copy more than one picture or video: Tap  
to select all pictures or videos in an album. To remove a file from  
the selection, tap it.  
To copy a single picture or video: Tap the thumbnail of the picture  
or video.  
and tap Select All  
Preinstalled on your  
device  
Online account  
Folder downloaded  
from the online  
account  
Not available in USB  
storage  
4
5
Tap  
. Tap the screen if  
is not visible.  
Copied from another  
album in Photos &  
Videos  
Album created by you Album created by you  
in Photos & Videos in Photos & Videos  
Do either of the following:  
To create a new album: Tap Create New Album, enter the album  
name, and tap Create Album.  
To select an existing album: Tap an album.  
Copied from  
elsewhere  
[Folder created by you [Folder created by you  
in USB storage]  
containing at least  
one BMP, JPG, PNG,  
or MP4]  
Look at pictures in a slideshow  
You can use any picture that is stored on your device as wallpaper (see  
Change your wallpaper). The picture does not have to be in the  
Wallpapers album.  
You can view the pictures in any album as a slideshow.  
You can assign any pictures or videos on your device to one of these  
albums or to an album you create.  
1
2
3
Open Photos & Videos  
.
Tap the album you want to view as a slideshow.  
Do one of the following:  
Create an album  
To start with the first picture in the album: Tap  
.
1
2
3
Open Photos & Videos  
Tap New Album.  
.
To select a different starting point: Tap the picture you want the  
slideshow to start at and tap  
.
4
To exit the slideshow, tap a picture.  
Enter the album name and tap Create Album.  
New albums that you create are added to the All Photos & Videos  
and My TouchPad libraries.  
Chapter 7 : Photos, videos, and music  
75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6
(Optional) Depending on the printer you are using, you can set the  
following printer attributes:  
Print pictures  
BEFORE YOU BEGIN Your device supports printing on all network-capable  
HP printers that support PCL page description language in the local LAN.  
These printers include new HP ePrint-capable printers–Photosmart,  
Officejet, and LaserJet–as well as legacy printers approximately five years  
old or newer. Make sure your printer is turned on and that both your  
device and the printer are connected to your local or corporate wireless  
network. For personal printers, see the instructions that came with your  
printer for information about setting up a printer on a wireless network.  
Number of Copies: Tap 1 and tap the number of copies you want to  
print.  
Size: Tap the current size and tap to select another size. The sizes  
displayed are those that are available on your printer.  
Color Printing: Tap On to switch color printing from On to Off.  
Tap Print.  
7
For more information about working with printers, see Print Manager.  
To cancel a print job, tap Cancel while the file is preparing to print,  
1
2
3
Open Photos & Videos  
.
or while printing is in progress, tap  
the notification, and then tap  
Print Queue.  
at the top of the screen, tap  
to the right of the print job in the  
Tap the album containing the pictures.  
Do either of the following:  
Add a comment to a picture or video in an online account  
To print a single picture: Tap the thumbnail of the picture.  
To print more than one picture: Tap  
and tap Select All to select  
You can add comments to pictures that were downloaded from an online  
account, and you can view comments that have been made by others  
about those pictures.  
all pictures in an album. To remove a file from the selection, tap it.  
4
5
Tap  
. Tap the screen if  
is not visible.  
Printers that are available on your current wireless network are  
displayed.  
1
2
Open Photos & Videos  
.
Tap the album containing the picture or video, and tap a picture or  
video thumbnail.  
Do one of the following:  
If this is your first time using a printer on this network: If a list of  
printers is displayed, tap one.  
If you have already used a printer on this network: The last printer  
you used is remembered and is selected. If you want to select  
another printer, scroll down and tap Select Another Printer.  
3
4
5
Tap  
Tap the comment box and enter a comment.  
Tap to upload your comment. Tap to close the comment box.  
. Tap the screen if  
is not visible.  
To set up a printer manually or on a corporate network: Scroll  
down in the list of printers and tap Add a Printer. Tap Enter an IP  
address and enter the IP address of the printer. (Optional) Tap  
Name this printer and enter a name to identify the printer. Tap  
Done.  
76  
Chapter 7 : Photos, videos, and music  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Set up an online pictures or videos account on your device  
Delete pictures or videos  
To view pictures in an account you have with a web service such as  
Facebook or Snapfish, you must set up the account on your device.  
You can delete pictures and videos that are stored on your device. These  
are displayed in the My TouchPad library. Pictures and videos that were  
downloaded from an online account cannot be deleted from your device.  
To delete these, you must log in to the online account and delete them  
from there.  
DID YOU KNOW? If you set up a Facebook account in the Photos & Videos  
application and you leave “Use account with” Calendar and Contacts turned on  
when setting up the account, your Facebook contacts and calendar events  
appear in the Contacts and Calendar applications on your device also.  
Likewise, if you set up a Facebook account in Contacts, and you accept the  
default options while setting up that account, the account is already set up in  
information about the behavior of Facebook, Snapfish, and other online  
accounts on your device.  
1
2
3
Open Photos & Videos  
Tap the album containing the pictures or videos.  
Tap and do one of the following:  
.
To delete more than one file: Tap Select All to select all pictures or  
videos in an album. To remove files that you do not want to delete  
from the selection, tap the file thumbnails.  
1
2
3
Open Photos & Videos  
.
To delete a single file: Tap a thumbnail.  
Open the application menu and tap Preferences & Accounts.  
4
5
Tap  
.
Tap Add an Account, and tap the type of account you want to add.  
To set up an account type that is not listed, tap Find more to find an  
app and follow the instructions onscreen.  
Tap Delete to confirm.  
4
5
Enter your account username and password and tap Sign In.  
HP Movie Store  
Depending on the account, you may be presented with options for  
which apps should download data from that account. For each app,  
tap On or Off, and then tap Create Account.  
HP Movie Store allows you to buy and rent the latest movies and television  
shows in high definition. Shows are downloaded directly to your device,  
and, once downloaded, can be enjoyed without an Internet connection.  
Delete an online pictures or videos account  
1
2
3
4
Open Photos & Videos  
.
Install HP Movie Store  
Open the application menu and tap Preferences & Accounts.  
Tap the account name.  
1
2
Open HP App Catalog  
.
Tap Search, and type HP Movie Store in the search field.  
Tap Remove Account and tap Remove Account again to confirm.  
Chapter 7 : Photos, videos, and music  
77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
3
4
Tap Free beside the HP Movie Store app.  
HP Movie Store is added to the Downloads page on the Launcher.  
(Optional) Tap Launch.  
Get music onto your device  
To get music onto your device, you can do any of the following:  
Copy music files from your computer (see Copy files between your  
device and your computer). You can copy music files to any folder on  
your device’s USB drive. However, to make it easy to find and manage  
files, consider creating a “Music” folder to store your files.  
Use solutions that may be available from third-party software  
developers (sold separately) that facilitate the transfer of music files to  
your device. For more information about the availability of third-party  
solutions, open the browser on your computer and go to  
YouTube  
Watch a YouTube video  
The YouTube icon on your device takes you to the YouTube website, where  
you can watch videos available online.  
Listen to music files received as email attachments (see Open email  
Sync with HP Play on your computer (see Use HP Play to sync music  
1
2
3
4
Open YouTube  
.
Table 4. Music formats playable on webOS devices  
Enter a search term for a video and tap Enter, or browse to a video.  
Tap the video thumbnail to play the video.  
File format  
Play in Music/Copy to USB  
storage  
Download from Email  
Use the YouTube playback controls to interact with the video.  
AAC  
(see Note)  
(see Note)  
(see Note)  
(see Note)  
(see Note)  
(see Note)  
(see Note)  
AAC+  
eAAC+  
AMR  
MP3TM  
QCELP  
WAV  
Music  
You can add and listen to DRM-free music files on your device. You can  
listen to music through the stereo speakers on your device (see Front view)  
or through headphones (sold separately). If you have speakers or a stereo  
headset (both sold separately) that are equipped with Bluetooth® wireless  
technology, you can also use them to listen to music. You can also listen to  
streaming music from the web directly in the web browser (see Web).  
NOTE Depending on how the sender’s email server has configured the  
attached music file, you may be able to download and listen to any of the listed  
file types in Email, but files you play Email are not saved to USB storage. To  
save an attachment to USB storage, tap and hold the attachment name, and tap  
Save Attachment. QCELP and AMR files are not listed in Music.  
KEY TERM DRM-free: A file that is not protected by Digital Rights Management.  
DRM-free music files can be copied as many times as you like and can be  
played on your HP TouchPad.  
78  
Chapter 7 : Photos, videos, and music  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
To listen to an album: Tap Albums and tap the album name. Tap  
the first song.  
Show/hide the Library or Playlist lists  
To listen to all songs in a genre: Tap Genres and tap the genre  
The Music app organizes the audio content you add to your device under  
two main headings: Library and Playlists. The Library heading organizes  
your audio content into four predefined categories: Songs, Artists,  
Albums, and Genres. Tap a category to see content organized in that  
category. The Playlists list contains playlists that you create on the device  
and playlists you import from other sources, for example from HP Play.  
name. Tap the first song.  
4
5
(Optional) Songs play in the order they are displayed onscreen. To  
listen to them in random order: Tap  
.
To end play, close the Music app.  
To show the Library or Playlists lists: Tap  
. To hide them, tap  
.
By default, items in a Library category or playlist are displayed in a list in  
the right-hand panel. To see Album Art instead of the list, tap  
. To  
Use music playback controls  
return to the list, tap  
.
Use the volume button (see Get to know your device) to control the sound  
level.  
Listen to music  
Table 5. Music playback controls  
After you begin to play music, music continues to play if you switch to  
another application or turn off the screen. If you are connected to a  
webOS smartphone using a Bluetooth connection and a call comes in,  
music pauses automatically and resumes when you hang up or ignore the  
call.  
Control  
Function  
Play.  
Pause.  
Rewind.  
If you put the Music app in the background while you work in another  
app, a music notification icon appears at the top of the screen. Tap the  
icon to display the music playback controls. You can use the controls even  
if the screen is locked.  
Fast forward.  
Shuffle current playlist.  
Play in list order.  
1
2
3
Add music files to your device. See Get music onto your device.  
Open Music  
Move forward or backward in a song. Tap and hold the  
slider, and then drag it right to move forward or left to  
move backward.  
.
Do one of the following:  
To listen to all songs on your device: Tap Songs. Tap the first song.  
Create a playlist  
To listen to a specific song: Tap Songs, Artists, Albums, Genres, or  
a playlist you created, to search that category. Continue making  
selections until the song you want appears. Tap the song name.  
To listen to all songs from an artist: Tap Artists and tap the artist  
name. Tap the first song.  
1
2
Open Music  
.
Tap Add Playlist.  
Chapter 7 : Photos, videos, and music  
79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3
4
Enter a name for the playlist.  
Delete songs from a playlist  
Tap Create.  
You can delete songs from playlists you created on your device. Songs  
you delete from a playlist are not deleted from the Music app. You can still  
access them in the Library and any other playlist they are in.  
Add music to a playlist  
Songs in playlists you synchronized from HP Play cannot be deleted on  
your device. To delete a song from a HP Play playlist, you must delete it  
from the playlist in HP Play on your computer and then synchronize HP  
device).  
1
2
Open Music  
.
Tap and hold a song or album, wait for the visual cue, and then  
drag the song or album to the playlist.  
1
2
3
4
Open Music  
Tap the playlist name and tap  
Tap beside the songs you want to delete.  
Tap Done.  
.
Sort all songs or a playlist  
.
1
2
Open Music  
.
Tap Songs or a playlist you created and do one of the following:  
To sort by song: Tap Song.  
To sort by artist: Tap Artist.  
To sort by Album: Tap Album.  
Search Songs, Artists, Albums, Genres, or playlists  
Table 6. Search for music  
To do this...  
Do the following...  
Edit a playlist name  
Search for a song Tap Songs, tap  
, and begin entering the song  
, and begin entering the artist  
, and begin entering the  
name.  
1
2
3
4
Open Music  
.
Search for an artist Tap Artists, tap  
Tap the playlist name and tap  
.
name.  
Search for an  
album  
Tap Albums, tap  
album name.  
Tap the playlist name field and enter a new name for the playlist.  
Tap Done.  
Search for a genre Tap Genres, tap  
, and begin entering the genre  
name.  
NOTE If you sync with HP Play, playlist names for playlists you created in HP  
Play on your computer cannot be changed on the device.  
To close the search field, tap  
.
80  
Chapter 7 : Photos, videos, and music  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
On a Windows computer, right click the drive representing your  
device and click Eject.  
Delete a playlist  
You can delete playlists you created on your device.  
On a Mac computer, drag the drive representing your device to the  
Trash. The Trash icon changes to Eject.  
Playlists you synchronized from HP Play cannot be deleted on your device.  
To delete a HP Play playlist, you must delete it from HP Play on your  
computer and then synchronize HP Play with your device (see Manually  
7
Disconnect the USB cable from the computer when the USB Drive  
screen no longer appears on your device.  
1
2
3
Open Music  
.
Use HP Play to sync music from your computer to your device  
Tap the playlist name and tap  
.
If you have music in your HP Play library on your computer, you can sync  
the songs in your HP Play library to the Music app on your device. If you  
have music in an iTunes library, the contents of that library are copied to  
HP Play when you install it on your computer (see Install HP Play), and you  
can then sync all your iTunes music to your device from HP Play. Music  
you add to iTunes after you install HP Play is copied to HP Play  
automatically.  
Tap Delete Playlist.  
Delete a song from your device  
To delete a song file from your device, you must put your device in USB  
Drive mode and delete the song using your computer.  
You can set up HP Play to sync automatically with your device each time  
you connect it to your computer (see Set up HP Play to sync with your  
device), or, if you choose not to sync automatically, you can manually  
sync HP Play with your device at any time (see Manually sync music from  
HP Play to your device). Playlists sync one way, from HP Play on your  
computer to your device, and playlists synchronized from HP Play cannot  
be changed on your device.  
1
2
Connect your device and your computer using the USB cable.  
On your device, tap USB Drive. If prompted, tap OK. On your  
computer, your device appears as a removable drive.  
For computer system requirements for using USB Drive mode, go to  
Install HP Play  
3
4
On a Windows computer, if the Found New Hardware wizard  
opens, click Cancel to close the wizard.  
On a Windows computer:  
Open My Computer (Windows XP), Computer (Windows Vista/  
Windows 7), or the Finder (Mac), and double click the drive  
representing your device.  
1
2
Open your computer’s browser and go to hpplay.com.  
Click Download the installer and double-click to install, and then  
click Run.  
5
6
Delete the song using your computer’s controls.  
End the connection safely. If you do not eject your device safely, your  
device resets, and may experience data loss, when you disconnect  
the USB cable:  
3
4
If an “Unknown publisher” message appears, click Run to continue.  
Click Install, (optional) uncheck Launch HP Play to stop HP Play from  
opening immediately, and click Finish.  
Chapter 7 : Photos, videos, and music  
81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
If you chose to open HP Play immediately, see Set up HP Play to sync  
6
(Optional) To automatically sync music to your smartphone when it is  
connected to the computer, check Automatically sync music to this  
device.  
On a Mac:  
7
8
Click OK.  
1
2
3
4
Open your computer’s browser and go to hpplay.com.  
Click Download the MAC installer.  
If required, click OK.  
Your device appears under Devices in the left-hand panel of HP Play.  
Click the device name and do either of the following:  
To set up manual sync: Click Manual, and then click Apply. You  
To set up automatic sync: Click Auto and continue to step 9.  
When HP Play has finished downloading, drag the HP Play icon to  
the Applications folder.  
9
Select any of the following sync settings:  
Auto Sync Music: If you selected the auto sync option in step 6, this  
is already selected. Uncheck this box to turn off auto sync.  
Set up HP Play to sync with your device  
BEFORE YOU BEGIN We recommend that you copy all of your music files  
from your device to your computer as a backup before beginning to sync  
Optionally, you can then add these files to HP Play on your computer and  
sync them from there back to your device.  
Sync all music and playlists: Available only when Auto Sync Music is  
turned on. Sync all HP Play music and playlists to your device.  
Sync selected playlists: Available only when Auto Sync Music is  
turned on. Allows you to choose which of the listed playlists you  
want to sync.  
1
If HP Play did not open automatically after installing it, do one of the  
following on your computer to open it:  
10 If you made changes to the default sync settings, click Apply, and  
then click Sync. If you did not make changes, click Sync.  
On a Windows computer: Open HP Play from the start menu or  
double-click  
.
11 A warning may appear to tell you that the contents of the Music app  
on your device will be erased and replaced with the files you are  
syncing from HP Play. Click Continue if you want to proceed.  
On a Mac: Open the Applications folder and double-click  
.
2
Connect your device and your computer using the USB cable.  
12 When HP Play finishes synchronizing, end the connection between  
your device and the computer safely. If you do not eject your device  
safely, your device resets, and may experience data loss, when you  
disconnect the USB cable:  
For computer system requirements for using USB Drive mode, go to  
3
4
On your device, tap USB Drive. If prompted, tap OK.  
On a Windows computer, in Windows Explorer, right-click the drive  
representing your smartphone and click Eject.  
On a Windows computer, if the Found New Hardware wizard  
opens, click Cancel to close the wizard.  
On a Mac computer, drag the drive representing your smartphone to  
the Trash. The Trash icon changes to Eject.  
5
In the Device Setup dialog box, click the Name field and enter a  
name for your device.  
82  
Chapter 7 : Photos, videos, and music  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
13 Disconnect the USB cable from the computer when the USB Drive  
screen no longer appears on your smartphone.  
Manually sync music from HP Play to your device  
1
2
3
Open HP Play on your computer.  
Connect your device and your computer using the USB cable.  
On your device, tap USB Drive. If prompted, tap OK.  
For computer system requirements for using USB Drive mode, go to  
4
5
On a Windows computer, if the Found New Hardware wizard  
opens, click Cancel to close the wizard.  
Your device appears under Devices in the left-hand panel of HP Play.  
Do one of the following:  
To add a song or playlist: Click a song or playlist and drag it on  
top of your device’s name. Repeat for any other songs or playlists.  
To delete a playlist: Right-click the playlist and click Delete.  
To delete a song from a playlist: Click the playlist name, right-click  
the song, and click Remove. Click Remove to confirm.  
6
When HP Play finishes syncing, end the connection between your  
device and the computer safely. If you do not eject your device  
safely, your device resets, and may experience data loss, when you  
disconnect the USB cable:  
On a Windows computer, in Windows Explorer, right click the drive  
representing your device and click Eject.  
On a Mac computer, drag the drive representing your device to the  
Trash. The Trash icon changes to Eject.  
7
Disconnect the USB cable from the computer when the USB Drive  
screen no longer appears on your device.  
Chapter 7 : Photos, videos, and music  
83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
84  
Chapter 7 : Photos, videos, and music  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8 Web  
Search the web  
Do one of the following:  
In Card view, tap Just type, type the search term, and then tap a search  
Web  
engine (for example, Google).  
Open Web  
, enter the search term, and tap Enter.  
Go to a website  
The web browser on your device is capable of displaying most web  
content. The browser supports HTML5 and Adobe Flash.  
1
Do one of the following:  
Navigate a web page  
In Card view, tap Just type, type the site address (for example,  
hp.com), and tap Go to website.  
Table 1. Web page navigation  
Open Web  
and enter the site address. If the page appears in  
To do this...  
Do the following...  
the history list, tap it to go there again. If not, tap Enter.  
Move back  
through previously  
viewed pages  
Tap  
Tap  
Tap  
.
When entering a website address (URL), you don’t need to enter  
“http://www.”  
Move forward  
through previously  
viewed pages  
.
DID YOU KNOW? If you browse to a secure web page, the lock icon in the  
address line appears closed.  
Refresh  
Scroll  
.
2
To cancel a page while it is loading, tap  
.
Drag or flick up/down on the screen.  
View in landscape Turn the device on its side.  
Chapter 8 : Web  
85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Table 1. Web page navigation  
old or newer. Make sure your printer is turned on and that both your  
device and the printer are connected to your local or corporate wireless  
network. For personal printers, see the instructions that came with your  
printer for information about setting up a printer on a wireless network.  
To do this...  
Do the following...  
Zoom in/out of a  
page  
Pinch out to enlarge items onscreen. Pinch in to  
decrease the size of items onscreen. Double-tap  
the screen to zoom in or out a specified amount.  
1
Open the web page that you want to print and wait until the blue  
progress bar runs the full way from left to right across the top of the  
screen and disappears.  
Zoom in on a  
column  
Double tap the column to center it and enlarge it.  
Double tap again to zoom out to see the whole  
page again.  
2
Open the application menu and tap Print.  
Pan  
Tap, hold, and drag the page.  
Printers that are available on your current wireless network are  
displayed.  
Enter information  
in a form  
Tap the form field. Enter or select information and  
tap Enter.  
3
Do one of the following:  
Share a web  
address as a link  
in an email  
Tap and then tap Share Link. Create the email  
message.  
If this is your first time using a printer on this network: If a list of  
printers is displayed, tap one.  
message  
If you have already used a printer on this network: The last printer  
you used is remembered and is selected. If you want to select  
another printer, scroll down and tap Select Another Printer.  
To set up a printer manually or on a corporate network: Scroll  
down in the list of printers and tap Add a Printer. Tap Enter an IP  
address and enter the IP address of the printer. (Optional) Tap  
Name this printer and enter a name to identify the printer. Tap  
Done.  
Open another browser  
If you are looking at one web page and need to check something on a  
different one, simply open another browser.  
1
2
Tap  
.
4
5
Depending on the printer you are using, you can set the following  
printer attributes:  
Enter the address or search term for the second instance of the  
browser.  
Number of Copies: Tap 1 and tap the number of copies you want to  
print.  
3
To move between the two pages, press Center  
view. The web pages are displayed in a stack. Tap the one you  
want.  
to display Card  
Color Printing: Tap On to switch color printing from On to Off.  
Tap Print.  
Print a web page  
To cancel a print job, tap Cancel while the file is preparing to print,  
or while printing is in progress, tap  
the notification, and then tap  
Print Queue.  
at the top of the screen, tap  
BEFORE YOU BEGIN Your device supports printing on all network-capable  
HP printers that support PCL page description language in the local LAN.  
These printers include new HP ePrint-capable printers–Photosmart,  
Officejet, and LaserJet–as well as legacy printers approximately five years  
to the right of the print job in the  
86  
Chapter 8 : Web  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Use Flash content  
Flash content plays as soon as you open a website.  
Do any of the following:  
To use playback controls with Flash content and interact with other  
active areas: Tap the Flash content.  
To zoom in on Flash content: Pinch out to enlarge items onscreen.  
To zoom out on Flash content: Pinch in to decrease the size of items  
onscreen.  
3
4
Do any of the following:  
To edit the title: Tap the title. See Text selection gestures for useful  
gestures if you want to edit the page title.  
To exit full-screen mode while using Flash content: Press Center  
.
The ability to use Flash content is turned on by default. To turn it off: Open  
the application menu and tap Preferences. In Enable Flash, tap On to  
switch it from On to Off. You can turn Flash auto-load off also. If auto-load  
is turned off, when you open a web page, Flash content on the page  
To edit the URL: Tap the URL and enter or edit the URL for the page.  
For example, change the URL to the home page of a site instead of a  
drill-down page within the site.  
appears with a play  
button. Tap  
to play the Flash content. To turn  
Tap Add to launcher.  
auto-load off: Open the application menu and tap Preferences. In  
Autoload Flash, tap On to switch it from On to Off.  
The page now appears as an icon on the Favorites page of the Launcher.  
Tap the icon to open the page. To delete the page from the Launcher, see  
Flash on your device does not support the following:  
Games that require arrow keys as controls. The device keyboard has no  
arrow keys, so unless a game enables the remapping of keys, you  
cannot play that game on your device.  
Hover states on Flash content.  
Some video streaming methods.  
Create a bookmark  
1
2
Open the page you want to bookmark.  
Tap , and tap on the bookmarks tab.  
If the bookmarks tab is not open, tap  
Add a web page to the Launcher  
.
Add any web pages you visit frequently to the Launcher so you can  
access them in a few taps.  
1
2
Open the page you want to add to the Launcher.  
Tap , and tap Add to Launcher.  
3
Tap  
to close the Bookmarks panel.  
Chapter 8 : Web  
87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Open Web  
and enter a term or address in the address bar that  
NOTE Web bookmarks are part of the data backed up to your HP webOS  
Account.  
matches the page name or address.  
To clear your browsing history: Open Web  
menu, tap Preferences, and then tap Clear History.  
, open the application  
Open a bookmarked page  
Use links on a web page  
Do one of the following:  
Table 2. Use links on a web page  
To do this...  
Do the following...  
Tap the link.  
In Card view, tap Just type, type a few characters of the bookmark title,  
and then tap Bookmarks & History. Scroll to find the bookmark you  
want, and tap to open it.  
Go to another  
page  
To open a bookmark if it’s not on the start page, or after you navigate  
Open a link in  
another browser  
Tap and hold the link. Tap Open In New Card.  
away from the start page: Tap  
, and tap the bookmark on the  
Bookmarks tab. If the Bookmarks tab is not open, tap  
.
Share via email  
Copy the URL  
Tap  
, and tap Share Link.  
Tap and hold the link. Tap Copy URL.  
Edit or delete a bookmark  
1
2
3
Open Web  
Tap  
Do either of the following:  
.
Work with images on a web page  
.
Table 3. Work with images on a web page  
To do this...  
Do the following...  
To edit: Tap  
to the right of the bookmark name. Change the  
Copy an image to Tap and hold the image. Tap Copy to Photos.  
title or URL and tap Save Bookmark.  
Photos & Videos  
Pictures you copy from the web are stored in the  
Miscellaneous album in Photos & Videos.  
To delete: Throw the bookmark off the side of the screen and tap  
Delete.  
Share an image  
via email  
Tap and hold the image. Tap Share Image.  
Use an image as  
wallpaper  
Tap and hold the image, tap Set Wallpaper, and  
then tap OK.  
Return to previously viewed web pages  
Do one of the following:  
Download files from the web  
In Card view, tap Just type, type a few characters of a keyword relating  
to the page you are looking for, and then tap Bookmarks & History.  
Scroll to find the page you want, and tap to open it.  
1
2
Open Web  
.
Open Web  
, tap  
, and then tap  
. Scroll to the page name and  
Go to the web page with the file you want to download.  
tap the page.  
88  
Chapter 8 : Web  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3
4
Tap the file name.  
3
Set any of the following:  
If an app on your device supports the file type, the file name is  
displayed in the Downloads panel. Tap Open.  
Default Web Search Engine: Select your default search engine.  
Block Popups: Prevents websites from opening up new browser  
windows. Tap On to switch Block Popups from On to Off.  
Accept Cookies: Allows cookies from any website you view, even if  
you are redirected to a site from another site. Tap On to switch  
Accept Cookies from On to Off.  
Enable JavaScript: Tap On to switch JavaScript from On to Off.  
Turning off JavaScript may prevent some websites from functioning  
properly.  
All files are downloaded to the device’s USB storage. If an app on  
your device supports the file type, you can also find the file in that  
app. For example, if it’s a PDF file, find it in Adobe Reader, and if  
it’s an MP3 file, find it in Music.  
Enable Flash: Tap On to switch it from On to Off. Turning off Flash  
content prevents Flash content from displaying.  
Autoload Flash: Enables Flash content to begin playing as soon as  
you open a website. Tap Off to switch it from Off to On.  
Add a web search engine  
Clear Bookmarks: Tap to delete your bookmarks.  
Clear History: Tap to delete your browsing history.  
When you browse to some websites that use search functionality, such as  
dictionary.com, you may see the notification Web Search Engine  
Available. This means that you can add this website to the list of search  
engines your device uses when you use Just Type to enter a search term  
while in Card view.  
Clear Cookies: Tap to delete cookies used by some websites to  
remember visiting history and user settings.  
1
2
Tap  
at the top of the screen and then tap the Tap to add as  
Clear Cache: Tap to delete any web page content that has been  
stored in the local cache. This ensures that you are viewing the most  
current content when you visit a web page.  
Search Engine notification.  
Check the box to the left of the website name in the Search Using  
section of the Just Type preferences to add this website as a search  
option in Just Type.  
4
Tap Done.  
Customize web browser settings  
Maps  
1
2
Open Web  
.
Search for a location  
Open the application menu and tap Preferences.  
1
Open Maps  
.
Chapter 8 : Web  
89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
2
3
If prompted, tap Allow Once to turn on Location Services for this  
5
6
If you want to start at a location other than your current location, tap  
Current Location, and enter a new starting location or tap a location  
you viewed recently.  
session.  
Do one of the following:  
Tap the address field to the right of Current Location and enter a new  
starting location and tap Enter, or tap a location you viewed  
To search for a new address: Tap the Search or Address field,  
enter an address, and tap Enter.  
recently. To get directions to an address you saved, tap  
Saved. Tap a location and tap Directions To Here.  
, and tap  
To find an address you saved: Tap  
location.  
, tap Saved, and tap a  
7
Do any of the following:  
To find an address you searched for recently: Tap  
Recents, and tap a location.  
, tap  
For driving directions: Tap  
.
For public transport directions: Tap  
.
4
5
(Optional) To save the location, tap , tap  
, and tap Save.  
For walking directions: Tap  
To see the route in writing, tap  
.
(Optional) To get directions to the location, tap , tap  
.
8
9
. Tap the transit mode icons at the  
top of the panel to see driving, public transport, or walking routes.  
Tap to close the directions panel.  
NOTE The Maps app cannot determine your location and therefore cannot  
work properly unless a location service is turned on (see Turn Google Services  
on/off).  
Tap Start to see step-by-step directions on the map. Tap  
to the next step, and to go to the previous step.  
to move  
TIP You can search for a location in Maps directly from Card view. Tap Just  
type, start typing the address or location name and, under Search Maps, tap  
Maps. If prompted, tap Allow Once to turn on Location Services for this session.  
The Maps application opens with the closest match to your search term  
displayed in the map header.  
NOTE The Maps app cannot determine your location and therefore cannot  
work properly unless a location service is turned on (see Turn Google Services  
on/off).  
Work with saved locations  
Get directions  
1
2
Open Maps  
.
1
2
Open Maps  
.
If prompted, tap Allow Once to turn on Location Services for this  
session.  
If prompted, tap Allow Once to turn on Location Services for this  
session.  
3
Do any of the following:  
3
4
Tap  
.
To view a saved location: Tap  
tap a location.  
, tap  
, tap Saved, and then  
If required, tap OK to turn on your location.  
90  
Chapter 8 : Web  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To get directions to a saved location from your current location:  
View your current location  
Tap  
, tap  
, and tap Saved. Tap a location and tap  
Directions To Here.  
To get directions from a saved location to your current location:  
If you are viewing a map of a location far from where you are currently,  
you can reposition the map to show your current location.  
Tap  
, tap  
, and tap Saved. Tap a location and tap  
Directions From Here.  
Do one of the following:  
To get directions from one saved location to another saved  
location: Tap  
, tap  
, and tap Saved. Tap a location and tap  
, tap Saved, tap a location, and  
If you have Location Services turned on: Tap  
If you do not have Location Services turned on: Tap  
Launch. Open the Location Services application menu, tap Locate Me  
.
Directions From Here. Tap  
and tap  
then tap Directions To Here.  
To delete a saved location: Tap  
, tap Saved, throw the location  
Using, and tap Google Services. Press Center  
and tap the Maps  
off the side of the screen and tap Delete to confirm.  
app in Card view. Tap Allow Once to allow the Maps app to use your  
location for this session.  
Work with locations you viewed recently  
Move around and zoom in/out on a map  
Do any of the following:  
1
2
Open Maps  
.
If prompted, tap Allow Once to turn on Location Services for this  
session.  
To pan a map: Tap, hold, and drag the map.  
To zoom in/out on a map: Pinch out to enlarge items onscreen. Pinch in  
to decrease the size of items onscreen.  
3
Do any of the following:  
To view a recently viewed location: Tap  
and then tap a location.  
, tap  
, tap Recents,  
Customize the map view  
To get directions to a recently viewed location from your current  
location: Tap , tap , and tap Recents. Tap a location and  
tap Directions To Here.  
To get directions from a recently viewed location to your current  
location: Tap , tap , and tap Recents. Tap a location and  
tap Directions From Here.  
1
2
Open Maps  
.
If prompted, tap Allow Once to turn on Location Services for this  
session.  
To save a recently viewed location: Tap  
and then tap a location. Tap , tap  
, tap  
, tap Recents,  
3
Tap  
and tap any of the following:  
, and then tap Save.  
To get directions from one recently viewed location to another  
recently viewed location: Tap , tap , and tap Recents. Tap a  
, tap Recents, tap a  
Road: Displays a two dimensional view showing roads and  
landmarks.  
location and tap Directions From Here. Tap  
location, and then tap Directions To Here.  
Satellite: Shows a satellite image.  
To delete a location: Tap  
, tap Recents, throw the location off  
Bird’s Eye: Shows a map made up of images taken from the air.  
the side of the screen, and tap Delete .  
To delete all recently viewed locations: Tap  
tap Clear.  
, tap Recents, and  
Chapter 8 : Web  
91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Show Traffic: Shows major roads and commute paths colored to  
indicate their current traffic status. The color scale runs from green  
(meaning free-flowing traffic), through yellow, red, and finally gray  
(meaning slow traffic).  
Drop a pin: Allows you to drag a pin to a map location and get  
directions to that location or add the location to your saved  
locations. Tap Drop a pin to drop a pin on the map. Tap, hold, and  
drag the pin to an address. Remove your finger from the pin and  
tap  
to get directions or tap  
and tap Save to save the  
location. To remove a pin from a map, tap  
, and then tap Drop a  
pin.  
Clear Map: Clear the current map view.  
4
Tap  
to close the map preferences panel.  
92  
Chapter 8 : Web  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9 Contacts, Calendar, and other personal information  
The Synergy feature provides another advantage: During the same  
process you go through to set up a contacts account, you also set up the  
same account for all other applications that can display data from that  
account. For details on how Synergy works for the current list of online  
For example, suppose you want to set up your Google contacts account  
on your device. The last step in setup is to select all the other apps that  
you want to receive data from your Google account (besides Contacts,  
you can include Messaging, Calendar, Email, and Documents). After  
setup is complete, your device begins to download your contacts and all  
data for all other apps you selected for synchronization.  
Contacts  
How do I add names and other info into Contacts?  
You have a few options for getting info into Contacts.  
NOTE In the Launcher, tap Accounts and then tap Add Account to see the  
current list of online accounts you can set up on your device and from which you  
can access contact info. See Online accounts available for webOS devices to  
see how major online accounts synchronize data between the web-based  
account and your device.  
Connect to an online address book: If you have an address book in an  
online account that works with the HP Synergy feature (see Your HP  
TouchPad), for example, Google or Microsoft Exchange, you can set up  
Contacts on your device to synchronize and display contacts that you  
store in the online address book. After you set up the connection to the  
online address book, contacts you enter online show up automatically in  
Contacts, and contacts you enter on your device sync to the online  
account, provided the account allows writing from the device to the online  
account.  
Enter a contact directly in Contacts: See Create a contact for instructions.  
You can assign the contact to one of your online address books—if you  
do, it synchronizes with the online address book. Or you can create the  
contact in your HP webOS Account, which means it shows up on your  
device only. HP webOS Account contacts are included in the daily  
backup of your HP webOS Account information, so you can restore them  
if they are accidentally erased.  
You can set up your contacts accounts in either of these locations.  
NOTE With some online accounts, such as Facebook or Yahoo!, data you enter  
on your device does not sync to the online account.  
Chapter 9 : Contacts, Calendar, and other personal information  
93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Use a third-party sync solution (if available): If you want to use a desktop  
app to store your contacts, you may be able to use a third-party solution  
(sold separately) to sync your contacts directly with your computer (see  
sync-solutions to see if third--party solutions are available for your device.  
If there are no solutions available for your device, check with the  
developers of existing sync software for other webOS devices to see if  
they are developing a solution for your device).  
Transfer contacts from an existing HP webOS Account: When setting up  
your device, you can choose to sign in to an existing HP webOS Account  
that you may be using already with a webOS smartphone. If you decide  
to sign in to an existing account, you can choose to do a one-time transfer  
of the data, including contacts, stored in the existing HP webOS Account  
to your device.  
1 Tap [number of] linked profiles to see the contacts that are linked.  
2 Steven is a contact in your HP webOS Account and your Google online account.  
3 Steven’s combined contact info is listed.  
Download vCard info to Contacts: A vCard is a file type made especially  
for contact info. A vCard may contain one or many contact entries. A  
vCard can be attached to an email, and you can download the info in a  
vCard to your Contacts app. See Receive vCards.  
You can unlink linked contacts, and you can manually link contacts (see  
Linked contacts  
Use Contacts for the first time  
The Synergy feature automatically links contacts from different accounts if  
it finds data in common between them. For example, if you have a contact  
in Exchange and in Google for Steven Grayson, your device links the  
contacts so that all of Steven’s info shows up on a single contact screen.  
You need to open just one view to see all of Steven’s info. The actual data  
remains separate in the various accounts where you originally created the  
data; it’s just assembled in one view on your device for your convenience.  
1
2
Open Contacts  
.
Do one of the following:  
To set up an online account to sync: To set up an account that is  
listed, tap the account type, and go to step 3. To set up an  
account type that is not listed, tap Find more to find an app and  
follow the instructions onscreen.  
To use accounts you have set up already in another app: Tap Go.  
This opens your HP webOS Account and any online accounts,  
and you can start creating contacts in these accounts.  
How can you tell if a contact is linked? Look in the upper-right corner of  
the contact panel. If you see [number of] linked profiles beside the photo  
icon, that means that you’re looking at a linked contact, with combined  
info from contacts you’re storing in separate accounts.  
To use Contacts without creating an online account: Tap your HP  
webOS Account name. You can now start creating contacts in  
your HP webOS Account.  
94  
Chapter 9 : Contacts, Calendar, and other personal information  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Set up an online account in Contacts  
1
2
Open Contacts  
.
Do one of the following:  
To set up an online account the first time you use Contacts: See  
To set up an online account any other time: Open the application  
menu, tap Preferences & Accounts, tap Add an account, tap an  
account type, and go to step 3. To set up an account type that is  
not listed, tap Find More to find an app and follow the instructions  
onscreen.  
3
4
5
If you are setting up a Skype account, tap Sign In.  
Enter the account information, and then tap Sign in.  
3
4
5
If you are setting up a Skype account, tap Sign In.  
Enter the account information, and then tap Sign in.  
If you are setting up an Exchange account, you may see a message  
telling you that you must set a PIN or password for the device the  
next time you wake up the screen. Tap OK to continue with account  
creation. The next time you wake up the screen, tap Set PIN or Set  
Password. Enter a PIN or Password and tap Done. If you encounter  
problems while setting up an Exchange account, see Set up email:  
Microsoft Exchange and Lotus Notes to learn about setting up an  
account manually.  
If you are setting up an Exchange account, you may see a message  
telling you that you must set a PIN or password for the device the  
next time you wake up the screen. Tap OK to continue with account  
creation. The next time you wake up the screen, tap Set PIN or Set  
Password. Enter a PIN or Password and tap Done. If you encounter  
problems while setting up an Exchange account, see Set up email:  
Microsoft Exchange and Lotus Notes to learn about setting up an  
account manually.  
6
Depending on the account, you may be presented with options for  
which apps should download data from that account. For each app,  
tap On or Off, and then tap Create account.  
6
Depending on the account, you may be presented with options for  
which apps should download data from that account. For each app,  
tap On or Off, and then tap Create account.  
Create a Skype account in Contacts  
NOTE If you add your Facebook or LinkedIn account to Contacts, your friends’  
Facebook and LinkedIn email addresses show up in Contacts. You cannot  
change Facebook or LinkedIn info from Contacts on your device. You also  
cannot add friends to your Facebook or LinkedIn account from Contacts. To  
work directly with Facebook or LinkedIn, download the free Facebook or  
LinkedIn application from App Catalog (see Download a free application and  
Facebook Tablet), or go to facebook.com or linkedin.com in the Web  
application (see Web).  
You do not need to have a Skype account set up before using Skype in  
Contacts—you can set one up directly from Contacts. You can also create  
a Skype account in Accounts (see Use the Accounts application to set up  
Calls).  
Chapter 9 : Contacts, Calendar, and other personal information  
95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
1
2
Open Contacts  
.
2
3
Tap Add Contact.  
Do one of the following:  
(Optional) Tap the account icon in the upper-right corner of the  
screen to change the account to which the new contact will be  
added.  
If you have not set up an account in another app that takes  
advantage of the Synergy feature: Tap Skype.  
If you have already set up an account that takes advantage of the  
Synergy feature and want to set up another one: Tap Add an  
Account and tap Skype.  
Any other time: Open the application menu and tap Preferences &  
Accounts. Tap Add an account and tap Skype.  
3
4
5
Tap Create Account.  
Tap Accept to agree to Skype’s terms and conditions.  
Enter the following details:  
*
Account icon, showing HP webOS Account  
Full Name: Enter your full name.  
Skype Name: Enter a name that you will use to identify yourself to  
other Skype users.  
NOTE If an account doesn’t appear in the list, you can’t add data to that  
account from your device.  
Password: Enter a password and then enter it again.  
Email Address: Enter your email address and then enter it again.  
4
5
Tap Name to enter the contact name.  
To add detailed name information, such as prefix, suffix, or middle  
6
7
Tap Create Account, and tap Create Account again.  
Tap Done.  
name, to a name, tap  
beside the Name field.  
6
Tap fields to enter contact details.  
In some fields, such as Phone Number, a label button is displayed  
on the right. Tap the button to change the label for your entry—for  
example, to identify a number as a mobile or work phone.  
Create a contact  
You can add a contact to an account. If you don’t specify the account, the  
new contact is added to your default account.  
7
8
9
(Optional) To assign the contact as a favorite, tap  
If you are using Contacts for the first time, you go through a few different  
steps to add or access the contacts on your device (see Use Contacts for  
the first time). Follow this procedure to add contacts directly on your  
device after the first time you use Contacts.  
(Optional) To add a photo to the contact, see Add or change a  
Tap Done.  
1
Open Contacts  
.
96  
Chapter 9 : Contacts, Calendar, and other personal information  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
4
Do any of the following:  
Find a contact  
To add information: Tap the field and enter the info. For a linked  
contact, you can also tap the account icon on the left side of the  
field, and then tap the account you want to add the info to (see  
To change information: Tap a field and enter the info (see Enter  
To find a contact within the Contacts app, use these steps.  
1
2
Open Contacts  
.
Do one of the following:  
Scroll through the list of contacts in the contacts list (left-hand  
panel).  
Tap Search and begin typing first, middle, or last name, first and  
last initial (with no space between), company, or nickname.  
NOTE Info that originates from some accounts (like Facebook) can’t be edited  
on your device. If you tap a field and nothing happens, this is a field that can't  
be edited on the device. To make changes, go to the online account.  
For more search options, tap Global Address Search. (This option  
is available if you are using Microsoft Exchange with a Global  
Address List.)  
To change a contact picture: Tap  
beside the current picture. If  
required, tap Change Photo. Tap the album containing the picture  
and tap the picture thumbnail, or tap Search, enter a file name,  
and tap a picture thumbnail. Tap OK.  
3
Tap the contact.  
To delete a piece of contact information: Throw the item off the  
For quick access to the contacts you use regularly, you can create a  
favorite in Contacts (see Create a favorite) or in Phone (see Create a  
side of the screen and tap Delete.  
To delete a contact picture: Tap  
beside the current picture and  
tap Delete Photo.  
To delete a contact: Tap Delete at the bottom of the screen.  
NOTE You can make calls from your device only when it is connected to a  
compatible HP webOS smartphone (see Make a pairing request to another  
In a linked contact, information from the various accounts is  
displayed in a single view. Tap any field to edit information specific  
to an account.  
5
Tap Done.  
View, edit, or delete contact information  
Add or change a contact photo  
1
2
3
Open Contacts  
Search for a contact (see Find a contact), and tap the contact name.  
To the contact info, tap  
.
1
While creating (see Create a contact) or editing (see View, edit, or  
delete contact information) a contact, tap  
photo.  
beside the current  
.
2
If you are replacing an existing photo, tap Change Photo.  
NOTE The fields that make up the contact header (name, photo, nickname, job  
title, company) are unique to each account. You must open a specific account to  
edit these fields.  
Chapter 9 : Contacts, Calendar, and other personal information  
97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
3
4
Do one of the following:  
1
2
3
Open Contacts  
.
To browse to a photo: Tap the album containing the picture and  
tap the picture thumbnail.  
To search for a photo: Tap Search, enter a photo name, tap the  
photo name, and then tap the photo thumbnail.  
Tap a contact and then tap the contact name again.  
Tap one of the following:  
To start an IM chat with a buddy: Tap Chat, enter your message,  
and tap Enter.  
To make a voice call to a buddy: Tap Voice Call.  
To make a video call to a buddy: Tap Video Call.  
Tap OK.  
Create a favorite  
You can make a contact a favorite, so that it appears at the top of the  
search results list when you search using Just Type.  
Link a contact  
When your device recognizes matching information in two or more  
contacts—for example, the same name and phone number—it  
automatically gathers the info from the two records into a single view that  
displays all the contact information. You can also manually link contacts.  
The info for your linked contacts appears combined only on your device;  
the actual info is kept separate and distinct in the accounts it came from.  
1
2
3
Open Contacts  
Search for a contact (see Find a contact), and tap the contact name.  
Tap in the contact details panel.  
In the All contacts list, favorites are identified with a  
.
.
IMPORTANT To maintain the integrity of your contact data, it’s important that  
you link only one person’s contact info in different accounts. For example, if you  
have contact info for Steven Grayson in Google, Facebook, Microsoft  
Exchange, and your HP webOS Account, go ahead and link all four contacts  
into a linked contact. But don’t link Steven’s contact info with his brother John’s.  
Remove a contact from favorites  
1
2
3
Open Contacts  
Tap Favorites.  
.
1
2
Open Contacts  
.
Search for a contact (see Find a contact), and tap the contact name.  
Tap a contact and tap  
.
Call or chat with a Skype contact  
When you add or create a Skype account on your device, your Skype  
buddies are added to Contacts. From here, you can chat with a buddy, or  
make a voice or video call to a buddy.  
98  
Chapter 9 : Contacts, Calendar, and other personal information  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
3
In the contact details panel, tap 1 profile or [number of] linked  
profiles, and tap Link more profiles.  
Get in touch with a contact  
1
2
3
Open Contacts  
.
Search for a contact (see Find a contact), and tap the contact name.  
Do any of the following:  
To send an email or instant message: Tap the appropriate field.  
For example, tap an email address to send an email to the  
contact.  
To locate an address on a map: Tap an address field.  
To send a text message: Tap  
.
To call that contact: Tap a phone number.  
4
5
Search for the contact (see Find a contact) and tap it to link the two  
contacts.  
NOTE You can only make calls and send text messages from your device when  
it is connected to a webOS smartphone (see Make a pairing request to another  
(Optional) After you create the link, you can ensure that the linked  
contact appears in your Contacts list under the name you’re most  
likely to recognize (and not, say, under a person’s IM screen name,  
which can be unrelated to their real name). To do this, tap [number  
of] linked profiles, tap the contact name you want to appear, and  
tap Set as primary profile.  
Delete a contact  
1
2
Open Contacts  
.
Search for a contact (see Find a contact), and tap the contact name.  
Unlink a contact  
1
2
3
Open Contacts  
.
NOTE Entries that you cannot change on your device, like those from Facebook  
and LinkedIn, you also cannot delete from the device. You must delete them from  
your account on the web to remove them from your device.  
Search for a contact (see Find a contact), and tap the contact name.  
Tap [number of] linked profiles, and tap the contact you want to  
unlink.  
3
Do one of the following:  
To delete only one entry in a linked contact: Tap [number of]  
linked profiles. Tap the entry you want and tap Delete this profile.  
4
Tap Unlink this profile.  
To delete an unlinked contact or an entire linked contact: Tap  
and then tap Delete. Tap Delete All Profiles to confirm.  
Chapter 9 : Contacts, Calendar, and other personal information  
99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
You can also choose to sort by Company & first name or Company  
& last name. In these cases, the company name is alphabetized,  
and within the company, whichever you choose, the names are still  
listed as first name followed by last name.  
NOTE If you see Delete Other Profiles rather than Delete All Profiles, you have  
linked contacts that come from accounts whose info you can't change on your  
device (like Facebook and LinkedIn). Tap it. To delete any remaining profiles, go  
to the account online using your computer and delete them there.  
Default account: Tap the current default account to change the  
default to another account. New contacts you create are assigned to  
this account unless you specify otherwise.  
If you delete a contact that is assigned to an online account, the  
contact is deleted in the online account also.  
Accounts: Tap an account to change login settings and sign in using  
the new settings.  
Customize Contacts  
Add an account: Tap, and then tap an account type. Enter the  
account information. Before you can set up an account on your  
device, you must already have an account online with the provider.  
1
2
3
Open Contacts  
.
Open the application menu and tap Preferences & Accounts.  
Sync Now: Tap to manually synchronize your online accounts (see  
Set the following options:  
List Order: Tap to select the criteria by which the contact list is  
sorted. If you select Last name to sort on, the names are  
alphabetized by last name, but they still appear in the Contacts list  
as first name followed by last name. If you select First name to sort  
on, names are alphabetized by first name.  
4
Tap Done.  
Manually synchronize Contacts with your online accounts  
If you want to get contacts from an online account on your device  
immediately, or upload contacts from your device to the online account,  
you can do a manual sync. This synchronizes Contacts with all the  
accounts you have set up on your device, and it syncs all other apps  
associated with all online accounts that you selected for synchronization.  
1
2
3
Open Contacts  
.
Open the application menu and tap Preferences & Accounts.  
Tap Sync Now.  
Delete an online account from Contacts  
1 Contact list sorted by first name  
2 Contact list sorted by last name  
If you synchronize contacts with an online account, deleting the account  
from Contacts stops synchronization of contacts only—if you also sync  
email or calendar events with that online account, those continue to  
100 Chapter 9 : Contacts, Calendar, and other personal information  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
synchronize. Deleting the account from Contacts also deletes the  
associated contact entries from your device only. The entries are not  
deleted from the online account.  
for example, Google or Microsoft Exchange, you can set up Calendar on  
your device to synchronize and display events in the online calendar.  
After you set up the connection to the online calendar, events you enter  
online show up automatically in Calendar, and events you enter on your  
device sync to the online account, provided the account allows writing  
from the device to the online account.  
1
2
3
4
Open Contacts  
.
Open the application menu and tap Preferences & Accounts.  
Tap the account name.  
You can set up your calendar accounts in either of these locations.  
Tap Remove Account and tap Remove Account.  
To restart synchronization with an account you have deleted from  
Contacts: Open Accounts  
, tap the account name, and tap Off beside  
Contacts to turn synchronization on.  
DID YOU KNOW? If you synchronize with your Google calendar, you can add  
Google Weather to the calendar on your computer and have it appear in  
Calendar on your device. On your computer, log in to your Google Calendar  
account and open Calendar Settings. Click the General tab, enter your location,  
and click the temperature unit you want in Show weather based on my location.  
The next time your device synchronizes with your Google account, Google  
Weather appears in Calendar on your device.  
Receive vCards  
To get an emailed vCard into Contacts:  
1
From the open Email message, tap the attachment.  
The vCard opens automatically within Contacts.  
The Synergy feature provides another advantage: During the same  
process you go through to set up a calendar account, you also set up the  
same account for all other applications that can display data from that  
account. For details on how Synergy works for the current list of online  
2
3
Tap the account icon in the upper-right corner, and tap the account  
to which you want to add the new contact.  
Tap Done.  
For example, suppose you want to set up your Google calendar account  
on your device. The last step in setup is to select all the other apps that  
you want to receive data from your Google account (besides Calendar,  
you can include Contacts, Messaging, Email, and Documents). After  
setup is complete, your device begins to download your calendar events  
and all data for all other apps you selected for synchronization.  
Calendar  
How do I get events into Calendar?  
NOTE In the Launcher, tap Accounts and then tap Add Account to see the  
current list of online accounts you can set up on your device and from which you  
can access Calendar events. See Online accounts available for webOS devices  
to see how major online accounts synchronize data between the web-based  
account and your device.  
You have a few options for getting events to show up in Calendar:  
Connect to an online calendar: If you have a calendar in an online  
account that works with the HP Synergy feature (see Your HP TouchPad),  
Chapter 9 : Contacts, Calendar, and other personal information 101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Enter an event directly in Calendar: See Create an event for instructions.  
You can assign the event to one of your online calendars—if you do, it  
synchronizes with the online calendar. Or you can create the event in your  
HP webOS Account, which means it shows up on your device only. HP  
webOS Account events are included in the daily backup of your HP  
webOS Account information, so you can restore them if they are  
accidentally erased.  
You can also look at the events of just one calendar at a time.  
Use Calendar for the first time  
1
2
Open Calendar  
.
Do one of the following:  
NOTE With some online accounts, such as Yahoo!, data you enter on your  
To set up an online account to sync: To set up an account that is  
listed, tap the account type, and go to step 3. To set up an  
account type that is not listed, tap Find more to find an app and  
follow the instructions onscreen.  
To use accounts you have set up already in another app: Tap Go.  
This opens your HP webOS Account and any online accounts,  
and you can start creating events in these accounts.  
To use Calendar without creating an online account: Tap your HP  
webOS Account name. You can now start creating contacts in  
your HP webOS Account.  
device does not sync to the online account.  
Use a third-party sync solution: If you want to use a desktop app to store  
your calendar events, you may be able to use a third-party solution (sold  
separately) to sync your calendar events directly with your computer (see  
sync-solutions) to see if third-party solutions are available for your device.  
If there are no solutions available for your device, check with the  
developers of existing sync software for other webOS devices to see if  
they are developing a solution for your device).  
Transfer calendar events from an existing HP webOS Account: When  
setting up your device, you can choose to sign in to an existing HP  
webOS Account that you may be using already with a webOS  
smartphone. If you decide to sign in to an existing account, you can  
choose to do a one-time transfer of the data, including calendar events,  
stored in the existing HP webOS Account to your device.  
Layered calendars  
Suppose you use the calendar in both Microsoft Exchange and in  
Google. If you set up both of those accounts to sync with your device,  
your device’s Calendar app shows the events from both in a single view—  
a layered calendar with events that are color-coded to identify which  
provider they come from. Individual events are stored separately with your  
different providers; the events are just assembled in one view on your  
device for your convenience.  
3
Enter the account information, and then tap Sign in.  
If you are setting up an Exchange account, you may see a message  
telling you that you must set a PIN or password for the device the  
next time you wake up the screen. Tap OK to continue with account  
creation. The next time you wake up the screen, tap Set PIN or Set  
Password. Enter a PIN or Password and tap Done. If you encounter  
problems while setting up an Exchange account, see Set up email:  
If you change an event, the change is made in the appropriate calendar.  
102 Chapter 9 : Contacts, Calendar, and other personal information  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Microsoft Exchange and Lotus Notes to learn about setting up an  
account manually.  
5
Depending on the account, you may be presented with options for  
which apps should download data from that account. For each app,  
tap On or Off, and then tap Create account.  
4
Depending on the account, you may be presented with options for  
which apps should download data from that account. For each app,  
tap On or Off, and then tap Create account.  
Create an event  
If you are using Calendar for the first time, you go through a few different  
steps to add or access the calendar events on your device (see Use  
Calendar for the first time). Follow this procedure to add events directly on  
your device after the first time you use Calendar. For information on  
managing your device’s time settings, see Date & Time.  
NOTE If you choose to sync Calendar with an online Facebook account, your  
Facebook events show up in Calendar, but you cannot add calendar events to  
Facebook from the Calendar app. To work directly with Facebook, use the  
Facebook application developed for your device (see Facebook Tablet). To  
work directly with LinkedIn, go to linkedin.com in the Web application (see  
Web) or download the free LinkedIn application from App Catalog.  
1
2
3
4
Open Calendar  
Tap New event.  
.
Set up an online account in Calendar  
Tap Event Name and enter the event name.  
1
2
Open Calendar  
.
Tap the account name below the Event Location field, and tap the  
calendar you want to use for this event.  
Do one of the following:  
To set up an online account the first time you use Contacts: See  
To set up an online account any other time: Open the application  
menu, tap Preferences & Accounts, tap Add an account, tap an  
account type and go to step 3. To set up an account type that is  
not listed, tap Find More to find an app and follow the instructions  
onscreen.  
NOTE If an account doesn’t appear in the list, you can’t add data to that  
account from your device.  
5
6
In the From and To fields, tap the start and finish times and dates for  
the event.  
Tap Done.  
3
4
Enter the account information, and then tap Sign in.  
If you are setting up an Exchange account, you may see a message  
telling you that you must set a PIN or password for the device the  
next time you wake up the screen. Tap OK to continue with account  
creation. The next time you wake up the screen, tap Set PIN or Set  
Password. Enter a PIN or Password and tap Done. If you encounter  
problems while setting up an Exchange account, see Set up email:  
Microsoft Exchange and Lotus Notes to learn about setting up an  
account manually.  
Enter the event location  
1
To create a new event, tap New event. To enter the event location  
after creating an event, tap the event name in Day view, and tap  
Edit.  
2
Tap Event location and enter the location.  
Chapter 9 : Contacts, Calendar, and other personal information 103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
3
Tap Done.  
Schedule a repeating event  
1
To create a new event, tap New event. To set an event as repeating  
after creating the event, tap the event name in Day view, and tap  
Edit.  
TIP Need to find the event location on a map? Open an event that has a  
location specified in the Event Location field, and tap the location address. The  
location is displayed in the Maps app.  
2
3
Tap No Repeat, and then tap a repeat interval or Custom to define a  
repeat interval and set the end date.  
Invite others to an event  
Tap Done.  
You can invite others to an event you create in an Exchange calendar.  
DID YOU KNOW? To enter a birthday, anniversary, or holiday, create an  
untimed event. Then select Yearly on [date] as the repeat interval. See Create an  
1
To create a new event, tap New event. To invite others to an event  
after creating the event, tap the event name in Day view, and tap  
Edit.  
2
3
4
Tap the account name below the Event Location field, and tap an  
Exchange calendar.  
Add an alarm to an event  
Tap To. Enter an email address or tap  
address.  
and tap a contact email  
1
To create a new event, tap New event. To add an alarm after  
creating an event, tap the event name in Day view, and tap Edit.  
Tap Send.  
2
The default alarm setting is 15 minutes before the start of the event.  
To change the setting, tap 15 minutes before and tap the new setting  
for the alarm.  
Contact meeting invitees  
3
Tap Done.  
You can send an email to invitees to an event you created in an Exchange  
calendar.  
Customize event notification sounds  
1
2
Tap the event name in Day view and tap [number of] attendee/  
attendees.  
The settings you apply here apply to all of your Calendar accounts.  
Tap Contact Attendees.  
1
2
3
Open Calendar  
.
This opens an email message with the participants’ addresses  
added to the To field. The default message text is “Running late. On  
my way...”. You can edit the text before sending the message.  
Open the application menu and tap Preferences & Accounts.  
Tap the Event Reminders field and tap any of the following:  
3
Tap Send.  
Vibrate: The device vibrates and makes a vibrating sound but makes  
no other sound.  
104 Chapter 9 : Contacts, Calendar, and other personal information  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
System Sound: The system sound plays.  
1
2
Open Calendar  
.
Mute: No sound plays and the device does not vibrate.  
Do any of the following:  
To see different calendar views: Tap  
(month) on the bottom of the screen.  
To remove a Calendar account from the layered calendar view:  
Tap the account you want to remove on the upper-left corner of the  
screen. Tap the account again to add it to the layered view. To  
hide all accounts, tap Hide All. Tap Show All to display all  
accounts.  
To change the color that identifies a Calendar account: Open the  
application menu and tap Preferences & Accounts. In Calendar  
Colors, tap the current color for an account, tap a new color in the  
list, and then tap Done.  
(day),  
(week), or  
Add a note to an event  
1
To create a new event, tap New event. To add a note after creating  
an event, tap the event name in Day view, and tap Edit.  
2
3
Tap Event Notes and enter the note.  
Tap Done.  
NOTE If a URL is displayed in an event note as an underlined link, you can tap  
it to open the web page in the Web app.  
Move around in Calendar  
To go to the next or previous day: In Day view, swipe left or right on the  
screen.  
Create an all-day (untimed) event  
To go to the next or previous week: In Week view, swipe left or right on  
the screen.  
To go to the next or previous month: In Month view, swipe left or right  
on the screen.  
To go to a specific day from Week or Month view: Tap the day.  
To go to a specific month, date, or year: Tap Jump to. Tap the month,  
day, and year and tap Go To Date.  
An all-day event such as a birthday appears in your calendar without a  
specific time slot.  
1
2
3
4
Open Calendar  
.
Open the application menu, tap New, and then tap All Day Event.  
To go to today: Tap Jump to and tap Show Today.  
Enter the event details.  
Tap Done.  
Quickly glimpse your schedule  
In Day, Week, or Month view, slightly drag left or right to peek at the  
next/previous day, week, or month without changing the current view.  
Change the Calendar display  
You can change the display of Calendar to show the events from all of  
your calendars or just the events recorded in one of your calendars. You  
can also change the color that identifies a calendar account, and you can  
display events in Day, Week, or Month view.  
Chapter 9 : Contacts, Calendar, and other personal information 105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
1
On your calendar, tap the meeting. The participants field shows the  
organizer name plus the number of participants.  
Delete an event  
If you delete an event that is assigned to an online account, the event is  
deleted in the online account also.  
2
3
Tap the number to see the participants’ names.  
(Optional) Tap a participant’s name. If the participant is a contact,  
the contact entry is displayed. If the participant is not a contact, tap  
Add to Contacts to add the participant to your contacts list.  
IMPORTANT When you delete an Exchange event on your device, notification  
is not sent to attendees.  
4
(Optional) Tap Contact Attendees to send an email to all  
participants.  
1
2
Open Calendar  
.
Tap the event name, tap Delete, and tap Delete again to confirm. If  
this event is one of a series of repeating events, tap the option to  
delete just this event or the entire series.  
Customize Calendar  
1
2
3
Open Calendar  
.
Respond to an event reminder  
Open the application menu and tap Preferences & Accounts.  
Set the following options:  
When an event reminder appears on the screen, tap the event description  
to open the event, or tap one of the following:  
Accounts: For all calendar accounts, tap an account to change login  
settings or remove the account. You should change login settings  
only if you have changed this information for the calendar account  
online—the information you enter here must match the information in  
the online account.  
Add account: Tap the account type and enter your username and  
password for the online calendar account. Before you can set up an  
account on your device, you must already have an account online  
with the provider.  
Contact Meeting Attendees: This opens an email message with the  
participants’ addresses added to the To field. The default message text  
is “Running late. On my way.... You can edit the text before sending  
the message.  
Dismiss: Close the notification.  
Snooze: The reminder reappears in five minutes.  
Default Calendar: If you create an event in All Calendars view, the  
event is assigned to your default calendar. Tap to change the default  
calendar.  
First Day of Week: Select the day that appears as the start of the  
week in Week view and Month view.  
View meeting participants  
Day Start and End: Tap to enter the default start and end times that  
appear in Day view and Week view.  
If you receive a meeting request, you can view the participants.  
106 Chapter 9 : Contacts, Calendar, and other personal information  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Default Event Duration: The default event duration is set to one hour.  
Tap to change this to 30 minutes or 2 hours.  
3
4
Under Accounts, tap the account name.  
Tap Remove Account and tap Remove Account again to confirm.  
Default Event Reminder: Tap the time interval for a notification to  
appear for timed and all-day events. Reminders you set for  
individual events override the default setting.  
To restart synchronization with an account you have deleted from  
Calendar: Open Accounts  
, tap the account name, and tap Off beside  
Calendar to turn synchronization on.  
Event Reminders: Select to play a sound when a calendar  
notification appears.  
Memos  
Calendar Colors: Set the color for events created in that account.  
Tap Done.  
4
All memos are backed up to your HP webOS Account.  
Manually synchronize Calendar with your online accounts  
Create a memo  
If you want to get calendar events from an online account on your device  
immediately, or upload events from your device to the online account (if  
the account allows it), you can do a manual sync. This synchronizes  
Calendar with all the accounts you have set up on your device, and it  
syncs all other apps associated with all online accounts that you selected  
for synchronization.  
1
2
3
4
Open Memos  
Tap  
.
.
Enter the memo text. Memos are saved as you type.  
Tap outside the memo to close it.  
1
2
Open Calendar  
.
Open the application menu and tap Sync Now.  
TIP You can also use Just Type to create a memo directly from Card view. Tap  
Just type and start typing the memo text . Under Quick Actions, tap New Memo.  
The Memos application opens at a new memo, with the text you entered in the  
body of the memo.  
Delete an online account from Calendar  
If you synchronize calendar events with an online account, deleting the  
account from Calendar stops synchronization of calendar events only—if  
you also sync contacts or email messages with that online account, those  
continue to synchronize. Deleting the account from Calendar also deletes  
any associated events from your device only. The entries are not deleted  
from the online account.  
Find a memo  
1
2
Open Memos  
.
1
2
Open Calendar  
.
Tap Search memos and begin typing the letters or numbers that start  
the memo.  
Open the application menu and tap Preferences & Accounts.  
Chapter 9 : Contacts, Calendar, and other personal information 107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
3
Tap the memo when it appears.  
Delete a memo  
1
2
In an open memo, tap  
Tap Delete to confirm.  
.
NOTE The results of a Just Type search that you access in Card view do not  
include memos.  
Email a memo  
Edit a memo  
1
2
In an open memo, tap  
Enter the email address.  
.
1
2
3
Open Memos  
.
Tap the memo you want to edit.  
The subject, “Just a quick memo, is automatically filled in. You can  
edit the text before sending the message.  
Tap the screen to position the cursor (see Text selection gestures),  
and edit the memo text (see Cut, copy, and paste information).  
3
Tap Send.  
Change the color of a memo  
Facebook Tablet  
Color-code your memos to help you recognize memos of a certain type.  
For example, make all of your grocery lists blue.  
1
2
3
Open Memos  
.
The Facebook Tablet app allows you to update your status, view and  
respond to friends’ comments, and more.  
Tap the memo.  
Tap a color at the top of the screen.  
Install Facebook Tablet  
BEFORE YOU BEGIN To use Facebook Tablet on your device, you must  
already have a Facebook account.  
This section describes the procedure for downloading and installing the  
free Facebook Tablet app. Installing this app is different from setting up  
an online account on your device, which enables you to see your  
Facebook data in Contacts, Calendar, and Photos & Videos (see Use the  
you both install the free app and create the online account on your  
device.  
4
Tap outside the memo to close it.  
108 Chapter 9 : Contacts, Calendar, and other personal information  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
1
2
Open Facebook Tablet  
. This opens the Facebook Tablet app  
page in HP webOS App Catalog.  
If this is your first time using App Catalog, tap your country, and tap  
Continue.  
3
4
5
6
If required, tap Accept to agree to the terms and conditions.  
Tap Free beside Facebook Tablet.  
If a Location Services notification appears, tap Continue.  
When the app is installed, tap Launch.  
Chapter 9 : Contacts, Calendar, and other personal information 109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
110 Chapter 9 : Contacts, Calendar, and other personal information  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10 Documents and eBooks  
If the Add an Account button is displayed: Tap Add an Account,  
and then tap the account type.  
TIP Alternatively, you can open the Quickoffice app to the files list and tap Add  
Account at the bottom of the screen. Or open the app to the files list, open the  
application menu, tap Preferences & Accounts, and then tap Add an Account.  
Quickoffice  
With Quickoffice, you can view Microsoft Word, Excel®, and PowerPoint®  
files on your device.  
NOTE The Quickoffice app is periodically updated. Because of this, the app  
may offer more functionality and features than those described in this chapter.  
For the most up-to-date information on Quickoffice, see the on-device Help.  
3
4
5
Enter your account username or email address and password.  
Tap Sign In.  
Set up Quickoffice to access files from an online account  
Under Use Account With, make sure the Documents option is set to  
On.  
You can use the Quickoffice app to view files that are stored on your  
device. You can also set up the Quickoffice app to access files in online  
accounts such as Google Docs, Dropbox, or MobileMe. You must have  
an account online, and then set up the account in Quickoffice on your  
device.  
6
Tap Create Account.  
Open a file  
1
2
Open Quickoffice  
.
You can view files in an online account that you set up, files that you copy  
computer), or files that you receive as an email attachment (see Open  
Do one of the following:  
If a list of accounts is displayed: Tap the account type.  
Chapter 10 : Documents and eBooks 111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
email attachments). You can view files in DOC, DOCX, TXT, XLS, XLSX,  
PPT, and PPTX formats.  
Send a file as an attachment to an email message  
1
Do one of the following:  
BEFORE YOU BEGIN Before you put a file on your device, make sure you  
have enough storage space on your device to fit the file. Open Device  
To send a single file: With the file open, open the application  
menu and tap Send.  
Info  
and look at the Available field under Device.  
To send multiple files: On the file list, tap  
want to send. To search for a specific file or files, tap Search  
[account name] and type the file name. Tap Attach.  
. Tap the files you  
1
Open Quickoffice  
.
2
The first time you open the Quickoffice app, you have the option to  
set up the app to work with files from an online account. To do that,  
just want to work with files on your device or with an account that’s  
already set up, tap Go.  
2
Create the email message and tap Send.  
Print a Word document or PowerPoint presentation  
3
Any online accounts you set up on your device appear in the left  
panel. The option My TouchPad also appears. Tap an account to  
view files in that account. Tap My TouchPad to view files stored in the  
USB drive storage on your device.  
You can print a document or presentation on an HP printer that is  
connected to a wireless network. See the instructions that came with your  
printer for information about setting up a printer on a wireless network.  
4
5
To view files of a certain type only, tap Show, and then tap  
Documents, PDFs, Presentations, or Spreadsheets. To see all files,  
tap All files.  
BEFORE YOU BEGIN Your device supports printing on all network-capable  
HP printers that support PCL page description language in the local LAN.  
These printers include new HP ePrint-capable printers–Photosmart,  
Officejet, and LaserJet–as well as legacy printers approximately five years  
old or newer. Make sure your printer is turned on and that both your  
device and the printer are connected to your local or corporate wireless  
network. For personal printers, see the instructions that came with your  
printer for information about setting up a printer on a wireless network.  
Tap the file.  
NOTE If you tap a PDF file, it opens in the Adobe Reader application on your  
device. See Adobe Reader for information.  
1
2
Open the file you want to print.  
6
To return to the file list, tap Documents in the upper-left corner of the  
screen.  
Tap  
at the top right corner of the screen, or open the application  
menu and tap Print.  
TIP If the print icon is not displayed at the top of the screen, tap the screen to  
display it.  
Change the display size  
Pinch out to enlarge items onscreen.  
Pinch in to decrease the size of items onscreen.  
Printers that are available on your current wireless network are  
displayed.  
For more information on zooming in and out, see Pinch (zoom gestures).  
112 Chapter 10 : Documents and eBooks  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3
Do one of the following:  
Switch among sheets in a spreadsheet  
If this is your first time using a printer on this network: If a list of  
printers is displayed, tap one.  
Tap the sheet you want to jump to at the bottom of the screen.  
If you have already used a printer on this network: The last printer  
you used is remembered and is selected. If you want to select  
another printer, scroll down on the Print dialog box (if needed),  
tap Select Another Printer, and then tap a printer.  
To set up a printer manually or on a corporate network: Scroll  
down in the list of printers (if needed) and tap Add a Printer. Tap  
Enter an IP address and enter the IP address of the printer.  
(Optional) Tap Name this printer and enter a name to identify the  
printer. Tap Done.  
Resize rows and columns in a spreadsheet  
1
To resize a row, tap and hold the row number. To resize a column,  
tap and hold the column header line to the right of the column you  
want to resize.  
2
Drag the row or column.  
4
(Optional) Depending on the printer you are using and the file type,  
you can set the following printer attributes:  
Switch among slides in a PowerPoint® slideshow  
Do one of the following:  
Number of Copies: Tap 1 and tap the number of copies you want to  
print.  
To move to the next or previous slide: Drag up or down on the screen.  
To jump to a different slide: Tap the currently displayed slide number in  
the upper-right corner of the screen. Tap the slide you want to jump to.  
2-Sided Printing: Tap Off to switch 2-sided printing from Off to On.  
Color Printing: Tap On to switch color printing from On to Off.  
To view all slides as thumbnails: Tap  
screen. Tap a thumbnail to open the slide. To dismiss the thumbnails  
panel, drag all the way to the right.  
in the upper-right corner of the  
Print Quality: Tap the currently displayed option, and tap the quality  
you want (Draft, Normal, or Best).  
5
Tap Print.  
TIP If the page number and thumbnail icons are not displayed at the top of the  
screen, tap the screen to display them.  
To cancel a print job, tap Cancel while the file is preparing to print,  
or while printing is in progress, tap  
the notification, and then tap  
Print Queue.  
at the top of the screen, tap  
to the right of the print job in the  
Edit or delete an online account in Quickoffice  
If you change the username, email address, or password you use with an  
online account, you need to enter the new information in the account  
settings on your device.  
Scroll rows or columns in a spreadsheet  
To scroll rows: Flick up or down on the screen.  
To scroll columns: Swipe left or right on the screen.  
1
2
Open Quickoffice  
.
Open the application menu and tap Preferences & Accounts.  
Chapter 10 : Documents and eBooks 113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3
4
Tap the account name.  
Do one of the following:  
If the Add an Account button is displayed: Tap Add an Account,  
and then tap the account type.  
TIP Alternatively, you can open the Adobe Reader app to the files list and tap  
Add Account at the bottom of the screen. Or open the app to the files list, open  
the application menu, tap Preferences & Accounts, and then tap Add an  
Account.  
To change the account display name: Under Account Name, tap  
the current name to highlight it, and enter the new name.  
To change the username, email address, or password associated  
with the account: Tap the appropriate field and enter the new  
information. Tap Sign In.  
To delete the account: Tap Remove Account. Tap Remove Account  
again to confirm.  
Adobe Reader  
With Adobe Reader, you can view PDF (Adobe Acrobat) files on your  
device.  
3
4
5
Enter your account username or email address and password.  
Tap Sign In.  
NOTE The Adobe Reader app is periodically updated. Because of this, the app  
may offer more functionality and features than those described in this chapter.  
For the most up-to-date information on Adobe Reader, see the on-device Help.  
Under Use Account With, make sure the Documents option is set to  
On.  
6
Tap Create Account.  
Set up Adobe Reader to access files from an online account  
Open a file  
You can use the Adobe Reader app to view files that are stored on your  
device. You can also set up the Adobe Reader app to access files in  
online accounts such as Google Docs, Dropbox, or MobileMe. You must  
have an account online, and then set up the account in Adobe Reader on  
your device.  
You can view a PDF file that you copy from your computer (see Copy files  
between your device and your computer) or receive as an email  
attachment (see Open email attachments).  
BEFORE YOU BEGIN Before you put a file on your device, make sure you  
have enough storage space on your device to fit the file. Open Device  
1
2
Open Adobe Reader  
.
Info  
and look at the Available field under Device.  
Do one of the following:  
1
Open Adobe Reader  
.
If a list of accounts is displayed: Tap the account type.  
2
The first time you open Adobe Reader, you have the option to set up  
the app to work with files from an online account. To do that, see Set  
114 Chapter 10 : Documents and eBooks  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
want to work with files on your device or with an account that’s  
already set up, tap Go.  
Send a file as an attachment to an email message  
1
Do one of the following:  
3
4
5
Any online accounts you set up on your device appear in the left  
panel. The option My TouchPad also appears. Tap an account to  
view files in that account. Tap My TouchPad to view files stored in the  
USB drive storage on your device.  
To send a single file: With the file open, open the application  
menu and tap Send.  
To send multiple files: On the file list, tap  
. Tap the files you  
want to send. To search for a specific file or files, tap Search and  
type the file name. Tap Attach.  
Tap the file.  
2
Create the email message and tap Send.  
If the PDF file was created with a password, enter the password to  
open the file.  
To return to the file list, tap Documents in the upper-left corner of the  
screen.  
Print a PDF file  
You can print a file on an HP printer that is connected to a wireless  
network. See the instructions that came with your printer for information  
about setting up a printer on a wireless network.  
Move around in a file  
BEFORE YOU BEGIN Your device supports printing on all network-capable  
HP printers that support PCL page description language in the local LAN.  
These printers include new HP ePrint-capable printers–Photosmart,  
Officejet, and LaserJet–as well as legacy printers approximately five years  
old or newer. Make sure your printer is turned on and that both your  
device and the printer are connected to your local or corporate wireless  
network. For personal printers, see the instructions that came with your  
printer for information about setting up a printer on a wireless network.  
To move to the next or previous page: Drag up or down on the screen.  
To jump to a different page: Tap the currently displayed page number  
in the upper-right corner of the screen. Tap the page you want to jump  
to.  
To view all file pages as thumbnails: Tap  
the screen. Tap a thumbnail to open the page. To dismiss the  
thumbnails panel, drag all the way to the right.  
in the upper-right corner of  
1
2
Open the file you want to print.  
TIP If the page number and thumbnail icons are not displayed at the top of the  
screen, tap the screen to display them.  
Tap  
at the top right corner of the screen, or open the application  
menu and tap Print.  
Change the text display size  
TIP If the print icon is not displayed at the top of the screen, tap the screen to  
display it.  
Pinch out to enlarge items onscreen.  
Pinch in to decrease the size of items onscreen.  
Double-tap the screen to zoom in or out a specified amount.  
Printers that are available on your current wireless network are  
displayed.  
For more information on zooming in and out, see Pinch (zoom gestures).  
Chapter 10 : Documents and eBooks 115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3
Do one of the following:  
Edit or delete an online account in Adobe Reader  
If this is your first time using a printer on this network: If a list of  
printers is displayed, tap one.  
If you have already used a printer on this network: The last printer  
you used is remembered and is selected. If you want to select  
another printer, scroll down on the Print dialog box (if needed),  
tap Select Another Printer, and then tap a printer.  
To set up a printer manually or on a corporate network: Scroll  
down in the list of printers (if needed) and tap Add a Printer. Tap  
Enter an IP address and enter the IP address of the printer.  
(Optional) Tap Name this printer and enter a name to identify the  
printer. Tap Done.  
If you change the username, email address, or password you use with an  
online account, you need to enter the new information in the account  
settings on your device.  
1
2
3
4
Open Adobe Reader  
.
Open the application menu and tap Preferences & Accounts.  
Tap the account name.  
Do one of the following:  
4
(Optional) Depending on the printer you are using, you can set the  
following printer attributes:  
To change the account display name: Under Account Name, tap  
the current name to highlight it, and enter the new name.  
To change the username, email address, or password associated  
with the account: Tap the appropriate field and enter the new  
information. Tap Sign In.  
Number of Copies: Tap 1 and tap the number of copies you want to  
print.  
To delete the account: Tap Remove Account. Tap Remove Account  
again to confirm.  
2-Sided Printing: Tap Off to switch 2-sided printing from Off to On.  
Color Printing: Tap On to switch color printing from On to Off.  
Page Range: Tap the currently displayed range, and enter the range  
you want.  
Amazon Kindle  
Print Quality: Tap the currently displayed option, and tap the quality  
you want (Draft, Normal, or Best).  
The Amazon Kindle app lets you read eBooks from the Amazon Kindle  
store on your HP TouchPad. The app is available as a free download from  
HP webOS App Catalog.  
5
Tap Print.  
To cancel a print job, tap Cancel while the file is preparing to print,  
1
2
3
On the Launcher, tap Amazon Kindle  
. This opens the Amazon  
or while printing is in progress, tap  
the notification, and then tap  
Print Queue.  
at the top of the screen, tap  
Kindle app page in App Catalog.  
to the right of the print job in the  
If this is your first time using App Catalog, tap your country, and tap  
Continue.  
If required, tap Accept to agree to the terms and conditions.  
116 Chapter 10 : Documents and eBooks  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
4
5
To download and install the app, tap Free.  
To open the app after you install it, tap Launch.  
After installation, the Amazon Kindle Launcher icon opens the app itself,  
not App Catalog.  
Chapter 10 : Documents and eBooks 117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
118 Chapter 10 : Documents and eBooks  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11 Phone & Video Calls  
Use Skype voice and video calling  
To use Skype on your device, you need to either sign in to a Skype  
account you already have set up online, or create a new Skype account.  
What kinds of calls can I make and receive with Skype?  
You can use Skype to make and receive the following types of calls:  
How can I make and receive calls with my HP  
TouchPad?  
Free Skype-to-Skype video calls  
Free Skype-to-Skype audio calls  
Skype calls to a mobile or other phone number. These calls require a  
paid Skype account (see Use Skype to dial a phone number).  
You can make and receive calls on your HP TouchPad in the following  
ways:  
Create a Skype account in Phone & Video Calls  
If you have a Skype account set up on your device, you can use Skype  
to make Skype video and voice calls, as well as calls to a phone  
If you have an HP webOS smartphone, you can connect your HP  
TouchPad to the smartphone and then make, receive, and manage calls  
on your HP TouchPad using the connected smartphone. See Use your  
If you do not have a Skype account, you can create one right on your  
device in the Phone & Video Calls application. You can also create a  
Skype account in Accounts (see Create a Skype account in Accounts),  
Contacts (see Create a Skype account in Contacts), and Messaging (see  
After you create a Skype account, you remain signed in to that account  
and can use it at any time. To sign out of a Skype account, remove it from  
your device (see Edit or delete a Skype account).  
Chapter 11 : Phone & Video Calls 119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
1
2
Open Phone & Video Calls  
.
After you sign in to a Skype account, you remain signed in to that account  
and can use it at any time. To sign out of a Skype account, remove it from  
your device (see Edit or delete a Skype account).  
Do one of the following:  
If a Skype button is displayed when you open the app: Tap Skype.  
If an Add an Account button is displayed: Tap Add an Account  
and tap Skype.  
1
2
Open Phone & Video Calls  
.
Do one of the following:  
Any other time: Open the application menu and tap Preferences &  
Accounts. Tap Add account and tap Skype.  
If a Skype button is displayed when you open the app: Tap Skype.  
If an Add an Account button is displayed: Tap Add an Account  
and tap Skype.  
3
4
Tap Create Account.  
Any other time: Open the application menu and tap Preferences &  
Accounts. Tap Add account and tap Skype.  
If prompted, tap Accept to agree to the account terms and  
conditions.  
3
4
5
Tap Sign In.  
5
Enter the following details:  
Enter your Skype name and password, and tap Sign In.  
Tap Create Account.  
Full Name: Enter your full name.  
Skype Name: Enter a name that you will use to identify yourself to  
other Skype users.  
Password: Enter a password and then enter it again.  
Make a Skype-to-Skype video or audio call  
Email Address: Enter your email address and then enter it again.  
6
7
Tap Create Account. On the next screen, tap Create Account again.  
Tap Done.  
BEFORE YOU BEGIN You must have one or more Skype buddies set up to  
make Skype-to-Skype calls (see Add a buddy).  
1
2
3
4
5
6
Open Phone & Video Calls  
Tap Contacts.  
.
Sign in to a Skype account in Phone & Video Calls  
Tap the Search field.  
If you have a Skype account but have not yet set it up on your device, you  
do not need to create the account again on your device. Simply sign in to  
the account to start using Skype on your device.  
Type a name or initials until the Skype contact you want appears.  
Tap the contact.  
You can also sign in to a Skype account in Accounts (see Sign in to a  
account).  
By default, the outgoing call is sent as voice only. To send outgoing  
video, tap  
.
120 Chapter 11 : Phone & Video Calls  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
7
If the other person answers the call as voice only, you can only hear  
audio from that person. If the other person answers the call as a  
video call, how you see incoming video depends on your Skype call  
preferences:  
3
4
Tap  
.
If you have the Auto-Accept Video preference turned on: Incoming  
video appears automatically.  
If you have the Auto-Accept Video preference turned off: To see  
incoming video, tap Accept when prompted.  
If prompted, select Skype to make the call using Skype.  
See Set Skype calling preferences for information.  
Answer a Skype call  
If a call comes in, an incoming call notification appears on your device.  
Skype calls are designated by Skype under the name or number on the  
notification.  
Use Skype to dial a phone number  
You can use Skype to make an international or domestic call to a phone  
number. The number you call does not need to be associated with a  
contact.  
1
To answer the call, do one of the following:  
Tap  
.
You can choose to use Skype for all calls to phone numbers, or to be  
prompted whether to use Skype or a connected HP webOS smartphone  
for a given call (see Set your dialing method).  
If a headset is attached, press the button on the headset.  
2
3
By default, when you answer a call, you answer as voice only. To  
send outgoing video, tap  
.
Calls to phone numbers are subject to Skype charges and require a  
Skype credit balance.  
If the other person makes the call as voice only, you can only hear  
audio from that person. If the other person makes the call as a video  
call, how you see incoming video depends on your Skype call  
preferences:  
TIP To check if you have a Skype credit balance, do the following: Open Phone  
& Video Calls, open the application menu, and tap Check Skype Credit. If you  
don’t see this menu item, it means you are not logged into your Skype account.  
Do this instead: Open Phone & Video Calls, open the application menu, and  
tap Preferences & Accounts. Under Accounts, tap Skype, and tap Sign In. Your  
Skype credit balance appears under Skype Credit.  
If you have the Auto-Accept Video preference turned on: Incoming  
video appears automatically.  
If you have the Auto-Accept Video preference turned off: To see  
incoming video, tap Accept when prompted.  
See Set Skype calling preferences for information.  
1
2
Open Phone & Video Calls  
.
Enter the number you want to call using any of the ways to dial  
described in these sections:  
TIP If you miss a call, a notification appears at the top of the screen. Tap the  
notification to open the missed call dashboard item. On the dashboard item,  
tap the name or number to call the person back, or tap the icon on the left to  
open your call history (see View your call history).  
Chapter 11 : Phone & Video Calls 121  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Silence the ringer on an incoming Skype call  
When you silence the ringer on an incoming call, you can answer the call  
or let it ring through to voicemail.  
Do one of the following:  
Press the power button.  
Press volume.  
*
Volume  
Ignore an incoming Skype call  
Manage a Skype-to-Skype voice call  
To send a call immediately to voicemail, do one of the following:  
Do any of the following:  
Tap  
.
Press the power button twice.  
To reply to a caller who is in your Contacts list after you ignore a call, tap  
the ignored call notification. This opens the caller’s contact entry, where  
you can select a reply method. To reply to a caller who is not in your  
Contacts list, go to your call history (see View your call history).  
Manage a Skype-to-Skype video call  
Do any of the following:  
Turn off outgoing video: Tap .Tap again to turn outgoing video back  
on.  
Mute the microphone so you can’t be heard: Tap . Tap again to  
unmute the microphone.  
Adjust call volume: Press volume.  
Make the call a video call: Tap  
Switch call audio between the device and a connected Bluetooth  
headset: Tap  
.
Mute the microphone so you can’t be heard: Tap  
unmute the microphone.  
. Tap again to  
122 Chapter 11 : Phone & Video Calls  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Make a second Skype voice call  
TIP You don’t need an on-hold button to put a call on hold. Just tap the mute  
icon to mute your end of the line.  
1
While on a Skype voice call, tap  
microphone or put the first call on hold.  
. This does not mute the  
Open the dial pad to enter numbers for navigating phone trees,  
2
Tap Contacts, and then tap the Skype contact.  
responding to prompts, and so on: Tap  
.
Add a call: Tap  
. When the dial pad appears, tap Contacts. Tap  
the contact you want to call.  
Adjust call volume: Press volume.  
Answer a second Skype voice call (call waiting)  
If you are on a Skype voice call, when a second Skype voice call  
notification appears, tap  
. The first call is put on hold.  
Switch between two Skype voice calls  
1
2
Tap  
to put the active call on hold and switch to the other call.  
*
Volume  
Tap  
to end either call. If you end the currently active call, the call  
on hold becomes active.  
Use another application while on a Skype call  
Make a conference call from multiple Skype voice calls  
While you’re on a Skype call, you can use the other applications on your  
device.  
1
Make or answer a Skype voice call, and then make or answer a  
second Skype voice call.  
1
While on a call, do one of the following:  
2
3
Tap  
to create the conference call.  
to end the conference call.  
Display Card view (see Manage applications in Card view), tap  
Just type, and begin typing the name of the app.  
When you’re done, tap  
Open the Launcher (see Open an application in the Launcher).  
2
3
Tap the application to open and work in it.  
Tap the call notification at the top of the screen to return to the call  
screen.  
Chapter 11 : Phone & Video Calls 123  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
End a Skype call  
Edit or delete a Skype account  
Do one of the following:  
If you change the name or password you use with a Skype account, you  
need to enter the new information in the account settings on your device.  
Tap  
.
1
2
3
4
Open Phone & Video Calls  
.
Minimize the call screen to a card, and throw the card off the top of the  
screen.  
If a headset is attached, press the button on the headset.  
Open the application menu and tap Preferences & Accounts.  
Under Accounts, tap Skype.  
Set Skype calling preferences  
Do one of the following:  
1
2
3
4
Open Phone & Video Calls  
.
To change the Skype name or password associated with the  
account: Tap the appropriate field and enter the new information.  
Tap Sign In.  
To delete the account: Tap Remove Account. Tap Remove Account  
again to confirm.  
Open the application menu and tap Preferences & Accounts.  
Under Accounts, tap Skype.  
Set any of the following:  
Allow Skype Calls From: Tap Only My Skype Contacts to allow calls  
from people in your Skype contacts only. Tap Anyone to allow calls  
from any Skype user.  
Use your HP TouchPad with a connected HP  
webOS smartphone  
Allow Video Calls: Select On to allow both incoming Skype video  
and Skype audio calls. Select Off to allow incoming Skype audio  
calls only.  
If you have an HP webOS smartphone, you can connect your HP  
TouchPad to the smartphone. When the two are connected, you can  
manage calls directly on your HP TouchPad.  
Auto-Accept Video: Select On to have your device automatically  
allow an incoming video call. Select Off if you want to be prompted  
whether to receive an incoming video call.  
You can connect your HP TouchPad to a webOS smartphone in the  
following ways:  
Show Video is Enabled: Select On if you want your Skype contacts  
to see if you have video enabled or not. Select Off if you do not  
want your contacts to see this.  
Touch to share: For certain supported webOS smartphones, simply  
touch the smartphone to your HP TouchPad to make a connection. To  
share calls, the smartphone and your device must use the same HP  
webOS Account. See Touch to Share.  
Bluetooth® wireless technology: For many webOS smartphone models,  
use your device’s Bluetooth feature to pair with and connect to the  
5
Tap Done.  
The Phone & Video Calls application: If you open the Phone & Video  
Calls application on your device before you have connected to a  
124 Chapter 11 : Phone & Video Calls  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
smartphone, the app prompts you to connect your device to a  
do not see the Allow prompt, you cannot share text messages  
between your device and your smartphone.  
7
(Optional) On your device, tap  
beside the smartphone name  
and turn any of the following options on or off for how you want to  
use your device with the smartphone:  
NOTE For certain supported webOS smartphones, connecting through Touch to  
Share enables you to read, send, and reply to text messages from your device  
through the connected smartphone (see Messaging: Text messaging).  
Auto-Connect: The device and smartphone connect anytime they are  
within range of one another.  
Receive Phone Calls: Manage incoming and outgoing phone calls  
directly on your device.  
Connect your device to a webOS smartphone in the Phone &  
Video Calls application  
Receive SMS: Send, receive, and reply to text messages directly on  
your device. This feature is supported on certain HP webOS  
smartphones only.  
BEFORE YOU BEGIN The webOS smartphone you are connecting to must be  
discoverable. Check the documentation that came with your smartphone  
for information on making it discoverable.  
TIP If you want to change these settings later, you can do so in the Bluetooth  
1
2
Open Phone & Video Calls  
.
If the Connect Phone option appears, tap Connect Phone. If this  
option does not appear, do not continue with this procedure.  
Instead, use the Bluetooth app to connect your device to the webOS  
smartphone (see Bluetooth® wireless technology).  
NOTE You cannot send or receive multimedia messages on your device. If you  
receive a multimedia message on a connected smartphone, a notification  
appears on your device. You need to view the message on the smartphone,  
however.  
3
4
If Bluetooth is off, tap Off to turn Bluetooth on.  
Do one of the following:  
Dial by contact name using Just Type  
If the smartphone you want to connect to is listed in the Devices  
list, tap it.  
1
Open Card view (see Manage applications in Card view) and tap  
If the smartphone you want to connect to is not listed in the  
Devices list, tap Add device, tap the Type field, and then tap  
webOS Phone. When the smartphone you want to connect to is  
found, tap it.  
Just type.  
2
Begin typing a contact’s first or last name, initials (no space), email  
address, or phone number.  
5
6
On your smartphone, tap Yes, Allow to complete the pairing  
process.  
NOTE Just Type searches contacts on your HP TouchPad, not on a connected  
smartphone.  
On your smartphone, if prompted, tap Allow to allow shared  
messaging between the smartphone and your HP TouchPad. This  
feature is supported on certain HP webOS smartphones only. If you  
Chapter 11 : Phone & Video Calls 125  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
3
4
Tap one of the contact’s phone numbers to dial it. If only the contact  
name appears, tap the name to display the phone numbers for that  
contact, and tap a number.  
TIP Tap the onscreen backspace icon (at the top of the dial pad, to the right of  
the number you entered) to delete numbers one at a time. Tap and hold the icon  
to delete all the numbers.  
If prompted, tap Bluetooth to make the call using a connected  
smartphone.  
Dial a favorite  
Dial using the onscreen dial pad  
See Create a favorite in Phone & Video Calls for instructions on creating a  
favorite.  
The onscreen dial pad is useful when you need to dial numbers that are  
expressed as letters and when you need large, brightly lit numbers that  
you can tap.  
1
2
3
Open Phone & Video Calls  
Tap Favorites.  
.
1
2
3
Open Phone & Video Calls  
.
Tap the favorite. The call is made using the default number you  
selected for that favorite.  
If the dial pad is not displayed, tap Dialpad.  
Tap the dial pad numbers to enter the number.  
4
If prompted, tap Bluetooth to make the call using a connected  
smartphone.  
Dial by contact name in the Phone & Video Calls application  
adding contacts to your device. You can also look up and dial contacts  
using Just Type (see Dial by contact name using Just Type).  
NOTE If you set up a Skype account on your device, see Use Skype voice and  
video calling for information on calling Skype contacts.  
1
2
3
Open Phone & Video Calls  
Tap Contacts.  
.
4
5
Tap  
to dial.  
If prompted, tap Bluetooth to make the call using a connected  
smartphone.  
Tap the Search field.  
126 Chapter 11 : Phone & Video Calls  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
4
Type a name or initials until the contact you want appears. If your  
company uses Microsoft Exchange Server with a Global Address List  
(GAL), entering the contact search information returns matching  
results from the GAL as well.  
1
If a phone number appears as an underlined link, tap the number.  
This displays the dial pad with the number already entered.  
2
3
Tap  
to dial.  
If prompted, tap Bluetooth to make the call using a connected  
smartphone.  
Answer an incoming call through a connected smartphone  
If a call comes in, an incoming call notification appears on your device.  
To answer the call, do one of the following:  
5
6
Tap the number.  
Tap  
.
If prompted, tap Bluetooth to make the call using a connected  
smartphone.  
If a headset is attached, press the button on the headset.  
TIP If you miss a call, a notification appears at the top of the screen. Tap the  
notification to open the missed call dashboard item. On the dashboard item,  
tap the name or number to call the person back, or tap the icon on the left to  
open your call history (see View your call history).  
Redial the last number dialed  
1
2
3
Open Phone & Video Calls  
.
If the dial pad is not displayed, tap Dialpad.  
Silence the ringer on an incoming call through a connected  
smartphone  
Tap  
. When the contact name or number appears at the top of  
again to dial.  
the screen, tap  
4
If prompted, tap Bluetooth to make the call using a connected  
smartphone.  
When you silence the ringer on an incoming call, you can answer the call  
or let it ring through to voicemail. Silencing the ringer on your device  
does not silence the ringer on a connected smartphone.  
Dial from another application  
Do one of the following:  
If a phone number appears in another application as an underlined link,  
you can begin dialing the number directly from that application. For  
example, you can dial phone numbers that appear in web pages; in  
messages; or in notes to calendar events.  
Press the power button.  
Press volume.  
Chapter 11 : Phone & Video Calls 127  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Mute the microphone so you can’t be heard: Tap  
.
Ignore a call through a connected smartphone  
TIP You don’t need an on-hold button to put a call on hold. Just tap the mute  
icon to mute your end of the line.  
To send a call immediately to voicemail, do one of the following:  
Tap  
.
Press the power button twice.  
Open the dial pad to enter numbers for navigating phone trees,  
responding to prompts, and so on: Tap  
.
To reply to a caller who is in your Contacts list after you ignore a call, tap  
the ignored call notification. This opens the caller’s contact entry, where  
you can select a reply method. To reply to a caller who is not in your  
Contacts list, go to your call history (see View your call history).  
Adjust call volume: Press volume.  
Manage a call through a connected smartphone  
This information applies to calls through a connected smartphone, as well  
as Skype calls to a phone number. For information on Skype-to-Skype  
*
Volume  
Do any of the following:  
DID YOU KNOW? You can send and receive text messages during a call. This is  
a great way to stay connected with friends and colleagues during a long call  
Use another application while on a call through a connected  
smartphone  
While you’re on a call using a connected smartphone, you can use the  
other applications on your device.  
1
While on a call, do one of the following:  
Display Card view (see Manage applications in Card view), tap  
Just type, and begin typing the name of the app.  
Open the Launcher (see Open an application in the Launcher).  
Switch call audio between the smartphone and the device: Tap  
and then tap TouchPad or Phone.  
,
128 Chapter 11 : Phone & Video Calls  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2
3
Tap the application to open and work in it.  
If you do not have visual voicemail set up: If prompted, tap Skype  
or Bluetooth to select which type of voicemail messages you want  
to listen to. Your device connects the appropriate voicemail system.  
Tap the call notification at the top of the screen to return to the call  
screen.  
3
Follow the voice prompts to listen to your messages.  
End a call through a connected smartphone  
View your call history  
Do one of the following:  
Tap  
.
Your call history is more than just a log. It’s also a place where you can  
dial a number, send a text message, and save or view contacts. Your  
device displays entries for any calls you made or received on the device  
itself, either using Skype or through a connected smartphone. The history  
does not display entries for smartphone calls that you did not make or  
answer on the device.  
Minimize the call screen to a card, and throw the card off the top of the  
screen.  
If a headset is attached, press the button on the headset.  
Listen to voicemail messages  
1
2
3
Open Phone & Video Calls  
Tap Call-Log.  
.
You can check voicemail messages left on Skype calls, as well as on calls  
through a connected smartphone. To use voicemail on your device, you  
must have a Skype account set up on your device, or have voicemail set  
up on the connected smartphone.  
Do any of the following:  
If you have visual voicemail set up on either Skype or a connected  
smartphone, you can view a list of voicemail messages on your device.  
1
Do one of the following:  
Tap a voicemail notification at the top of the screen.  
To call a number: Tap the number.  
To display other options for the contact or number: Tap  
right side of the call history entry.  
Open Phone & Video Calls  
. Then tap Voicemail.  
on the  
Open Phone & Video Calls  
hold 1 onscreen.  
. Tap Dialpad, and then tap and  
DID YOU KNOW? If a call history entry displays a number next to the contact  
picture or icon, this indicates that you made and/or received multiple calls to or  
from that phone number or contact in the same day. If you had calls to or from a  
contact using more than one of that contact’s phone numbers, all calls are  
collapsed into a single entry, and the most recently used phone number is  
displayed.  
2
Do one of the following:  
If you have visual voicemail set up on either Skype or a connected  
smartphone: A list of your voicemail messages is displayed. Tap a  
message to listen to it.  
Chapter 11 : Phone & Video Calls 129  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
To delete a call history entry: Throw the entry off the side of the  
3
4
Tap Add Favorite, search for the contact, and tap the contact when  
screen. Tap Delete to confirm.  
the name appears.  
To clear the call history: Open the application menu, tap Clear  
Call History, and tap Clear Call History to confirm.  
If the contact has more than one phone number, tap the number you  
want to set as the favorite. When you call the favorite, the call is  
made using this number.  
4
If you displayed additional options for the contact or number, do  
any of the following:  
To call an alternate number for a contact: Tap the number.  
View favorite details  
To send a text message: Tap  
.
From the favorites list, you can dial a different phone number for that  
contact, send a message, or view the favorite’s contact entry.  
To save the number to Contacts: Tap Add to Contacts (see Save a  
To view a contact entry: Tap View Contact.  
TIP In the favorites list, you can change the order of any favorite with an  
assigned default number (see Create a favorite in Phone & Video Calls and Set  
or change the default number for a favorite) by tapping and dragging. So you  
can put the people you call most at the top of the list.  
DID YOU KNOW? The additional options display includes the time and type  
(incoming, outgoing, missed) of the call. If a call history entry collapses multiple  
calls, the additional options show information for each call.  
1
2
3
4
Open Phone & Video Calls  
Tap Favorites.  
.
Work with favorites  
Tap  
to the right of the favorite name.  
You can quickly reach your closest contacts by phone, email, or text  
message by designating them as favorites. Creating a favorite from a  
contact lets you view and touch base with that contact in just a few taps.  
Do one of the following:  
To call the favorite using a different number: Tap the number.  
To send the favorite a text message: Tap  
To view the favorite’s contact entry: Tap View Contact.  
.
For instructions on calling a contact you designate as a favorite, see Dial  
Add a phone number to a favorite  
Create a favorite in Phone & Video Calls  
If you create a favorite in Contacts, but the contact does not have a phone  
number associated with it, you can add a phone number to the favorite in  
Phone & Video Calls.  
You can also create favorites in Contacts (see Create a favorite).  
1
2
Open Phone & Video Calls  
Tap Favorites.  
.
1
2
Open Phone & Video Calls  
.
Tap Favorites and tap the favorite.  
130 Chapter 11 : Phone & Video Calls  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
3
4
Enter the number, and tap to select the phone number type (see  
Create a contact for information).  
1
2
3
Open Phone & Video Calls  
Tap Favorites.  
.
Tap Done.  
Throw the favorite off the side of the screen. Tap Delete to confirm.  
NOTE You can enter more than one phone number for the favorite here. If you  
do, you need to set one of the numbers as the default (see Set or change the  
TIP You can also remove a contact as a favorite from within the Contacts app  
Set or change the default number for a favorite  
Save a phone number to Contacts  
If you create a favorite in Contacts, but the contact has more than one  
phone number associated with it, you need to set the default number for  
the favorite in the Phone & Video Calls app.  
You can create a new contact directly from an incoming or outgoing call  
in Phone & Video Calls. If an incoming call uses caller ID blocking, you  
cannot create a contact for the number.  
Also follow these steps if you want to use a different number as the default  
number for a favorite.  
1
Do one of the following:  
1
2
3
Open Phone & Video Calls  
Tap Favorites.  
.
If you enter a phone number in Just Type that is not associated with  
a contact, tap Add to Contacts.  
Before dialing a number you entered in the dial pad, tap Add to  
Contacts.  
Do one of the following:  
During a call, tap  
at the top of the screen.  
To set a default number: Tap the favorite.  
After a call, from the dial pad, tap Call-Log. Tap  
on the right  
side of the call history entry, and tap Add To Contacts.  
To change the default number: Tap  
to the right of the favorite  
name, and tap Change Default Number.  
2
On the new contact screen, enter the information for the contact,  
and tap Done.  
4
Tap the number you want to use.  
Remove a contact from the favorites list  
Use a phone headset  
When you remove a contact as a favorite, you do not delete the contact  
itself. The contact no longer shows up as a favorite in Phone & Video  
Calls, Contacts, Email, Messaging, or Just Type search results.  
You can connect a 3.5mm headset to your device for hands-free  
operation. You can also connect to a wireless headset using Bluetooth®  
wireless technology. Both 3.5mm and wireless headsets are sold  
separately.  
Chapter 11 : Phone & Video Calls 131  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Set up and use a Bluetooth® hands-free device  
WARNING If driving while using a phone is permitted in your area, we  
recommend using a headset or hands-free car kit (sold separately). However, be  
aware that use of a headset that covers both ears impairs your ability to hear  
other sounds. Use of such a headset while operating a motor vehicle or riding a  
bicycle may create a serious hazard to you and others, and may be illegal. If  
you must use a stereo headset while driving, place a speaker in only one ear.  
Leave the other ear free to hear outside noises, and use the headset only if it is  
legal and you can do so safely.  
If you are on a Skype call, you can listen to the call audio through a  
compatible headset enabled with Bluetooth® wireless technology.  
NOTE You cannot use a Bluetooth headset with calls made through a  
connected webOS smartphone.  
Your device is compatible with many headsets (sold separately) enabled  
with Bluetooth version 2.1, with EDR and Stereo (with AVRCP media  
controls).  
Use a wired headset  
Your device works with headsets that have a 3.5mm connector (look for  
three colored bands on the plug). When in doubt, ask the third-party  
headset manufacturer if the product is compatible with your device. If you  
hear a headset buzz or poor microphone performance, your headset may  
be incompatible with your device.  
After you set up a connection with a Bluetooth headset, you can  
communicate using that device whenever it is within range and the  
Bluetooth feature on your device is turned on. The range can vary greatly,  
depending on environmental factors. The maximum is about 30 feet (10  
meters).  
1
Insert a 3.5mm headset into the headset jack on the top of your  
device. When you are on a call, the call audio is automatically  
routed to the headset.  
NOTE You can use an A2DP-enabled Bluetooth headset or speakers to listen to  
music files on your device.  
2
The button on the headset performs different actions depending on  
the headset model and what’s happening on the device. Press the  
button once to perform any of the following tasks supported by your  
particular headset:  
1
2
Open Bluetooth  
.
If the Bluetooth setting at the top of the screen is off, tap Off to switch  
the Bluetooth feature from Off to On.  
Answer an incoming call.  
3
4
5
6
Tap Add device.  
Respond to call waiting.  
Hang up a single active call or all calls on a conference call.  
In Type, make sure Audio is selected.  
Tap the device name.  
3
To switch the call audio to a different device, do one of the  
following:  
To use a Bluetooth device with your HP TouchPad, follow the  
instructions that came with the Bluetooth device.  
To switch from the headset to your device’s speakers: Disconnect  
the headset.  
To switch from the headset to a connected smartphone: Tap  
and then tap Phone.  
,
132 Chapter 11 : Phone & Video Calls  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
7
To switch the call audio to a different device, do one of the  
following:  
Example: A complete phone number in your company’s phone system has  
11 numbers, for example, 1-408-555-1122. When dialing from a phone  
that’s part of the system, you need to dial only the last five digits (51122).  
When you create a dialing shortcut on your device, you select “5 digit  
numbers” for When I Dial and enter “140855” in Use This Dialing Prefix.  
So when you dial your co-worker’s five-digit extension (51122), your  
device automatically dials the whole number: 1-408-555-1122.  
To switch from the headset to the speakers on your HP TouchPad:  
Disconnect the headset.  
To switch from the headset to a connected smartphone: Tap  
and then tap Phone.  
,
For more information on using the Bluetooth feature on your device, see  
Set your dialing method  
If you have both a Skype account and a connected smartphone (see  
account in Phone & Video Calls), you can set whether your device dials  
calls using a connected smartphone or the Skype account. Alternatively,  
you can select to be prompted for the account to use each time you make  
a call.  
Customize Phone & Video Calls settings  
Use dialing shortcuts  
1
2
3
Open Phone & Video Calls  
.
Dialing shortcuts add a prefix at the beginning of a number, so you can  
dial an extension instead of the whole number.  
Open the application menu and tap Preferences & Accounts.  
In Use, tap one of the following:  
1
2
3
4
Open Phone & Videos Calls  
.
Open the application menu and tap Preferences & Accounts.  
Under Dialing Shortcuts, tap Add a number.  
Set the following:  
To use a connected smartphone for outgoing calls: Tap Bluetooth.  
To use your Skype account for outgoing calls: Tap Skype.  
To see a prompt asking you which method you want to use every  
time you make a call: Tap Always Ask.  
When I Dial: Tap this field and select the number of digits you need  
to enter to have your device add a dialing prefix.  
4
Tap Done.  
Use This Dialing Prefix: Enter the prefix to be added at the  
beginning of the dialed number. The combination of prefix and  
digits you enter must add up to a complete phone number.  
Select the smartphone to use for calls and text messages  
If your device is paired with more than one webOS smartphone, you can  
select the one to use for calls (and text messages, if supported). You can  
connect with only one smartphone at a time.  
5
Tap Done.  
1
Open Phone & Video Calls  
.
Chapter 11 : Phone & Video Calls 133  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
2
3
Open the application menu and tap Preferences & Accounts.  
Under Tap the device you’d like to use, tap the smartphone you want  
to use for calls (and text messages, if supported).  
4
Tap Done.  
134 Chapter 11 : Phone & Video Calls  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12 HP webOS App Catalog and Software Manager  
NOTE Applications you installed on your old Palm OS by ACCESS or Windows  
Mobile smartphone do not work on your HP TouchPad because your HP  
TouchPad uses the new HP webOS. In addition, some apps developed for HP  
webOS smartphones may not work on your HP TouchPad. Check App Catalog  
for a new version of your old favorites.  
1
2
Open HP App Catalog  
.
The first time you open App Catalog, if prompted, select your  
country.  
IMPORTANT Be sure to select the correct country. You can’t change it later.  
Browse applications in HP webOS App  
Catalog  
3
4
The first time you open App Catalog, review the terms of use and tap  
Accept.  
Do one of the following:  
Use HP webOS App Catalog to browse and download any of the many  
applications available for your device. App Catalog contains both free  
apps and apps you can buy.  
To browse Pivot, a magazine showcasing new apps: Tap Featured  
at the bottom of the screen. Swipe right and left on the screen to  
turn pages.  
To search by category: Tap Categories at the bottom of the screen,  
and tap a category. To view subcategories for a category, tap All  
[category name] at the top of the screen, and tap a subcategory. If  
a subcategory screen displays the subcategory name at the top,  
tap the name to view further subcategories. Tap the arrow next to  
the subcategory name to return to the list of subcategories.  
NOTE HP webOS App Catalog is periodically updated. Because of this, the  
app may offer more functionality and features than those described in this  
chapter. For the most up-to-date information on App Catalog, see the on-device  
Help.  
To search applications you bookmarked: Tap Bookmarks at the  
bottom of the screen.  
Chapter 12 : HP webOS App Catalog and Software Manager 135  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
To search by name: Tap Search at the bottom of the screen. Type a  
search term, and then tap or tap Enter on the onscreen  
if your device is connected to an HP webOS smartphone (see Use  
keyboard. A list of apps whose name or category matches your  
search term appears.  
To search within featured, paid, free, or new apps only: After you  
start a category, bookmark, or name search, tap Top, Paid, Free,  
or New at the top of the screen.  
To see more apps from this app developer: Tap Developer Apps.  
To go to the developer’s product support page: Tap Support (if  
available).  
To report a problem with the app: Tap Report a Problem. Tap Bug  
and tap the type of problem you are reporting. Tap Type your  
problem here, enter the problem description, and tap Send.  
5
6
When the app you want appears onscreen, tap the name to display  
app details.  
On the app details screen, do any of the following:  
Download a free application  
BEFORE YOU BEGIN Before you download an app, make sure you have  
enough storage space on your device to fit the app. Open Device Info  
and look at the Available field under Device.  
1
2
Open HP App Catalog  
.
Find a free app you want (see Browse applications in HP webOS  
3
Tap Free to the right of the app name.  
TIP You can also tap the app name to open the app details screen, and tap Free  
at the top of the screen.  
To see video of the app: Tap a thumbnail image that displays the  
icon. Not all apps include videos.  
To see more thumbnails: Swipe right or left on the thumbnail area  
of the screen.  
4
If the application uses Location Services, a notification appears (see  
Location Services). Tap Continue.  
To bookmark the app: Tap  
at the top of the screen.  
TIP To pause a download, tap the Downloading progress bar. To resume  
downloading, tap Download paused.  
TIP You can also bookmark an app in the app search results list by tapping the  
bookmark icon to the right of the app name.  
5
After you download an app, tap Launch to open it. The app also  
now appears as an icon on the Downloads page in the Launcher, so  
you can open it from the Launcher as well.  
To read reviews: Under Reviews, tap Positive or Negative. Scroll to  
see more positive or negative reviews.  
To share info about the app with a friend: Tap Share, and then tap  
Email or Text Message. Sharing via text message is available only  
136 Chapter 12 : HP webOS App Catalog and Software Manager  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
You can move to other screens and work in other applications while your  
new app downloads in the background. For example, find another app in  
App Catalog and start its download while the first download is finishing.  
4
5
6
If the application uses Location Services, a notification appears (see  
Location Services). Tap Continue.  
If prompted, enter your HP webOS Account password to authorize  
the purchase. Tap Submit.  
TIP A good way to get started with App Catalog is to download the free  
Facebook Tablet app.  
If you have a billing account, if prompted, tap OK to verify the email  
address where you want to receive purchase receipts, or enter a  
different email address.  
7
8
If you do not have a billing account, you are prompted to set one up.  
Buy an application  
Do one of the following:  
Buy an application using your billing account or by entering  
a promo code  
To purchase the app using a promo code: Tap Use Promo Code.  
Tap Promo Code, enter the promo code, and then tap Use Promo  
Code.  
A promo code allows you to purchase one or more App Catalog apps for  
free. You might receive a promo code for a specific app, or a general  
code that allows you to purchase one or more apps up to a specific dollar  
amount.  
To purchase the app using your billing account: Tap Purchase.  
TIP To pause a download, tap the Downloading progress bar. To resume  
downloading, tap Download paused.  
You need to have a billing account set up in App Catalog to purchase  
apps with a promo code—however, your account is not charged when  
you use the code. If you do not have a promo code for an app, the  
purchase is billed to your billing account.  
9
After you download an app, tap Launch to open it. The app also  
now appears as an icon on the Downloads page in the Launcher, so  
you can open it from the Launcher as well.  
You can also purchase an app directly from a promo code link (see Buy  
TIP If you delete a purchased application you can reinstall it without paying for  
1
2
Open HP App Catalog  
.
You can move to other screens and work in other applications while your  
new app downloads in the background. For example, find another app in  
App Catalog and start its download while the first download is finishing.  
Browse to the app you want (see Browse applications in HP webOS  
3
Tap the price to the right of the app name.  
TIP You can also tap the app name to open the app details screen, and tap the  
price at the top of the screen.  
Chapter 12 : HP webOS App Catalog and Software Manager 137  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
8
After you download an app, tap Launch to open it. The app also  
now appears as an icon on the Downloads page in the Launcher, so  
you can open it from the Launcher as well.  
Buy an application directly from a promo code link  
A promo code allows you to purchase one or more App Catalog apps for  
free. You might receive a promo code for a specific app, or a general  
code that allows you to purchase one or more apps up to a specific dollar  
amount.  
TIP If you delete a purchased application you can reinstall it without paying for  
You need to have a billing account set up in App Catalog to purchase  
apps with a promo code—however, your account is not charged when  
you use the code.  
You can move to other screens and work in other applications while your  
new app downloads in the background. For example, find another app in  
App Catalog and start its download while the first download is finishing.  
1
2
If you receive a promo code link (such as in an email or text  
message), click the link.  
Reinstall a deleted application  
Do one of the following:  
If the main App Catalog page is displayed: Tap OK to dismiss the  
promo code notification. Browse to the app you want. Tap the app  
name.  
If a specific app page is displayed: Tap OK to dismiss the promo  
code notification.  
If you delete an app you installed on your device (see Manage  
applications with Software Manager), you can easily reinstall the app.  
You do not need to buy the app again—App Catalog recognizes that you  
bought it and now offers it as a free app.  
1
2
Open HP App Catalog  
.
3
4
Tap the price at the top of the app details screen.  
Catalog).  
If the application uses Location Services, a notification appears (see  
Location Services). Tap Continue.  
3
Tap Free to the right of the app name.  
5
6
7
If prompted, enter your HP webOS Account password to authorize  
the purchase. Tap Submit.  
If you do not have a billing account, you are prompted to set one up.  
Set up a billing account  
Do one of the following:  
1
2
Open HP App Catalog  
.
To purchase the app using the promo code: Tap Use Promo Code.  
To purchase the app using your billing account: Tap Purchase.  
Do one of the following:  
Find an app you want to buy, and tap the price to the right of the  
app name. Tap Setup Credit Card.  
TIP To pause a download, tap the Downloading progress bar. To resume  
downloading, tap Download paused.  
138 Chapter 12 : HP webOS App Catalog and Software Manager  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Open the application menu, tap Preferences & Accounts, and tap  
Add Credit Card.  
Update or delete a billing account  
3
4
Enter your HP webOS Account password and tap Submit.  
1
2
3
4
Open HP App Catalog  
.
Tap OK to verify your email address, or tap Change Email Address  
to enter a different one. Purchase receipts are sent to the address  
shown here.  
Open the application menu and tap Preferences & Accounts.  
To change credit card information: Tap the credit card name.  
5
Select your billing country and credit card type. Enter your credit  
card and billing address details, and tap Done.  
To change the password requirements or receipt email: Tap the  
current entry under Password Is Required or Send Receipts, and  
select a new password requirement or enter a new email address.  
IMPORTANT Your credit card details are not stored on your device. They are  
encrypted and stored in your HP webOS Account in the cloud.  
5
6
If prompted, enter your HP webOS Account password and tap  
Submit.  
Do one of the following:  
Set billing account preferences  
To edit the account information: Change the information as  
needed and tap Done.  
To delete the account information: Tap Remove Credit Card. Tap  
Remove Credit Card again to confirm.  
1
2
3
Open HP App Catalog  
.
Open the application menu and tap Preferences & Accounts.  
Under Password is Required, select one of the following:  
Manage applications with Software Manager  
Once Every 4 Hours: You must enter your password the first time you  
make a purchase. If you make any other purchases within four hours,  
you don’t need to enter your password again. After four hours, you  
enter your password again for the first purchase, which starts a new  
four-hour clock.  
Use Software Manager to work with applications and background  
services that you add to your device.  
Every Purchase: You must enter your password for each purchase,  
regardless of the time interval.  
4
Under Send Receipts, enter the email address where you want to  
receive receipts for App Catalog purchases. This option appears  
only if you have a billing account set up.  
Chapter 12 : HP webOS App Catalog and Software Manager 139  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
1
Open Software Manager  
.
Update a downloaded application from a  
notification  
When an update is available for one or more apps you downloaded, you  
get a notification.  
Tap the notification and do one of the following:  
2
Tap Apps to manage downloaded apps that appear in the  
Launcher, or tap Other to manage background apps and services  
that do not appear in the Launcher.  
To display details about an app and the available update: Tap the app  
name.  
To update one app: Tap the arrow icon to the right of the app name.  
To update all apps: Tap Install Updates.  
3
4
Tap an app or service name.  
On the app details screen, do any of the following:  
Manually check for application updates  
To add a review: Tap Review App. Tap the stars to rate the app.  
Tap the name you want displayed with your review. Tap Tap Here  
to Type, enter your review, and then tap Send.  
To report a problem with the app: Tap Report a Problem. Under  
Problem Type, tap Bug and tap the type of problem you are  
reporting. Tap Tap Here to Type, enter the problem description,  
and then tap Send.  
1
2
Open Software Manager  
.
Tap Apps to manage downloaded apps that appear in the  
Launcher, or tap Other to manage background apps and services  
that do not appear in the Launcher.  
To delete the app: Tap Delete. Tap Delete again to confirm.  
3
If updates are available for any of your downloaded apps or  
services, an [X] Updates Available button appears at the bottom of  
the screen with a number. The number indicates the number of items  
for which updates are available. Tap [X] Updates Available.  
TIP You can also delete an app by throwing it off the side of the screen from the  
app list, and then tapping Delete to confirm.  
TIP You can reinstall any app you delete (see Reinstall a deleted application).  
140 Chapter 12 : HP webOS App Catalog and Software Manager  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
4
Do one of the following:  
To display details about an app and the available update: Tap the  
app name.  
To update one app: Tap the update version number to the right of  
the app name.  
To update all apps: Tap Install All.  
To return to the list of apps: Tap My Apps.  
Chapter 12 : HP webOS App Catalog and Software Manager 141  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
142 Chapter 12 : HP webOS App Catalog and Software Manager  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
13 Preferences  
NOTE You cannot access the info in your HP webOS Account anywhere but on  
your device. View, add to, and edit the info in your HP webOS Account on your  
device.  
Automatic, daily backup to a secure server: Info stored in your HP webOS  
Account is automatically, daily backed up to a secure server.  
Your device backs up the contacts, calendar events, and memos that are  
in your HP webOS Account, as well as system settings and applications  
you downloaded to your device. If you ever need to erase the info from  
your device, you can restore all your backed-up info. All data backed up  
to your HP webOS Account is encrypted, and only you, the profile owner,  
can access your data.  
Backup  
Backup is one of the major advantages of your HP webOS Account. You  
create an HP webOS Account when you set up your device.  
Backup does not affect information stored in online accounts like Google.  
Information stored in online accounts is synchronized by the online  
provider at regular intervals. Information stored in Exchange is  
synchronized by your company’s Exchange server.  
What is an HP webOS Account?  
When you create an HP webOS Account during setup of your device, you  
gain access to the many advantages of having an HP webOS Account,  
including automatic, daily backup of your data.  
IMPORTANT Backup does not back up files stored on your device’s USB drive.  
You can turn off automatic backup, and you can also perform a manual  
backup.  
Your HP webOS Account gives you the following benefits:  
HP webOS Account on your device: Your HP webOS Account is  
automatically created for you on your device. In this account you can  
store Contacts and Calendar info that you don’t store in online accounts  
like Google or Exchange.  
Remote erase of a lost or stolen device: If your device is lost or stolen,  
open the web browser on your computer, sign in to your HP webOS  
Account on hpwebos.com/account, and do a remote erase of the info on  
the device.  
Chapter 13 : Preferences 143  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Table 1. Backup details  
Application Backed up  
NOTE If you want to erase data on your device while you are still in possession  
of the device—for example, before you give it to someone else—don’t do a  
remote erase. Instead, do a partial or full erase of the device itself (see Erase  
Not backed up  
Adobe  
Reader  
Nothing is backed up.  
Keep a copy of these files  
on your computer (see  
Access to system updates: Automatic system and software updates are  
sent to your device.  
Updating of HP webOS Account settings: To change your HP webOS  
Account information after you set it up, see Update your HP webOS  
Account settings. To see the email address you used when you set up your  
HP webOS Account, open Device Info (see View system information).  
Amazon  
Kindle  
If you downloaded the  
Amazon Kindle app from  
HP webOS App Catalog,  
when you sign in to your  
HP webOS Account after  
your device is erased, the  
app is downloaded again.  
What information is backed up?  
App  
See entry for HP App  
Catalog.  
All data backed up to your HP webOS Account is encrypted, and only  
you, the profile owner, can access your data. Data in your HP webOS  
Account can be viewed, added to, or edited only on your device.  
Catalog  
Backup  
Backup setting is on by  
default.  
Bluetooth  
Calendar  
Nothing is backed up.  
IMPORTANT In the event that your device is lost or stolen, you can go to your  
HP webOS Account on hpwebos.com/account and from there erase the data  
on your device.  
Events in your HP webOS  
Account.  
Events in online accounts.  
Passwords for online  
accounts that sync, like  
Google.  
Usernames for online  
accounts that sync, like  
Google.  
The following table lists info that is and is not backed up to your HP  
webOS Account:  
Preferences (see Customize  
Table 1. Backup details  
Contacts  
Contacts in your HP  
webOS Account.  
Contacts in online  
accounts.  
Application Backed up  
Accounts Usernames for online  
Not backed up  
Entries (contacts, events,  
messages, and so on) in  
online accounts  
accounts that sync, like  
Google.  
Usernames for online  
accounts that sync, like  
Google.  
Passwords for online  
accounts that sync, like  
Google.  
Passwords for online  
accounts that sync, like  
Google.  
Favorites.  
Linking relationships  
between contacts.  
Preferences (see Customize  
144 Chapter 13 : Preferences  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Table 1. Backup details  
Table 1. Backup details  
Application Backed up  
Application Backed up  
Not backed up  
Not backed up  
Date & Time Nothing is backed up.  
Messaging  
Instant messages.  
Passwords and history.  
Device Info  
Email  
Nothing is backed up.  
Usernames for IM  
accounts.  
Usernames for your email  
accounts.  
Passwords for your email  
accounts.  
Text messages sent or  
received when your device  
was connected to a  
webOS smartphone (see  
Emails, their contents, and  
attachments, their sort  
order, and account  
preferences.  
Excel  
See entry for Quickoffice.  
Nothing is backed up.  
Nothing is backed up.  
Nothing is backed up.  
Music  
Nothing is backed up.  
Keep a copy of these files  
on your computer (see  
Exhibition  
Facebook  
Help  
HP App  
Catalog  
When you sign in to your  
HP webOS Account after  
your device is erased, apps  
you downloaded from App  
Catalog are downloaded  
again.  
App settings and data  
stored in the app.  
Phone &  
Call history entries for any  
Video Calls calls made, received, or  
missed when your device  
was connected to a  
Applications from sources  
other than App Catalog.  
webOS smartphone (see  
Just Type  
Launcher  
Nothing is backed up.  
Reordered Launcher icons  
icons).  
Photos &  
Videos  
Usernames for online  
accounts that sync, like  
Facebook and Snapfish.  
No photos or videos are  
backed up. On your  
computer, keep a copy of  
the photos and videos that  
are on your device (see  
Location  
Services  
Preferences.  
Maps  
Nothing is backed up.  
Memos  
All memos.  
Passwords for online  
accounts that sync, like  
Facebook and Snapfish.  
PowerPoint  
See entry for Quickoffice.  
Chapter 13 : Preferences 145  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table 1. Backup details  
Application Backed up  
Table 1. Backup details  
Application Backed up  
Not backed up  
Not backed up  
Print  
Nothing is backed up.  
Word  
See entry for Quickoffice.  
Nothing is backed up.  
Manager  
YouTube  
Quickoffice  
Usernames and passwords No documents,  
for your Quickoffice  
accounts.  
spreadsheets, or  
presentations are backed  
up. Keep a copy of these  
files on your computer (see  
Manually back up information to your HP webOS Account  
Backup occurs automatically every day, but we recommend that you  
manually back up your information before you reset your device or  
change your HP webOS Account settings.  
Regional  
Settings  
Nothing is backed up.  
Nothing is backed up.  
1
Open Backup  
.
Screen &  
Lock  
Software  
Manager  
When you sign in to your  
HP webOS Account after  
your device is erased, apps  
you downloaded from App  
Catalog are downloaded  
again.  
App settings and data  
stored in the app.  
Applications from sources  
other than App Catalog.  
Sounds &  
Ringtones  
Nothing is backed up.  
Nothing is backed up.  
Nothing is backed up.  
System  
Updates  
Text Assist  
Third-party  
apps  
Apps you downloaded are  
downloaded again from  
App Catalog.  
VPN  
Nothing is backed up.  
Nothing is backed up.  
Bookmarks.  
Wallpaper  
Web  
Downloads and web  
settings.  
Browser cookies.  
Wi-Fi  
Nothing is backed up.  
2
Tap Back Up Now.  
146 Chapter 13 : Preferences  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Erase HP webOS Account information from the server  
Update your HP webOS Account settings  
1
2
Open Backup  
.
IMPORTANT To ensure that the data on your device is consistent with that  
stored on your HP webOS Account, we recommend that you perform a manual  
backup of your data both before and after you change any of your HP webOS  
Account).  
Do either of the following:  
To stop backup of your info and delete all backed-up information  
from the server: Tap On to switch backup from On to Off. Tap Turn  
Off And Erase Backup. This deletes all your information on the  
server. It does not affect the information on your device.  
1
2
3
4
Open Accounts  
.
Tap your HP webOS Account name.  
Enter your HP webOS Account password and tap Sign In.  
Edit any of the following:  
TIP Open Device Info to delete the information on your device (see Erase data  
To turn on automatic backup if you had previously turned it off:  
Tap Off to switch Backup from Off to On.  
Name: Tap the current name. Enter a new first name and/or last  
name associated with your HP webOS Account.  
Remotely erase HP webOS Account information from your  
device  
Email: Tap the current email address. Enter a new email address  
associated with your HP webOS Account. A verification email is sent  
to the new address. Click the link in the email to verify the new  
address. After you verify, the email address is changed.  
In the event that your device is lost or stolen, go to your HP webOS  
Account on your computer and from there, erase the data on your device.  
This does not affect the information stored in your online HP webOS  
Account.  
Password: Tap the current password (displayed as a series of *  
characters). Enter your new password and confirm it. Tap Done.  
1
2
On your computer, go to hpwebos.com/account.  
Security Question/Answer: Tap the current question and tap a new  
one. Then tap Answer and enter an answer.  
Sign in using your HP webOS Account email address and  
password.  
5
To view information about a device associated with this account,  
under Devices, tap the device. When you are finished viewing the  
information, tap Done.  
3
4
Click Device Info.  
Click I Lost My Phone > Erase Device.  
Chapter 13 : Preferences 147  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
3
4
To view application information, under Software, tap and hold an  
app name, then release. Tap Done when you are finished viewing  
the information.  
Date & Time  
You can set your device to adjust the date and time automatically to the  
local date and time wherever you are, or you can turn this feature off and  
enter this information manually.  
To return to the summary view, tap Back.  
Rename your device  
1
2
Open Date & Time  
.
The name you give your device appears on any paired Bluetooth® device  
that has a display, such as a connected webOS smartphone. If you  
rename your HP TouchPad, the name is updated automatically on the  
other device—you don’t need to pair again.  
Set any of the following:  
Time format: Tap the field at the top of the screen and set whether to  
use a 12-hour or a 24-hour format.  
1
2
Open Device Info  
.
Network Time: Network time is set by your Wi-Fi network provider.  
Tap On or Off. If you turn this option off, select the date and time. If  
you switch from manual time to network time, there might be a delay  
before the network time updates on your device.  
Under Name, tap the currently displayed name and enter the new  
name.  
Timezone: To change the time zone, tap the currently displayed city.  
Tap the search field and begin typing the name a country or city in  
the time zone you want, or scroll the list to find the location. Tap the  
location when it appears.  
Restart your device  
If an application freezes, first try restarting your device.  
An occasional restart can be good for your device just the way a restart  
can be good for your computer. Every once in a while, restart your  
device.  
Device Info  
1
2
Open Device Info  
.
View system information  
Tap Reset Options and tap Restart.  
1
2
Open Device Info  
. Basic system information is displayed, such as  
your battery usage and available memory. The screen also displays  
the email address you used when you set up your HP webOS  
Account.  
NOTE If the screen does not respond to taps, press and hold the power button  
and Center at the same time for 15 seconds to restart your device.  
To view more detailed system information, tap More Info, and tap  
Software or Hardware.  
148 Chapter 13 : Preferences  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Erase data and reset your device  
About the full erase options  
If restarting your device does not solve the problem of application freezes,  
you may need to reset the device. A reset deletes some or all information  
from your device (depending on the type of reset you select). After a reset,  
you must follow the prompts to sign in to your HP webOS Account again  
before you can use your device.  
In most cases, you can perform a regular full erase if you want to erase  
downloaded applications and USB drive storage files from your device.  
Perform a secure full erase when you give your device to somebody else  
and you don’t want that person to be able to access your data.  
Regardless of which full erase option you choose, all your data on the  
web—in your online accounts and in your HP webOS Account—is  
untouched.  
IMPORTANT If possible, do a manual backup of your HP webOS Account data  
before resetting your device (see Manually back up information to your HP  
webOS Account). After you sign in to your HP webOS Account again, any  
backed-up information is restored (see What information is backed up?).  
After either type of full erase, you can sign in to your HP webOS Account  
either on a new webOS device or the same device you just erased.  
Signing in restores your HP webOS Account data and information from  
online accounts (see What information is backed up?), but not your stored  
files such as pictures, videos, and music (you must copy those again to the  
1
2
3
Open Device Info  
Tap Reset Options.  
.
Tap one of the following:  
Run Automated Diagnostics  
Erase Apps & Data: Erases all application data and settings, as well  
as any applications you installed from App Catalog.  
If you are troubleshooting your device with a support agent, you can run  
Automated Diagnostics to supply the agent with diagnostic information  
about your device. If you need more information after running Automated  
Diagnostics, you can run Interactive Diagnostics (see Run Interactive  
Erase USB Drive: Erases all files stored in USB drive storage, such as  
pictures, videos, and music.  
Full Erase: Erases application data and settings, apps you installed,  
and USB drive storage files. Use Full Erase if you want a clean erase  
of your currently installed apps and files but plan to continue using  
the device.  
1
2
3
4
Open Device Info  
.
Open the application menu and tap Diagnostics.  
On the screen that appears, tap Automated.  
Secure Full Erase: Erases application data and settings, apps you  
installed, and USB drive storage files. Use Secure Full Erase if you  
plan to give the device away and you do not want your data and  
files to be recoverable even using a third-party tool. Secure Full Erase  
performs a complete wipe of the device and takes considerably  
longer than a regular full erase.  
Work with the support agent to view and report the test results.  
Run Interactive Diagnostics  
4
Tap the button again to confirm your choice.  
If you are troubleshooting your device with a support agent and need  
more information after running Automated Diagnostics (see Run  
Automated Diagnostics), you can run Interactive Diagnostics.  
Chapter 13 : Preferences 149  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
1
2
3
4
Open Device Info  
.
4
Do either or both of the following:  
Open the application menu and tap Diagnostics.  
On the screen that appears, tap Interactive.  
To change the default application to use for different functions:  
Under Data Types, tap the currently displayed application for a  
given data type, and tap a different application.  
To change the default application to use for different file types:  
Under File Types, tap the currently displayed application for a  
given file type, and tap a different application.  
Work with the support agent to run and view results from one or  
more tests.  
To override the default application setting when looking for the map  
location of an address, tap and hold the address, and then tap the  
application you want.  
Run a custom application  
If you are troubleshooting your device with a support agent, the agent  
may need to run a custom application on your device.  
Use Certificate Manager  
1
2
3
Open Device Info  
.
Certificates are digital documents that are used to authenticate and  
exchange information on networks. Certificates can be issued for a user,  
a device, or a service.  
Open the application menu and tap Custom Application.  
Work with the support agent to enter the custom application name  
and run the application.  
Install a certificate from USB drive storage  
Change default applications  
You can install a certificate that is located in the USB drive storage on  
your device. For information on copying a certificate into USB drive  
If you have more than one application on your device that can perform a  
particular function, you can change the default application to use for that  
function.  
1
2
3
Open Device Info  
Open the application menu and tap Certificate Manager.  
Tap and tap the certificate name.  
.
In addition, if you have more than one application on your device that  
can open a particular file type, you can change the default application to  
use for opening that file type.  
1
2
3
Open Device Info  
.
Install a certificate from an email attachment  
Open the application menu and tap Default Applications.  
Open the email attachment (see Open email attachments), and then  
tap Trust Certificate.  
To find data types and file types for which more than one app is  
available, look for app names that appear in black type.  
150 Chapter 13 : Preferences  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
View certificate details  
Start Exhibition  
You can view user-installed certificates only.  
Do one of the following:  
1
2
3
Open Device Info  
.
When the screen is off, place your device on a Touchstone. Exhibition  
starts automatically.  
If you place your device on a Touchstone while the screen is on,  
Exhibition starts when the device has been inactive for the period  
automatically). The screen does not lock.  
Open the application menu and tap Certificate Manager.  
Tap the certificate name.  
Open Exhibition  
and tap Start Exhibition. This starts Exhibition  
whether or not your device is on a Touchstone.  
Delete a certificate  
You can delete user-installed certificates only.  
NOTE If you place your device on a Touchstone when you are on a call or  
watching a video in the Pictures & Videos or YouTube app, Exhibition does not  
start.  
1
2
3
Open Device Info  
.
Open the application menu and tap Certificate Manager.  
Tap the certificate and tap Delete Certificate.  
Exit Exhibition  
Do any of the following:  
Exhibition  
Press Center  
.
If your device is on a Touchstone, remove the device from the  
Touchstone.  
Exhibition gives you access to applications specially designed for use with  
your device when it is placed on an HP Touchstone (sold separately).  
These apps include Time (clock app), Photos & Videos (photo slideshow),  
and Agenda (agenda based on your Calendar events for the day).  
When you exit Exhibition, the last used item on the device is displayed:  
the Launcher, Card view, or an app window.  
NOTE You cannot use a Touchstone by connecting the USB cable to a  
computer.  
Chapter 13 : Preferences 151  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
does not have a checkmark next to its name to include it in the  
slideshow. Tap an album that has a checkmark next to its name to  
remove it from the slideshow. Tap Done.  
Use Exhibition  
Here are some key features of using Exhibition.  
To pause playback: Tap  
To resume playback: Tap  
.
.
When Exhibition starts, the last-used app is displayed. To switch to  
another app, tap the upper-left corner of the screen, and tap the app  
you want.  
When Exhibition starts, notifications appear as usual, and tapping a  
notification performs the same action as usual.  
To change the timing of the slideshow: Tap  
and tap a time  
interval. This interval sets how long a picture is displayed before it  
transitions to the next picture.  
4
5
To manually move to the next or previous picture during a slideshow:  
Swipe left or right on the screen.  
If your device is on a Touchstone but Exhibition is turned off, Exhibition  
starts automatically when the device has been inactive for the period  
automatically). The screen does not lock.  
To exit the slideshow: Press Center  
.
If you have Secure Unlock turned on, you must enter your PIN or  
password to use the device when you exit Exhibition.  
View your day’s agenda  
Agenda view displays any of the current day’s calendar events in list  
format.  
Use your device as a clock  
The Exhibition Time app provides a convenient way to use your device as  
a clock while the device is sitting on a Touchstone.  
In Exhibition, tap the upper-left corner of the screen, and tap Agenda.  
In Exhibition, tap the upper-left corner of the screen, and tap Time.  
View a picture slideshow  
When your device is in Exhibition, you can set it to play a continuous  
slideshow of pictures from any album in the Photos & Videos app.  
1
In Exhibition, tap the upper-left corner of the screen, and tap Photos.  
Playback of the currently selected album starts automatically. The  
default is to display photos from all albums.  
NOTE If Agenda is not displayed in the options in the upper-left corner of the  
screen, you need to turn it on (see Customize Exhibition settings).  
2
3
To display playback controls, tap the screen.  
Customize Exhibition settings  
When the playback controls are displayed, do any of the following:  
1
Open Exhibition  
To choose which album(s) to use for the slideshow: Tap Select  
Album in the upper-right corner of the screen. Tap an album that  
152 Chapter 13 : Preferences  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2
Do either of the following:  
2
Under Keyboard Type, do one of the following:  
To change which apps are available in Exhibition: Check or  
uncheck the box to the right of each app name. You cannot  
remove the Time app.  
To change the layout or language of the keyboard you are  
currently using: Tap the keyboard.  
To add a keyboard: Tap Add Keyboard.  
To find more Exhibition apps: Tap Find More. This opens App  
Catalog displaying a list of apps you can use in Exhibition. Tap an  
app to download it (see Download a free application and Buy an  
application). You can install as many Exhibition apps as you want.  
3
4
5
To select a layout, tap the layout currently displayed, and then tap a  
new layout.  
To select a language, tap the language currently displayed, and  
then tap a new language.  
Regional Settings  
Tap Done.  
Select a default country code for phone numbers  
Change the display language  
You can set the country code to be used with any phone numbers that do  
not include a country code, including phone numbers contained in a  
contact entry.  
You can set your device display to any language available for the device.  
1
2
Open Regional Settings  
.
1
2
Open Regional Settings  
.
Tap the language currently displayed in the Language field, and  
then tap a new language.  
Under Phone Numbers, tap the currently displayed country or  
region.  
3
4
If a region list is displayed, tap the region.  
3
4
Scroll down to find a country, and then tap it.  
Tap Apply Changes and Reboot.  
Tap Apply Changes and Reboot.  
Your device restarts after you select a new language. The restart does not  
affect your data or applications.  
Your device restarts after you select a new default region for phone  
numbers. The restart does not affect your data or applications.  
Set up and switch among multiple onscreen keyboard layouts  
and languages  
Change the display formats  
For information on using the onscreen keyboard, see Use the onscreen  
You can set your device to format numbers, currency, date, and time in the  
style you prefer. You can select the format commonly used in your country  
or region, or any style you want.  
1
Open Regional Settings  
.
1
Open Regional Settings  
.
Chapter 13 : Preferences 153  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
2
3
4
Under Formats, tap the currently displayed country name.  
Scroll down to find a country, and then tap it.  
Tap Apply Changes and Reboot.  
1
2
Open Screen & Lock  
.
In Turn off After, tap the interval shown, and then tap the number of  
minutes.  
Your device restarts after you select a new country format. The restart does  
not affect your data or applications.  
Change your wallpaper  
Your wallpaper is the screen background in Card view. You can customize  
the wallpaper to show a favorite picture.  
Screen & Lock  
1
2
3
4
Open Screen & Lock  
.
Tap Change Wallpaper.  
Turn auto dim on/off  
Tap the album containing the picture, and tap the picture.  
By default, your screen dims after a period of inactivity. You can turn this  
feature off.  
(Optional) In the preview window, do either or both of the following:  
To zoom out or in on a part of the picture: Pinch in or out on the  
picture, or double-tap the picture.  
To capture the portion of the picture you want for your wallpaper:  
Tap and hold the picture, and then drag the portion you want to  
the fill the window. This portion becomes the wallpaper.  
1
2
Open Screen & Lock  
.
In Auto Dim, tap On to change the setting from On to Off, or tap Off  
to change the setting from Off to On.  
5
Tap OK.  
Adjust the screen brightness  
1
2
Open Screen & Lock  
.
Turn advanced gestures on/off  
Drag the Brightness slider left or right.  
Turning on advanced gestures enables the up gesture.  
TIP You can also adjust the screen brightness in the system menu (see Use the  
The up gesture is a drag up from the bottom edge of the screen. When an  
app is open full-screen, make the up gesture to go to Card view. When  
Card view is displayed, make the up gesture to open the Launcher. When  
the Launcher is open, make the up gesture to go to Card view.  
Set the interval for turning the screen off automatically  
1
2
Open Screen & Lock  
.
By default, your screen turns off after two minutes of inactivity to save  
battery power. You can change this interval.  
In Enable Gestures, tap On or Off.  
154 Chapter 13 : Preferences  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
3
4
Enter the old PIN/password and the new PIN/password.  
Set options for unlocking the screen  
Tap Done.  
The screen locks five seconds after it turns off automatically, or  
immediately if you turn the screen off manually. Use Secure Unlock if you  
want to require a PIN or a password to unlock the screen.  
Get notifications when the screen is locked  
TIP If your company issued your device to you, check with your system  
administrator about whether the company has its own settings for locking and  
unlocking the screen of your device.  
1
2
Open Screen & Lock  
.
In Show When Locked, tap On or Off to set whether notifications are  
displayed when the screen is locked.  
1
2
Open Screen & Lock  
.
To turn Secure Unlock on: In Secure Unlock, tap Off. Tap Simple PIN  
or Password, and do one of the following:  
Turn blink notifications on/off  
If blink notifications are turned on, when the screen is off, the Center  
button blinks when a notification arrives and continues to blink until you  
tap the notification or turn on the screen. Blink notifications are on by  
default.  
Simple PIN: Enter a PIN of any length. This is a PIN that you make  
up. Enter the PIN again to confirm, and then tap Done.  
Password: Enter a password containing any combination of letters  
and numbers, and then tap Done. Enter the password again to  
confirm, and then tap Done.  
1
2
Open Screen & Lock  
.
In Blink Notifications, tap On or Off.  
IMPORTANT Be sure to write down your PIN or password and keep it  
somewhere safe. If you forget your PIN or password, you need to remotely reset  
your device and may lose data.  
Sounds & Ringtones  
3
4
Tap Lock After to choose whether the screen locks after a designated  
time, or after the screen turns off.  
Set sound options  
To turn Secure Unlock off: In Secure Unlock, tap the currently  
displayed option (Simple PIN or Password), and then tap Off. Enter  
the PIN or password, and then tap Done.  
You can turn all sounds on or off. You can also turn a particular group of  
sounds, including keyboard clicks, notification alerts, and system sounds  
such as transition sounds, on or off. When sounds are on, you can set the  
sound volume.  
Change your Secure Unlock password  
Sounds are turned on by default.  
1
2
Open Screen & Lock  
.
In Secure Unlock, tap Change PIN or Change Password.  
Chapter 13 : Preferences 155  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
1
Open Sounds & Ringtones  
.
NOTE If you turn off system sounds using the system menu, the sounds are  
muted even if they are turned on in Sounds & Ringtones (see Use the system  
menu). Likewise, if sounds are turned off in Sounds & Ringtones, they do not  
play even if you have the system menu sound setting turned on.  
1
Open Sounds & Ringtones  
.
2
In Vibrate, tap On or Off to turn the vibrate setting off or on.  
Turn Beats Audio on/off  
Beats Audio lets you hear the music the way the artist intended you to  
hear it. The dynamic Beats Audio profile delivers a clear, distortion-free  
music listening experience with incredible highs and rich, warm lows.  
2
Do one of the following:  
Beats Audio is turned on by default.  
To turn off all sounds: In Sounds, tap On to switch all sounds from  
On to Off.  
1
Open Sounds & Ringtones  
.
To turn off a specific group of sounds: In System Sounds or  
Keyboard Clicks, tap On to switch from On to Off.  
NOTE Calendar, Email, and Messaging notification sounds are controlled  
separately. If you have notification sounds turned on in any of those apps (see  
Customize messaging notifications), the sound plays even if you have System  
Sounds turned off.  
2
In Beats, tap On or Off to turns Beats Audio off or on.  
3
If sounds are on, drag the Volume slider to set the sound volume.  
Add ringtones to your device  
Set your device to vibrate  
If you pair your HP TouchPad with an HP webOS smartphone, you can  
answer calls made to your smartphone directly from your HP TouchPad  
details). You can select a ringtone to ring on your HP TouchPad when a  
call comes in.  
You can set your device to vibrate whenever a sound would normally  
play. The vibrate option can be turned on even when sounds are off.  
156 Chapter 13 : Preferences  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
You can add a file in any of the following file types as a ringtone for your  
device: MP3, AAC, AAC+, AMR, QCELP, or WAV. How to use the file as  
a ringtone depends on the following: the file type, how you obtain the  
file, and whether you want to use the file as a ringtone only, or play it in  
the Music app.  
Select a file from the ringtones folder as a ringtone  
If you pair your HP TouchPad with an HP webOS smartphone, you can  
answer calls made to your smartphone directly from your HP TouchPad  
details). You can select a ringtone to ring on your HP TouchPad when a  
call comes in.  
You can obtain files to use as ringtones in any of the following ways:  
Download a ringtone from one of the many ringtone apps in HP  
Manager).  
1
2
Open Sounds & Ringtones  
.
In Ringtone, tap the displayed ringtone to open the list of tones. This  
list displays all files stored in the ringtones folder in your device’s  
USB drive storage.  
Copy a file from your computer (see Copy a ringtone to your device).  
To use an AMR or QCELP file as a ringtone, the file must be stored in the  
ringtones folder in your device’s USB drive storage. Here’s how to get the  
file into the correct folder:  
3
4
5
(Optional) Tap  
to listen to the ringtone.  
Tap the name of the ringtone to select it.  
Files downloaded from App Catalog: The file is placed in the ringtones  
folder automatically.  
To set the ringtone volume, drag the Ringtone Volume slider.  
Files copied from your computer: You must place the file in the ringtones  
TIP Adjusting the Ringtone Volume slider is the same as using the volume button  
on the side of the device.  
To use a file in the ringtones folder as a ringtone, see Select a file from the  
For MP3, AAC, AAC+, and WAV files, you have two options:  
Select a song as a ringtone  
To use the file as a ringtone only: Place the file in the ringtones folder  
(see Copy a ringtone to your device). If the file is already on your  
device, connect your device to your computer as described in that  
procedure, navigate to the file, and move the file to the ringtones folder.  
If you download a file from a ringtone app in App Catalog, it is  
automatically placed in the ringtones folder. To use a file in the  
ringtones folder as a ringtone, see Select a file from the ringtones folder  
To both use the file as a ringtone and listen to the file in the Music app:  
Copy the file to your device and place the file in any folder in your  
device’s USB drive storage except ringtones (see Copy files and folders  
using USB Drive mode). To use the file as a ringtone, follow the steps in  
If you pair your HP TouchPad with an HP webOS smartphone, you can  
answer calls made to your smartphone directly from your HP TouchPad  
details). You can select a ringtone to ring on your HP TouchPad when a  
call comes in.  
If you have a song you listen to in the Music app, you can use that song  
as the ringtone for your device.  
1
2
3
Open Sounds & Ringtones  
.
Tap the displayed ringtone.  
Tap  
.
Chapter 13 : Preferences 157  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
4
5
6
Tap  
to the right of a song title to preview it. Tap the song title to  
add it to your list of ringtones.  
When the list of ringtones is displayed, tap the song you added to  
use it as your ringtone.  
To set the ringtone volume, drag the Ringtone Volume slider.  
Copy a ringtone to your device  
1
2
3
Identify a file on your computer to use as a ringtone on your device.  
Connect your device to your computer using the USB cable.  
On your device, tap USB Drive. On your computer, your device  
appears as a removable drive.  
4
Open My Computer (Windows XP), Computer (Windows Vista/  
Windows 7), or the Finder (Mac), double-click the drive representing  
your device, and drag and drop files to the ringtones folder on your  
device.  
5
End the connection safely. If you do not eject safely, your device  
resets when you disconnect the USB cable:  
On a Windows computer, right-click the drive representing your  
device and click Eject.  
On a Mac computer, from your desktop, drag the drive  
representing your device to the Trash. Trash changes to Eject.  
6
Disconnect the USB cable from the computer when the USB Drive  
screen is no longer displayed on your device.  
The new file appears in the list of ringtones on your device.  
158 Chapter 13 : Preferences  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
14 Wireless connections  
Are there different kinds of Wi-Fi networks?  
There are two types of Wi-Fi networks.  
Open networks: These networks broadcast their name (SSID) and do not  
require you to enter a password or other settings. To learn how to connect  
to an open network for the first time, see Connect to a new open network.  
Secure networks: These networks may broadcast their name, but at the  
very least, they require you to enter a password that you get from an  
administrator (who may be, for example, the librarian or the person  
behind the counter at the coffee shop). You may also have to get other  
network settings from the system administrator. To learn how to connect to  
a secure network for the first time, see Connect to a new secure network.  
Wi-Fi  
What is a Wi-Fi connection?  
Many environments, such as corporate offices, coffee shops, airports, and  
libraries, offer access to a Wi-Fi network, which is a wireless local area  
network (WLAN). To access this WLAN, you connect your device to the  
WLAN through a Wi-Fi access point (also called a hotspot). When you’re  
within range of an accessible Wi-Fi network, you can use your device’s  
Wi-Fi feature to connect to that network and access the web.  
To connect to either type of network after the first time, see Connect to a  
Turn Wi-Fi on/off  
Wi-Fi is turned on by default. Do one of the following to turn it off or on:  
Your device supports Wi-Fi connectivity based on the 802.11 standard  
(802.11a, 802.11b, 802.11g, and 802.11n), with WPA, WPA2, WEP, and  
802.1x authentication.  
Open Wi-Fi  
, and tap On or Off.  
Chapter 14 : Wireless connections 159  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
From any screen: Open the system menu in the upper-right corner of the  
screen, tap Wi-Fi, and tap Turn on Wi-Fi or Turn off Wi-Fi.  
If the network you want is not displayed, tap Join network and  
enter the network name. Make sure Open is displayed in the  
Security field, and then tap Connect.  
TIP You can also open Wi-Fi by opening the system menu, tapping Wi-Fi, and  
tapping Wi-Fi Preferences.  
Connect to a new secure network  
For an explanation of secure networks, see Are there different kinds of  
1
2
3
Open Wi-Fi  
.
Make sure Wi-Fi is on (see Turn Wi-Fi on/off).  
Do one of the following:  
If the network you want is displayed, tap the network name, enter  
your Username and/or Password, and tap Sign In. You’re done.  
*
Tap the icons in this corner, or drag your finger down across the icons.  
If the network you want is not displayed, tap Join network and  
enter the network name. Follow steps 4 to 7.  
If your device finds the network you want, tap the network name to  
connect to it. Otherwise, see Connect to a new open network and  
Connect to a new open network  
For an explanation of open networks, see Are there different kinds of  
1
2
3
Open Wi-Fi  
.
4
5
Tap the Security field, and then tap the network type: Open,  
WPA-personal, WEP, or Enterprise.  
Make sure Wi-Fi is on (see Turn Wi-Fi on/off).  
Do one of the following:  
Tap Connect.  
If the network you want is displayed, tap the network name.  
160 Chapter 14 : Wireless connections  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
6
7
A series of different screens appears depending on the network  
type. Enter or select the following if you are prompted to do so:  
2
If required, review the security certificate notices and tap one of the  
following:  
Username and/or Password  
Certificate  
Trust Certificate: Connects you to the captive portal page  
automatically whenever you connect to this Wi-Fi access point.  
Trust Certificate Once: Connects you to the captive portal page for  
this session only. The next time you try to connect to this Wi-Fi access  
point, you will be asked to trust this certificate again.  
Tap Sign In.  
Connect to a previously used network  
Don’t Trust Certificate: Cancels the connection.  
If Wi-Fi is turned off, turn on Wi-Fi (see Turn Wi-Fi on/off). Your device  
automatically attempts to connect to a previously used network, starting  
with the most recently used network.  
3
Your Wi-Fi host may require you to view advertisements, pay a fee,  
or accept conditions of use. Follow the instructions onscreen.  
If you move to a new location and Wi-Fi is turned on, your device  
automatically attempts to connect to a previously used network if one is  
discovered at the new location. If more than one previously used  
network is discovered, the device starts with the most recently used  
network.  
Disconnect from a network  
If you are connected to one network and want to use a different one,  
When you disconnect from a network, you can keep it on your list of  
known networks so that your device can automatically connect to it again.  
If you remove the network from your list of known networks, however, you  
must reconnect to the network. Follow the steps in Connect to a new open  
network or Connect to a new secure network to connect to the network  
again.  
open Wi-Fi  
and open the application menu. Tap Stored Profiles and  
tap another network name.  
Connect to a captive portal  
When connecting to some Wi-Fi access points, such as in a coffee shop,  
a hotel, or an airport, the notification for a captive portal sometimes  
appears. This means that to connect to this Wi-Fi access point, you must  
first go to a special Internet page, known as a captive portal, before you  
can connect to the Internet. A captive portal might be used by your Wi-Fi  
host for authentication or for payment to access the Internet.  
To disconnect from a network but keep it on your list of known networks:  
Turn off Wi-Fi (see Turn Wi-Fi on/off). This disconnects you from the  
network.  
To disconnect from a network and remove it from your list of known  
networks: Open Wi-Fi  
Network.  
. Tap the network name, and then tap Forget  
To connect to a captive portal:  
Put Wi-Fi to sleep when the screen is off  
1
Tap  
at the top of the screen and then tap the notification Captive  
Portal Detected on WiFi.  
By default, your device keeps its Wi-Fi connection active even when the  
screen is dark. If, however, you find that a Wi-Fi connection is constantly,  
unnecessarily waking up your device, you can save battery power by  
Chapter 14 : Wireless connections 161  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
turning off this setting. When you turn the screen on again, the Wi-Fi  
connection is reactivated.  
5
Tap Done.  
1
2
3
Open Wi-Fi  
.
Print Manager  
Open the application menu and tap Sleep Settings.  
The current setting is displayed in the When Phone Sleeps field. To  
change the setting, tap the current setting and then select the other  
option from the displayed list.  
Add a printer  
BEFORE YOU BEGIN Your device supports printing on all network-capable  
HP printers that support PCL page description language in the local LAN.  
These printers include new HP ePrint-capable printers–Photosmart,  
Officejet, and LaserJet–as well as legacy printers approximately five years  
old or newer. Make sure your printer is turned on and that both your  
device and the printer are connected to your local or corporate wireless  
network. For personal printers, see the instructions that came with your  
printer for information about setting up a printer on a wireless network.  
Customize connection settings  
Do not change Wi-Fi settings unless you are having trouble with your  
network connection.  
BEFORE YOU BEGIN You must be connected to the network you want to  
Your device detects most HP printers that are connected to a wireless  
network automatically. Some HP wireless-enabled printers or  
wireless-enabled printers on a corporate network, however, may need to  
be added manually to your device.  
1
2
3
Open Wi-Fi  
.
Tap the network name.  
1
2
3
4
Open Print Manager  
.
In Automatic IP settings, tap On or Off.  
Tap Add or remove printer.  
When Automatic IP settings is on, the IP address is automatically  
and dynamically configured.  
When Automatic IP settings is off, you can manually configure the  
IP address.  
Tap Enter Printer IP Address and enter the printer’s IP address.  
(Optional) Tap Name Printer and enter a name for the printer. If you  
do not enter a name, the printer’s IP address is used as the default  
name.  
4
If you turned Automatic IP settings off, enter any of the following:  
Address: The IP address of the network  
5
Tap Add Printer.  
You can print emails (see Print an email), pictures (see Print pictures), web  
pages (see Print a web page), Word documents or PowerPoint  
and PDF files (see Print a PDF file).  
Subnet: The Subnet address of the network  
Gateway: The Gateway address of the network  
DNS Servers: Addresses (#1 and #2)  
162 Chapter 14 : Wireless connections  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Your company’s wireless LAN is inside the firewall, but you are  
accessing the network from outside the firewall (for example, from a  
public location or at home).  
Cancel printing  
1
2
Open Print Manager  
Do one of the following:  
.
Check with your company’s system administrator to see if a VPN is  
required for accessing the corporate network.  
To cancel a single print job: Tap the print job under Print Queue.  
To cancel all your print jobs: Tap Cancel All.  
TIP Being connected to VPN may sometimes interfere with web browsing. If you  
are having problems browsing in Web, disconnect VPN (see Disconnect from a  
profile) and then try using Web again.  
Remove a printer  
Your device does not need to be connected to a wireless network to  
remove a printer that you had set up to print on that network.  
Add a VPNC VPN profile  
VPNC is a Cisco-compatible IPSEC client.  
1
2
3
Open Print Manager  
.
BEFORE YOU BEGIN Get the following information from your system  
administrator:  
Tap Add or remove printer.  
Tap the network name listed under the Add Printer button and select  
the network that the printer you want to remove is associated with.  
Profile name  
VPN server  
Username and password  
Group ID  
4
Tap Remove beside the printer you want to remove, and then tap  
Yes.  
Group secret  
Domain  
Dead peer detection setting: When selected, if no VPN traffic is  
received for five minutes, the client checks to see if the VPN server is  
still available.  
VPN  
Encryption method: Secure, Weak, None: Secure forces the client to  
use more secure AES or 3DES algorithms. Weak allows the weaker  
1DES algorithm. Strong encryption may still be used, depending on  
what the VPN server decides. None enables no encryption. Encryption  
is not disabled and may still be used, depending on the VPN server.  
With the None option, the VPN profile is simply allowed to use no  
encryption.  
What is VPN?  
If you want to use your device to access files on your company’s servers,  
you may need to set up a VPN (virtual private network). You can do this  
using the VPN application. VPN enables you to log in to your corporate  
server through the company’s firewall (security layer). You need to set up  
a VPN to access a corporate server in any of the following situations:  
NAT traversal method: Cisco-UDP, NAT-T (always), NAT-T (auto-detect),  
or Disabled  
Your company’s wireless local area network (LAN) is outside the  
firewall.  
1
Open VPN  
.
Chapter 14 : Wireless connections 163  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
2
3
Tap Add Profile.  
8
9
If required, enter your security token or other password, and tap  
Done.  
If VPNC is not selected already in the Connection Type field, tap the  
Connection Type field, and tap VPNC.  
Tap Continue to acknowledge that you are accessing a private  
network.  
4
5
6
7
8
Tap the VPN Server field and enter the server name.  
Tap Next.  
Connect to a profile  
Enter the information you got from your system administrator.  
1
Do one of the following:  
Tap Connect.  
Open VPN  
, and tap a profile.  
From any screen, open the system menu, tap VPN, and tap a  
profile.  
If required, enter your security token or other password, and tap  
Done.  
2
Tap Continue to acknowledge that you are accessing a private  
network.  
9
Tap Continue to acknowledge that you are accessing a private  
network.  
View statistics for a connected profile  
Add a Cisco AnyConnect VPN profile  
1
2
Open VPN  
.
BEFORE YOU BEGIN Get the following information from your system  
administrator:  
Tap beside a connected profile.  
VPN server name  
Username and password  
Security token or other password  
Disconnect from a profile  
1
2
3
4
5
6
Open VPN  
.
Do one of the following:  
Tap Add Profile.  
Open VPN  
, and tap a connected profile.  
From any screen, open the system menu, tap VPN, and tap a connected  
profile.  
Tap the Connection Type field, and tap Cisco AnyConnect.  
Tap the VPN Server field and enter the server name.  
Tap Next.  
Edit a profile  
If required, tap Accept to accept the Cisco license agreement. Tap  
1
Do one of the following:  
Open VPN  
to view the full agreement.  
.
7
Enter your login information, and tap Connect.  
164 Chapter 14 : Wireless connections  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
From any screen, open the system menu and tap VPN, and then  
tap VPN Preferences.  
2
3
You can set Location Services to always ask your permission to send  
your location to a website when the site requests this information or  
you can set it to never share your location with any website. The  
current setting is displayed in the For Websites field. To change the  
setting, tap the current setting and then select another option from  
the displayed list.  
2
Tap  
beside the profile you want to edit, and tap  
to open  
Profile Details.  
Tap a setting to edit it.  
Tap Done.  
3
4
To clear all location data currently in use by websites, tap Clear My  
Location Data, and then tap Clear.  
Delete a profile  
Manage location information passed to applications  
1
2
Open VPN  
.
An application might request your current location so it can provide you  
with information that is relevant to where you are. For example, Maps  
might use your current location to provide driving directions to a  
destination.  
Do one of the following:  
Throw the profile off the side of the screen and tap Delete.  
Tap beside the profile you want to delete and tap Delete  
Profile.  
1
2
Open Location Services  
.
Select one of the following in the For Applications field:  
Always Ask: Applications display a request to identify your location.  
You choose whether to allow this for the current session only.  
Location Services  
Auto Locate: Applications can automatically identify your location.  
The Location Services application allows you to control the sending of  
information about your location to websites and applications that request  
it.  
3
(Optional) Tap On to switch Background Data Collection from On to  
Off. Background Data Collection is available only when Google  
Services is on (see Turn Google Services on/off). When Background  
Data Collection is on, anonymous location data is collected from  
your device. This data is used to improve the quality of location  
services.  
Manage location information passed to websites  
A website might request your current location so it can provide you with  
information that is relevant to where you are. For example, a weather site  
might require your location so it can let you know the weather forecast for  
your area.  
Turn Google Services on/off  
Google Services must be turned on for Location Services to be enabled.  
1
Open Location Services  
.
1
Open Location Services  
.
Chapter 14 : Wireless connections 165  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
2
Open the application menu, tap Locate Me Using, and tap Google  
Services.  
Make a pairing request to another device  
BEFORE YOU BEGIN The other device must be discoverable in order to  
appear on your tablet’s Devices list. Check the documentation that came  
with the other device for information on making it discoverable.  
Google Services uses Wi-Fi access points to approximate your  
location.  
The first time you turn on Google Services you may be asked to  
review and accept the terms of use, and decide whether to allow  
anonymous data collection. Do the following:  
You can make a pairing request to a Bluetooth audio device such as a  
headset, car kit, or A2DP (stereo Bluetooth) device, or to a webOS  
smartphone or Bluetooth-enabled keyboard.  
Review the terms of use.  
If you decide not to allow anonymous data collection, tap the  
checkmark to remove it.  
If you have a webOS smartphone that uses a different HP webOS  
Account than the one used on your device, you can use the following  
procedure to pair with it. When you have paired and connected with the  
smartphone (see Connect with a paired device), you can manage phone  
calls and, on compatible smartphones, text messages on your device. If  
you have an HP webOS smartphone that shares an HP webOS Account  
with your device, you can use Touch to Share to pair it with your device  
Tap Agree or Don’t Agree.  
Bluetooth® wireless technology  
1
Open Bluetooth  
.
What is Bluetooth® wireless technology?  
TIP You can also open the Bluetooth app by opening the system menu, tapping  
Bluetooth, and tapping Bluetooth Preferences.  
With the Bluetooth® wireless technology on your device, you can connect  
to a number of Bluetooth devices, including a hands-free device such as a  
2
Make sure Bluetooth is on (see Turn the Bluetooth feature on/off).  
Before you can connect to another Bluetooth device, you need to pair with  
that device. You can make the pairing request from your device (see Make  
a pairing request to another device) or use Touch to share to pair with a  
webOS smartphone (see What is Touch to Share?).  
3
4
Tap Add device.  
Tap the Type field, and tap Audio, webOS Phone, Keyboard, or  
Other to filter the list of discoverable Bluetooth devices.  
Turn the Bluetooth feature on/off  
5
Tap a device name.  
Do one of the following:  
Open Bluetooth  
, and tap On or Off.  
From any screen: Open the system menu, tap Bluetooth, and tap Turn  
on Bluetooth or Turn off Bluetooth.  
166 Chapter 14 : Wireless connections  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
6
If a passkey is not required, pairing is complete when the Devices list  
appears. If required, tap Allow on the other device to complete the  
pairing. If a passkey is required, do one of the following.  
Auto-Connect: Allows paired devices to reconnect automatically  
when they are within range and a phone call or text message is  
received.  
An automatically generated passkey appears on the passkey  
screen: Check the other device screen to verify that the passkey is  
correct, and tap Yes, connect to connect.  
The screen displays a passkey generated by your tablet: Enter the  
displayed passkey on the other device.  
Receive Phone Calls: Allows you to make and receive phone calls on  
both devices.  
Receive SMS: Allows you to send and receive text messages on both  
devices. This is available on compatible webOS smartphones only.  
The screen prompts you to enter a passkey: Check the  
documentation that came with the other device to see if there’s a  
required passkey. If so, enter that passkey on your tablet. If not,  
make up a passkey and enter it on both devices.  
Disconnect from a device  
Disconnecting from a device does not mean you delete the relationship  
you created between that device and your tablet. See Connect with a  
paired device for instructions on how to reconnect with the device.  
Connect with a paired device  
1
2
Open Bluetooth  
.
After you pair with a device, you can connect to that device without  
having to go through the pairing process again.  
Tap the connected device name to disconnect from it. Or tap  
another device name to disconnect from the current device and  
connect to the new device.  
1
2
Open Bluetooth  
.
Make sure Bluetooth is on (see Turn the Bluetooth feature on/off)  
and tap the device name.  
3
Tap OK.  
Delete a device  
NOTE To connect with a paired computer, you must initiate the connection from  
the computer. See the computer documentation for instructions.  
Deleting a device means you end the relationship you created between  
your device and that device. This means that you will need to pair with  
that device again if you want to connect (see Make a pairing request to  
another device). If all you want to do is temporarily disconnect from a  
device, see Disconnect from a device.  
Manage webOS smartphone connection preferences  
1
2
3
Open Bluetooth  
Tap beside the smartphone name.  
Tap On/Off for any of the following:  
.
1
2
Open Bluetooth  
.
Throw the name off the side of the screen and tap Delete.  
Chapter 14 : Wireless connections 167  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
1
2
Make sure Bluetooth is turned on on your device (see Turn the  
Bluetooth feature on/off) and on your smartphone (see the  
documentation that came with your smartphone).  
Rename a device  
1
2
3
4
Open Bluetooth  
.
Touch the smartphone to your device, with the HP logo on the back  
Tap and hold the device name.  
of the smartphone touching the area of the Center  
your device.  
button on  
Enter a new name.  
A ripple is displayed on the device screen to indicate that the  
smartphone has been placed correctly, and a notification appears  
on both devices to indicate that the pairing was successful.  
Tap outside the device name field to save your changes.  
The devices remain paired while in range (approximately 30 feet (10  
meters)). If the devices move out of range of each other, provided the  
relationship between the two devices has not been deleted (see  
Delete a device), they reconnect automatically upon receiving a  
phone call or text message when they are back within range.  
Touch to Share  
What is Touch to Share?  
When you set up a Touch to Share relationship with a webOS  
smartphone, you can manage the connection preferences from the  
Touch to Share lets you easily transfer web pages between your HP  
TouchPad and an HP webOS smartphone. If you have a web page open  
on your HP TouchPad or on a webOS smartphone, simply touch the  
devices to transfer the page from one device to the other.  
What’s more, if you have a compatible webOS smartphone that shares  
an HP webOS Account with your device, you can use Touch to Share to  
pair it with your device, allowing you to share calls, and, on some  
smartphones, text messages between your device and your smartphone. If  
you receive a phone call or text message, it appears on your device, and  
if you want to make a phone call or send a text message, you can do that  
from your device.  
Share a web page using Touch to Share  
1
Make sure Bluetooth is turned on on your device (see Turn the  
Bluetooth feature on/off) and on your smartphone (see the  
documentation that came with your smartphone).  
2
3
Open Web  
and open a web page that you want to send to your  
If your device and webOS smartphone do not share an HP webOS  
Account, you can still pair them and you can manage phone calls and,  
on compatible smartphones, text messages on your device (see Make a  
smartphone.  
Tap the smartphone to the Center  
button of the device.  
The web page opens in full screen on the smartphone.  
You can also share a web page you open on your smartphone with your  
device. This is useful when you want to view the web page on a larger  
screen. Repeat steps 1 and 2 above, except open the web page on your  
smartphone, then Touch to Share it on your device.  
Pair with an HP webOS smartphone using Touch to Share  
BEFORE YOU BEGIN Your device must be connected to a Wi-Fi network to  
168 Chapter 14 : Wireless connections  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Disconnect a Touch to Share connection  
1
2
Open Bluetooth  
.
Tap the webOS smartphone name to disconnect from it.  
Delete a Touch to Share connection  
1
2
Open Bluetooth  
.
Throw the webOS smartphone name off the side of the screen and  
tap Delete.  
Chapter 14 : Wireless connections 169  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
170 Chapter 14 : Wireless connections  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
15 Troubleshooting  
5Ts: Ways to get your HP TouchPad working  
again  
Introduction  
Is your HP TouchPad not working the way you expect it to? Has it stopped  
responding to taps? Is one of your applications not responding or  
behaving in an unexpected way?  
These problems can be pretty easy to fix.  
Here are five different methods—5Ts—that you can try, on your own, to  
get your device working again.  
Try each method in the order it’s presented to see if it solves your  
problem. When the problem is solved, stop.  
T1. Throw all open applications off the top of the screen  
NOTE If the screen is off and you can’t turn it on, or if gestures don’t work, skip  
1
2
If you’re working in an application that’s displayed full-screen and it  
isn’t responding, press Center to send the app to Card view.  
Throw the app off the top of the screen to close it.  
Chapter 15 : Troubleshooting 171  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
T3.Trigger a restart  
1
2
Press and hold the power button.  
While still holding down the power button, press and hold  
Center  
until the HP logo appears (about 15 seconds).  
Why this might help  
A restart may be effective if the screen is off and you can’t turn it on, or if  
the screen is on but doesn’t respond to taps or other gestures.  
3
Throw any other open applications off the top of the screen to close  
them.  
Why this might help  
NOTE Because open applications are forced to close immediately during this  
kind of restart, some unsaved data may be lost.  
One or more of your open applications could be reserving so much  
memory that there’s not enough memory left to do real work. Closing  
apps can free up enough memory so you can continue working.  
TIP An occasional restart can be good for your device just the way a restart can  
be good for your computer. Every once in a while, restart your device.  
T2. Turn your device completely off and on  
T4. Top off the battery  
NOTE If the screen is off and you can’t turn it on, or if gestures don’t work, skip  
1
Connect your USB cable to the AC charger and to your device.  
1
2
3
Press and hold the power button.  
Tap Shut Down.  
To turn your device back on, press and hold the power button until  
the HP logo appears.  
Why this might help  
Shutting down your device closes all applications, frees up all memory,  
and reinitializes wireless services (Bluetooth® technology, Wi-Fi, and  
VPN). A fresh start.  
2
3
Plug the AC charger into a working electric outlet.  
Let the battery charge completely.  
172 Chapter 15 : Troubleshooting  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Why this might help  
HP webOS Account  
Fully charging the battery ensures your device is not conserving power  
due to a low battery.  
Creating your HP webOS Account: Is your device ready for  
setup?  
NOTE If you use an HP Touchstone, be sure to complete T4 using the USB cable  
and the AC charger, not the Touchstone. Connecting directly to an outlet is more  
effective in waking a device.  
BEFORE YOU BEGIN Did you remove the clear plastic screen protector? Your  
device won’t respond well to your taps if the protector is covering the  
touchscreen.  
Look along the top of the screen from left to right:  
Do you see:  
T5. Tether your device to your computer and reinstall webOS  
IMPORTANT Don’t try this method until you’ve already tried the four Ts before  
this.  
1
The Wi-Fi icon showing white bars (not gray)?  
No? Then turn Wi-Fi on and connect to a network (see Wi-Fi).  
A battery icon that is green or at least one-third white?  
1
On your computer’s web browser, go to hpwebos.com/account,  
sign in, and write down the device’s product number and serial  
number.  
2
No? Then charge your device: Plug the USB cable into the AC  
charger, plug the charger into an electric outlet, and attach the small  
end of the cable to the charger/microUSB connector on your device.  
Charge the device for at least one hour.  
2
3
Go to hpwebos.com/rom and click the link to get webOS Doctor.  
Enter the device’s product number and serial number and follow the  
instructions.  
If you answered Yes to all these questions and still can’t set up your  
account, read the next sections.  
Why this might help  
Installing the latest version of webOS wipes and refreshes all memory.  
Your preferences, installed software, and files in USB drive storage are not  
affected.  
Creating your HP webOS Account: Are you trying to use an  
account from another webOS device?  
Want help while you use webOS Doctor? Go to hpwebos.com/support.  
Select your device and click Support Services. Select one of the support  
options.  
When you set up your device, did you tap Sign In on the HP webOS  
Account screen? Tap the Sign In button only if you can answer Yes to  
these questions:  
Did you create a valid HP webOS Account on another webOS device  
in the past?  
Do you want to use that same HP webOS Account again on your new  
webOS device?  
Chapter 15 : Troubleshooting 173  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
If you answered No to those questions, do this:  
Swipe left on the screen until you see the HP webOS Account screen  
again. Then tap Create New Account.  
If you answered Yes to the questions, do this:  
3
4
Tap the Email field and enter a valid email address. Enter the same  
email address in the Confirm Email field. Note the following:  
If you forgot the account password, tap Forgot Login? Enter the answer  
to your security question and tap Done. Create a new password and  
tap Done.  
Enter the full address, for example: yourname@emailaccount.com.  
Enter the address accurately, with an @ sign and a period, and  
the appropriate domain type at the end (com, net, and so on).  
If that doesn’t work, do this:  
For help on setting up your old account on your new device, go to  
hpwebos.com/support. Select your device and click Support Services.  
Select one of the support options.  
Create a password for your account. It must be between 6 and 20  
characters long. You must enter it exactly the same way in the  
Password and Confirm Password fields. Note the following:  
This password can be anything you want. You do not need to  
enter the password associated with the email address you entered.  
To type a symbol that appears on a number key on the keyboard:  
Creating your HP webOS Account: Are you having trouble  
creating a new account?  
Tap Shift  
and then the key (see Enter symbols and alternate  
To create an HP webOS Account, do the following:  
To enter an accented character or a symbol that doesn’t appear  
on the keyboard: Tap to open the symbol keyboard, and  
tap the symbol. If the symbol you want is not displayed, tap  
to return to the alphanumeric keyboard, and then tap and hold a  
key to see the symbols associated with that key. When you see the  
symbol you want, tap it. For a complete list of the symbols  
associated with each key, see Symbols and accented characters.  
1
2
During setup, tap Create New Account.  
Tap the field labeled First and Last Name and enter your first and  
last name.  
5
6
Tap the question displayed in the Security Question field, and select  
a security question. Tap the Answer field and enter the answer.  
Tap Create.  
174 Chapter 15 : Troubleshooting  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2
3
Click Forgot password?  
Creating your HP webOS Account: Unable to complete? Try  
this  
Enter the email address you used to create your HP webOS Account  
and click Next.  
To start setup over from the beginning, tap Start Over in the lower-left  
corner of any screen.  
4
5
6
Enter the answer to your security question and click Next.  
If your device stops responding to taps, restart your device and begin  
again by doing this:  
Enter your new password twice.  
(Optional) Click Change Security Question, select a security  
question, and enter your answer.  
1
2
Press and hold the power button until you see two buttons—Turn Off  
and Cancel.  
7
Click Reset Password.  
Tap Turn Off. Wait for the device to shut down completely.  
If you never verified your account or didn’t create a security question, the  
process is a little different. Do this:  
1
Go to hpwebos.com/account, select your device, and then click  
Manage HP webOS Account.  
3
Press and hold the power button and begin setup again.  
2
3
Click Forgot password?  
If you are unable to create an account, check the status of the webOS  
server: Go to hpwebos.com/support. Select your device and click  
Support Services. Select one of the support options. There may be a  
temporary outage affecting your area.  
Enter the email address you used to create your HP webOS Account  
and click Next.  
4
5
Type the text you see in the white box and click Send Email.  
Open your email program on your computer, and open the email  
with the subject How to reset your security information.  
Having trouble logging in to your HP webOS Account?  
6
7
8
Click the link in the email.  
Remember, to log in to your HP webOS Account, you must enter the same  
email address and password you used to create the account.  
Enter your new password twice.  
(Optional) Click Change Security Question, select a security  
question, and enter your answer.  
TIP After you create your HP webOS Account, you get an email at the address  
you used to create the account. Click the link in the email message to verify your  
account.  
9
Click Reset Password.  
If that doesn’t work, or if you can’t remember your security question and  
answer, get help on gaining access to your account: Go to  
hpwebos.com/support. Select your device and click Support Services.  
Select one of the support options.  
If you verified your account when you created it, do this:  
1
Go to hpwebos.com/account, select your device, and then click  
Manage HP webOS Account.  
Chapter 15 : Troubleshooting 175  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Battery  
WARNING Never remove the back cover of your HP TouchPad. The battery is  
built in to your device and is not removable.  
The battery drains quickly  
Make sure the AC charger is securely inserted into a working outlet. Try  
a different outlet if one is available.  
Try a different compatible USB cable if one is available.  
If the battery seems to drain quickly from normal use, see Maximizing  
battery life for tips on improving battery life.  
If you still experience problems and you frequently leave the Wi-Fi feature  
on even when you are not using the device, change the sleep setting for  
Wi-Fi. See Put Wi-Fi to sleep when the screen is off for instructions.  
If you are trying to charge the battery using an HP Touchstone, try these  
steps in sequence:  
Make sure your device is correctly positioned on the Touchstone. If the  
HP TouchPad is correctly positioned, a “Charging Battery” notification  
appears, and a lightning bolt appears on the battery icon in the  
upper-right corner of the screen.  
The battery doesn’t charge or doesn’t hold a charge  
Make sure the USB cable is securely connected to the AC charger.  
If you are trying to charge the battery using the USB cable, try these steps  
in sequence:  
NOTE The Touchstone does not work when it is connected to a computer.  
Make sure you are using the USB cable and AC charger that came with  
your HP TouchPad, or a compatible cable or charger approved by HP.  
Make sure the AC charger is securely inserted into a working outlet.  
If the outlet is connected to a light switch or power strip, make sure the  
power is on.  
NOTE Your HP TouchPad does not charge if you connect it to a computer using  
the USB cable.  
Try a different outlet if one is available.  
Restart your device (see Restart your device).  
Make sure the small end of the cable is securely attached to the  
charger/microUSB connector on your device. Make sure the other end  
is securely connected to the AC charger.  
I need to replace the battery  
WARNING Never remove the back cover of your HP TouchPad. The battery is  
built in to your device and is not removable.  
176 Chapter 15 : Troubleshooting  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Contact HP to get your device repaired. Within the warranty period, your  
battery should not need replacing. With good treatment, your battery is  
likely to last for a couple of years. See Maximizing battery life for helpful  
tips.  
7
If you don’t see a display or the screen doesn’t respond to taps,  
press and hold both the power button and Center for 15  
seconds to restart your device. Then wait until your device completes  
startup.  
An application is not responding to taps  
Screen and performance  
1
Make sure you have removed the screen protector that came  
attached to your device screen.  
The screen appears blank  
2
Check to see if the screen has any cracks. If it does, contact Support  
for further assistance: Go to hpwebos.com/support. Select your  
device and click Support Services. Select one of the support options.  
When the device is on and idle, the screen first dims and then turns off.  
This is normal behavior, caused by the auto shut-off interval. You can  
adjust this auto shut-off interval to be as long as 10 minutes (see Set the  
as a power-saving measure. Just tap the screen to brighten it. Then, if your  
device remains inactive for the full interval you set, the screen turns itself  
off. Press the power button to turn the screen back on.  
3
4
5
Make sure the screen is not locked. Press the power button and drag  
up to unlock the screen.  
Press Center  
. If the application screen minimizes to a card,  
throw the card off the top of the screen to close the app.  
Follow these steps in sequence if you can’t turn the screen back on:  
If the screen does not respond to taps at all, press and hold both the  
power button and Center  
for 15 seconds to restart your device.  
1
2
Make sure you have removed the protective cover that came  
attached to your device screen.  
Then wait until your device completes startup.  
6
If this does not solve the problem, see 5Ts: Ways to get your HP  
TouchPad working again for additional steps to try.  
Make sure that there are no stickers covering any part of the front of  
the device.  
3
4
To brighten the screen if it has dimmed, tap the screen.  
To turn on the screen, do one of the following:  
Applications are running slowly  
Press the power button. Drag  
Press Center  
up to unlock the screen.  
NOTE Be sure that any third-party applications you install are compatible with  
HP webOS and HP TouchPad tablets. Applications written for earlier Palm  
devices using the Palm OS by ACCESS operating system or Windows Mobile  
are not compatible with your HP TouchPad. If you can try a free version of the  
software before purchasing it, you can test it first to make sure it works properly.  
.
5
6
Look closely at the screen. If the display appears but is faint, try  
adjusting the screen brightness (see Turn auto dim on/off).  
If the problem persists, connect your device to the AC charger (see  
Charge the battery). If you see a faint display, try to restart your  
device (see Restart your device).  
1
2
Press Center  
to display Card view.  
Scroll through the cards and note how many applications are open.  
Chapter 15 : Troubleshooting 177  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
3
Close any application you are not using by throwing its card off the  
top of the screen.  
3
To change which applications are associated with the account: For  
each app listed, tap On or Off.  
If the problem persists after you close apps you are not using, restart your  
device (see Restart your device). If this does not solve the problem, see  
try.  
You can also remove an application from online account sync from within  
the application itself.  
1
2
3
4
Open the application.  
Open the application menu and tap Preferences & Accounts.  
Tap the account name.  
There are small icons at the top of the screen  
Your device screen always displays the time and battery icon in the top  
right corner.  
Tap Remove Account, and then tap Remove [app name] Account.  
To the left of these are system icons, showing network connection status,  
wireless services that are turned on, and so on.  
I want to sync with Outlook or Palm Desktop by ACCESS  
software on my computer  
To the left of these are notification icons. These icons represent  
notifications that you have not opened or dismissed. If you see one or  
more notification icons, tap or drag down over the icons to display your  
notifications (see View and work with notifications).  
Your HP TouchPad can synchronize with select online services so that you  
can store and sync your info in online accounts (see Manage online  
accounts). You can access your data even when you are not able to make  
a connection to the web because your data is stored on your device.  
If you want to continue using a desktop organizer to store your contacts  
and calendar events—iCal and Address Book on the Mac, or desktop  
Outlook® or Palm Desktop by ACCESS on Windows—and if there are  
third-party solutions available for your device, you may have two choices:  
Synchronization  
I don’t want to sync calendar or contact information with my  
online account—just email  
Sync directly with your desktop organizer, avoiding the web completely.  
Sync your desktop organizer with Google on the web, and then sync  
Google with your device.  
For most online account providers that sync with more than one app—for  
example, Google—if you do not want to sync an application with that  
provider’s online account, you can remove that application from the  
account using the Accounts application. The online account continues to  
sync with any other related applications.  
Both choices require you to use a third-party solution (sold separately). Go  
to hpwebos.com/sync-solutions to see if third--party solutions are  
available for your device. If there are no solutions available for your  
device, check with the developers of existing sync software for other  
webOS devices to see if they are developing a solution for your device.  
1
2
Open Accounts  
.
For more information, see Sync your desktop organizer and your device.  
Tap the account name.  
178 Chapter 15 : Troubleshooting  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
If the problem persists, see Making room on your device for other  
suggestions.  
I have an Exchange account at work, but my data is not  
being downloaded to my device  
Check with your system administrator to obtain or verify the name of the  
mail server that offers you wireless access to the corporate mail system.  
If you cannot obtain the name of this server (some companies do not give  
it out because they do not want wireless access to their servers), you  
cannot synchronize with your Exchange account.  
A notification tells me that the server could not be reached  
Make sure your device is connected to a Wi-Fi network (see Icons in the  
If your company requires you to change your password for accessing your  
Exchange account, you must change the password on your device (see  
If you have a network connection and receive this notification, it means  
your device had to wait too long to connect to the Exchange server. The  
connection may have been lost, the server may be temporarily  
overloaded, or the server may have encountered an internal error. Check  
your Exchange server name and proxy server settings (see Set up email:  
Microsoft Exchange and Lotus Notes), and try again later.  
I entered the settings to sync with Exchange, but I can’t  
synchronize with my company’s Exchange server  
A notification tells me that ActiveSync encountered a problem  
with [item type] [item name]  
Check with your system administrator to find out if a systemwide locking  
policy is in place.  
There was an error while synchronizing a single item. This error can  
usually be corrected only by deleting the item that caused the error. If you  
sync again to see if the error persists, be aware that items causing this  
type of error are skipped and do not show up again.  
A notification tells me that ActiveSync encountered a problem  
on the server  
There is a temporary problem with the server, or the server may be  
temporarily overloaded. Try again later, and if the problem persists,  
contact your system administrator.  
Email  
A notification tells me that there is not enough free memory to  
synchronize  
I have problems using my account  
Occasionally you may experience problems using an email account after  
you set it up. If you followed the account setup procedure (see Set up  
email) and are experiencing problems using the account, verify that the  
account complies with your email provider’s requirements:  
1
2
3
Press Center  
to display Card view.  
Scroll through the cards and note how many applications are open.  
Close any application you are not using by throwing its card off the  
top of the screen.  
Verify both your password and your username for your email account.  
Chapter 15 : Troubleshooting 179  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
If you changed your password in an online email account, you must  
change the password on your device (see Change account login  
Make sure your email provider or ISP allows you to access email on a  
device via POP or IMAP. (Some providers do not offer this option at all;  
other providers require an upgrade for you to access email on a  
device.)  
Enter the name of a different outgoing mail server for sending mail (see  
Set up email when automatic setup fails). Many ISPs, such as cable  
companies, require that you have an Internet connection to their  
network to send email through their servers. In this case, you can almost  
always receive email from these accounts, but if you want to send  
email, you must send it through another server. Check with your email  
service provider for the correct outgoing mail server name.  
Email provider settings may change. If your email account was working  
but you are currently experiencing problems, check with your email  
provider to find out whether any of the account settings have changed.  
You may need to manually change some email settings on your device  
I can send but not receive email (IMAP accounts)  
Some IMAP email providers don’t support the setting to receive email As  
items arrive. Check with your email provider to see if this situation applies  
to your account. If your device is set to receive email as it arrives, try  
changing the Sync setting for Get Email to 5 or 10 minutes (see Enter  
I have problems sending and receiving email  
Make sure your device is connected to a Wi-Fi network (see Icons in the  
After I receive messages, older messages disappear from my  
Inbox  
For problems sending and receiving email using an Exchange email  
account, see the following sections:  
When email sync takes place, by default, the last three days’ worth of  
email messages is downloaded from your mail server to your Inbox. All  
messages older than three days are removed from your Inbox; they are  
not deleted on the server, however.  
You can change the setting to download only one or two days’ worth of  
messages. If you select one of these options, any messages older than  
one or two days are deleted from your Inbox. You can also change the  
setting to download all messages regardless of the date, in which case all  
messages continue to appear in your Inbox (see Enter advanced account  
I have problems sending email (IMAP and POP accounts)  
If you are able to receive email messages but cannot send them, try the  
following:  
I have trouble sending or receiving attachments  
Turn on authentication (see Set up email when automatic setup fails).  
Many service providers require authenticated access, or ESMTP, to use  
their SMTP servers for outgoing mail.  
Confirm the port number for the outgoing mail server. Many ISPs require  
a specific port number, and that number may differ from the default port  
number.  
Email attachments smaller than 150KB are downloaded automatically.  
All other attachments have to be downloaded manually by tapping the  
attachment name in the email. You may need to tap the attachment to  
complete receiving it.  
180 Chapter 15 : Troubleshooting  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sometimes an attachment to an email may prevent the email from being  
sent. The reason may be related to the account, an account setting, or  
the file. To determine whether this is the case, try sending the email  
without the attachment, or try sending the email from a different email  
account. If a different account works, check the settings of the problem  
account. If sending the email without the attachment works, also check  
the account settings, and try sending the email with another file, in case  
the first file was damaged.  
If you are trying to set up a Yahoo! IM account, note that you can have  
only one Yahoo! IM account on your device at a time. If you already  
have a Yahoo IM! account on your device, you must remove it before  
you can set up a different one (see Use the Accounts application to edit  
Make sure your device is connected to a Wi-Fi network (see Icons in the  
Verify you have an Internet connection by going to a website (see Go to  
Make sure the account you want to set up is supported. See Set up an  
instant messaging (IM) account for information. If the account you want  
is not listed, or is not available in HP webOS App Catalog when you  
tap Find More, the account is not available at this time. Be sure to check  
back—your webOS device periodically adds support for new account  
types.  
Messaging  
I can’t send or receive text messages  
To use text messaging on your device, you must be connected to a  
compatible HP webOS smartphone (see Use your HP TouchPad with a  
I can’t send or receive instant messages  
If possible, contact the recipient of the message, and make sure the  
receiving device can handle the type of message you’re sending.  
Make sure your device is connected to a Wi-Fi network (see Icons in the  
If a message arrives but does not display a notification, make sure  
message notifications are turned on (see Customize messaging  
Make sure your instant messaging (IM) account is properly set up (see  
Make sure you are logged into your IM account (see Sign in to an IM  
account).  
If a message arrives but does not display a notification, make sure  
message notifications are turned on (see Customize messaging  
I can’t send or receive multimedia messages  
You can’t send or receive multimedia messages on your HP TouchPad. If  
you receive a multimedia message on a connected webOS smartphone, a  
notification appears on your HP TouchPad. You must view the message on  
the smartphone, however.  
Restart your device (see Restart your device).  
Wi-Fi  
I can’t set up an instant messaging (IM) account  
I can’t make a Wi-Fi connection from my home network  
To set up an IM account on your device, you must already have the IM  
account established online. If you don’t, first set up the account online.  
Turn off Wi-Fi, and then turn it on again (see Turn Wi-Fi on/off).  
If you are logged into the account from another location, log out from  
that location and try setting up the account on your device again.  
Chapter 15 : Troubleshooting 181  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
If the device does not automatically connect to a known network, select  
your Wi-Fi network from the list. If the device does not detect your Wi-Fi  
network, continue to the next step.  
Try connecting to the Wi-Fi network with another computer or device.  
If you cannot connect using the other device, there may be a  
problem with the Wi-Fi network’s Internet connection or wireless  
router. Report the problem to the system administrator.  
Try connecting to the Wi-Fi network with another computer or device.  
If you cannot connect using the other device, there may be a  
problem with your Internet connection or wireless router. Unplug  
the modem and the wireless router and reboot the modem. After  
the modem re-establishes an Internet connection, plug in the  
wireless router and try connecting again. If you still can't connect  
with the other device or computer, contact your Internet service  
provider.  
If you can connect with the other device, but not with the HP  
TouchPad, continue with the next step.  
Does the Wi-Fi network use MAC address filtering? MAC address  
filtering is a common method of securing a Wi-Fi network. The filter list  
is similar to a guest list at a party; if you’re not on the list, you can't  
come in. The filter list (allowing access to the Wi-Fi network) lives on the  
Wi-Fi router. This list is maintained by the system administrator and you  
must provide the administrator with your device’s MAC address and  
request to be added to the list. To find your device’s MAC address:  
If you can connect with the other device, but not with the HP  
TouchPad, continue with the next step.  
Open Device Info  
and tap More Info. The MAC address is the Wi-Fi  
Does your Wi-Fi network use MAC address filtering? MAC address  
filtering is a common method of securing a Wi-Fi network. The filter list  
is similar to a guest list at a party; if you’re not on the list, you can't  
come in. The filter list (allowing access to your network) lives on your  
Wi-Fi router. If your Wi-Fi network uses MAC address filtering, you need  
to log in to the Wi-Fi router and add your device’s MAC address to the  
access control list. Because each router has a unique method to perform  
this task, consult your router documentation for detailed instructions. To  
hex number under Device.  
Restart your device (see Restart your device).  
I am trying to connect my device to my Wi-Fi network and  
need to find the device’s MAC address  
find your device’s MAC address: Open Device Info  
and tap More  
Open Device Info  
, tap More Info, and tap Hardware. Under Device,  
Info. The MAC address is the Wi-Fi hex number under Device.  
the number listed to the right of Wi-Fi is your device’s MAC address.  
Restart your device (see Restart your device).  
I can’t make a Wi-Fi connection from a public or corporate  
network  
Web  
Turn off Wi-Fi, and then turn it on again (see Turn Wi-Fi on/off).  
If the device does not automatically connect to a known network, do  
one of the following:  
I can’t access a web page  
Make sure your device is connected to a Wi-Fi network (see Icons in the  
title bar). If you do not have a Wi-Fi network connection, see the topic  
that matches your situation:  
Select the Wi-Fi network you want to connect to from the list.  
If you’re trying to connect to a secure network with a hidden  
name, ask the system administrator for the info needed to connect  
to the network.  
If you’re not trying to connect to a secure network with a hidden  
name and there are no Wi-Fi networks detected, there are no  
Wi-Fi networks available for the device to connect to. Try moving  
to another location and attempting the connection again.  
182 Chapter 15 : Troubleshooting  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Clear the cache in Web Preferences. Open Web  
and open the  
Calendar and Contacts  
application menu. Tap Preferences, and then tap Clear Cache. This  
ensures that pages are viewed directly from the Internet and not from a  
saved copy of the page on the device. Then close Web  
and reopen  
it.  
I haven’t entered any contacts or calendar events on my  
device, but when I open those apps, I see entries  
To confirm you have an Internet connection, try to view a web page  
you’ve loaded before.  
After confirming your Internet connection, try to view the page again. If  
The entries you see displayed in Calendar or Contacts have been  
downloaded to your device from one of your online accounts such as  
Google or Exchange. In the Accounts application, as well as in Email,  
Calendar, or Contacts, you can set up a relationship to wirelessly sync  
data with one of these accounts. When you do so, you specify the apps  
that should download data from that account. So, for example, you could  
set up your Google account in Email, and choose whether to also  
download contacts and calendar events. If you choose to download  
Google calendar info, your device’s calendar automatically displays  
events entered in your Google calendar—even though you haven’t  
opened the app yet.  
it comes up blank, tap  
.
Some websites redirect simple web addresses given to the public to  
actual web addresses that are more complex (for example, if you enter  
the address www.hpwebos.com/support, it may actually go to the web  
address http://www.hpwebos.com/us/support). If the Web app can’t  
follow the redirect, enter the web address in a desktop browser and  
read the actual web address in the address bar. Then enter the actual  
address in Web at the top of the screen.  
If a website appears static or is missing content, look for a Skip button,  
a link to a mobile or tablet version of the site, or a link to a basic HTML  
version of the site that your device can render properly.  
You can remove an online account from an application so that that app  
no longer syncs with that account (see Use the Accounts application to  
If you’re still having trouble, the page may contain elements that are  
not supported by the browser, such as Shockwave, Silverlight, VBScript,  
WML script, and other plug-ins.  
An image or map is too small on my screen  
My personal and work contact and calendar information is  
getting merged into a single view—I’d rather keep them  
separate  
Do either of the following:  
To switch to landscape mode to see more of the image, turn the device  
on its side.  
To zoom in on the image, pinch out or double-tap the image.  
The HP Synergy feature on your device displays information from several  
sources in a single view, so you can access your info quickly, without  
having to remember where you stored it. Even though the information is  
visible in one view, the sources of that information are kept separate.  
A secure site refuses to permit a transaction  
In Calendar, to see events from just one calendar, tap Hide All on the right  
side of the screen, and then tap the individual account you want to view  
on the left (see Change the Calendar display).  
Some websites don’t support certain browsers for transactions. Contact  
the site’s webmaster to make sure the site allows transactions using your  
device’s web browser.  
In Contacts, the list view shows all contacts from all accounts. You can,  
however, see what data comes from which account by opening the  
contact and tapping Edit. If you want to unlink contacts, see Unlink a  
Chapter 15 : Troubleshooting 183  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
You can also keep inbox views separate in Email: Turn off the smart folder  
for All Inboxes (see Set email preferences), then make the inboxes of your  
individual accounts favorites so that they’re always easy to see in the  
Account List panel (see Add an email folder as a favorite).  
If you make changes or add to a Facebook, LinkedIn, or Yahoo!  
contact entry on your device, the device creates a new contact in  
the default Contacts account, adds the changes to this new  
contact, and then links the new contact to the original Facebook,  
LinkedIn, or Yahoo! contact. The changes sync with the default  
Contacts account, not with your Facebook, LinkedIn, or Yahoo!  
account.  
Changes made on Facebook.com, LinkedIn.com, or Yahoo.com  
are reflected on your device every 24 hours, or after you manually  
sync.  
Some of my contact information is missing  
NOTE Contacts associated with a Microsoft Exchange server sync as items  
arrive. Items for Google and other online accounts are synced from every few  
hours to up to once a day. If the contact is available in your online account, it  
will show up on your device within a day, as long as you are have a network  
connection. Contacts created in your HP webOS Account are backed up daily.  
If the missing contact is from a LinkedIn account, make sure the contact  
is in your direct network. The device does not sync second- and  
third-level connections.  
If the missing contact information is from another account that is  
compatible with the HP Synergy feature, you need to contact the  
developer for help.  
Sync your Contacts accounts (see Manually synchronize Contacts with  
Set the default Contacts account (see Customize Contacts).  
Search to locate the contact information (see Find a contact)  
Check other contacts that have the same phone number or email  
address to make sure the missing contact information has not been  
improperly linked to another contact. If you have contacts with matching  
information, tap the contact name at the top of the screen to display  
any linked contacts. If you find the missing contact, tap it, and then tap  
Unlink this profile. The unlinked contact now appears as a separate  
entry in Contacts.  
Verify that your contact information is correct in your online account.  
If the missing contact is from a Google account, make sure the contact  
is in your My Contacts list in Google. If your Google contacts are only  
partially synchronizing, check for contact names that start with a special  
character (like @,*, or #) instead of a letter. Delete the nonalphabetic  
character from the contact’s name. Synchronize again to see if all of  
your contacts are listed.  
If the missing contact is from an Exchange account, make sure the email  
account is set up as an Exchange account, not a POP or IMAP account.  
An Exchange account that is set up as a POP or IMAP account cannot  
sync contacts (see Change account login settings).  
If the missing contact is from Facebook, LinkedIn, or Yahoo! note the  
following:  
Facebook and LinkedIn contact info comes from the profile of the  
Facebook friend or LinkedIn contact. Because Facebook.com and  
LinkedIn.com do not allow you to change another user’s profile,  
any changes you make on your device do not affect the contact’s  
info on the web. When a Facebook friend or LinkedIn contact  
makes changes to his or her profile, these changes are transferred  
to your device the next time the account syncs.  
Yahoo! accounts support a one-way transfer of Yahoo! contact  
info from the web to the device. The info on your device updates  
each time the account syncs, but Yahoo! accounts do not provide  
two-way synchronization.  
My contact data is in the wrong field  
If your incorrect contact data is being synced from an online account,  
update the contact information in your online account. If your incorrect  
contact data is being backed up with your HP webOS Account, update  
your contact information on your device.  
Manually synchronize Contacts (see Manually synchronize Contacts  
184 Chapter 15 : Troubleshooting  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Make sure your device is connected to a Wi-Fi network (see Icons in the  
I have duplicate contacts  
Set up your online account to sync on your device if you have not  
already done so (see How do I get events into Calendar?).  
If the duplicate contacts are from the same source—if, for example, both  
contacts are Google contacts or both contacts are Exchange contacts—  
link the duplicate contacts (see Link a contact).  
IMPORTANT If you want to add a Google Calendar account on your device,  
make sure your Gmail account includes Google Calendar before you add your  
Google account on your device. By default, Gmail accounts do not  
automatically include Google Calendar. If you don’t already have a Gmail  
account, go to mail.google.com and create one. To add Google Calendar to  
your Gmail account, go to google.com/calendar and log in using your Gmail  
account name and password. When prompted, add Google Calendar to your  
account.  
Delete one of the duplicate records from the source, such as Google or  
Exchange, or delete the duplicate from the device (see Delete a  
contact).  
Manually synchronize Contacts with your online accounts (see  
I started entering a contact’s name in Card view or the  
Launcher, but I’m not seeing the person in the results  
Verify the default calendar account. When a new calendar event is  
created on the device, it syncs with the default account (see Customize  
Manually sync Calendar (see Manually synchronize Calendar with your  
With Just Type, you need to enter at least two letters before contact  
matches are returned.  
You may need to scroll down the list to find the match you want.  
If you still don’t see the match you want, try typing a few more  
characters of the person’s name.  
NOTE You should see a notification at the top of your screen when the account  
starts to sync. You may have to wait up to 30 minutes after a sync operation  
starts for your data to appear if the data is located in an online account.  
I can’t synchronize Calendar events  
Delete the account on the device, and then re-create it (see Use the  
Different accounts sync events for different periods of time into the past  
and future. Note the following to be sure the information you want to sync  
is available for the account:  
Some of my calendar information is missing  
Google accounts sync events one month back and two months forward.  
Yahoo! accounts sync events one month back and three months  
forward.  
Exchange accounts sync events two weeks back and unlimited forward.  
If you are trying to synchronize with a desktop application using the  
USB cable, note that HP webOS does not support synchronization of HP  
webOS devices with desktop software such as Palm Desktop software  
or desktop Outlook. Instead, webOS devices synchronize wirelessly  
with online services such as Google or Microsoft Exchange ActiveSync.  
If you are trying to synchronize with a third-party desktop application,  
contact the application developer for support.  
If the missing calendar information is from an Exchange account, make  
sure the email account is set up as an Exchange account, not a POP or  
IMAP account. An Exchange account that is set up as a POP or IMAP  
account cannot sync calendar information (see Change account login  
Verify that your calendar information is correct in your online account.  
Verify that the calendar information is correct on the device.  
Chapter 15 : Troubleshooting 185  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Note the following and determine if the missing information is actually  
available for syncing:  
Calendar notifications are not working  
Google accounts sync events one month back and two months  
forward.  
Yahoo! accounts sync events one month back and three months  
forward.  
If the event is in an online account, make sure that the event exists in the  
online account on your computer, and that a reminder is set for the  
event. Note that it can take up to 30 minutes for an event to synchronize  
from an online account to your device.  
Make sure an alarm is set for the event in Calendar on your device (see  
Make sure that the Event Reminders preference is set to System Sound  
Exchange accounts sync events two weeks back and unlimited  
forward.  
Sync your Calendar accounts (see Manually synchronize Calendar with  
Set the default account (see Customize Calendar).  
Photos & Videos, and Music  
My calendar data is in the wrong field  
I can’t upload my picture  
If your incorrect calendar data is being synced from an online account,  
update the calendar information in your online account. If your  
incorrect calendar data is being backed up with your HP webOS  
Account, update your calendar information on your device.  
Manually synchronize Calendar (see Manually synchronize Calendar  
To upload a picture to a web service such as Facebook or Photobucket,  
you must already have an account with the service, you must have the  
account set up on your device, and you must have access to the Internet  
on your device.  
To upload to Facebook, you must have installed the Facebook app from  
App Catalog on your device (see Download a free application).  
For information about setting up online picture accounts on your device,  
Open Date & Time  
and check whether the online account and the  
device are using the same time zone setting. If not, change the time  
zone either on the device or in the online account so that the time zones  
match.  
I have duplicate calendar events  
I can’t send or upload my video  
If the events are from an online account, delete the account from your  
account), log in to the account on your computer and delete any  
duplicate data, and then add the account to your device again (see  
If the events are in your HP webOS Account, turn off Backup (see Erase  
calendar events on your device (see Delete an event), and then turn on  
Account).  
To upload videos of any size, you need access to the Internet from the  
device. To confirm that you have an Internet connection, open a website  
To upload to Facebook, you must have installed the Facebook app from  
App Catalog on your device, and you must already have an account  
set up on the Facebook site. Facebook has a limit of 2 minutes or  
100MB for unverified accounts, and 20 minutes or 1GB for verified  
accounts (see Download a free application). You also need to add the  
Facebook account from the Contacts app or Accounts app, not the  
Photos app. If you added the Facebook account from the Photos app,  
first delete the Facebook app (see Use the Accounts application to edit  
186 Chapter 15 : Troubleshooting  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
or delete an online account), and then add it from the Contacts app  
(see Customize Contacts) or the Accounts app (see Use the Accounts  
To upload a video to YouTube, you must already have an account set up  
on the YouTube site. YouTube has an upload limit of 10 minutes or 2GB.  
Your device is not connected to the network through a VPBN  
connection. HP webOS printing does not support printing over VPN  
If all of the above are true and your printer is on your corporate network,  
you may need to add the printer manually. See Add a printer.  
If it seems that your HP printer doesn’t support printing from your HP  
TouchPad, a firmware update may be available for the printer that will  
enable this feature. Check the documentation that came with your printer  
for instructions on downloading and installing a firmware update.  
Videos have poor quality during playback  
Low memory on your device may cause video files to play with poor  
quality. Close any other open cards and play the video again.  
Try viewing the same file on your computer and observe the video  
quality. If the video quality is poor when played on the computer, the  
file may be corrupted. Download a new copy of the file to the computer  
and try again. If the new file still won’t play on the computer, contact  
the content provider for information on the quality of the files.  
HP webOS App Catalog  
NOTE HP supports finding, purchasing, downloading, installing, updating, and  
deleting HP webOS App Catalog applications. The app developer cannot assist  
with any of these functions.  
Print Manager  
I can’t find the app I want to download  
I can’t print from my HP printer  
There are several sources of applications for your HP TouchPad:  
Your device supports printing on all network-capable HP printers that  
support PCL page description language in the local LAN. These printers  
include new HP ePrint-capable printers–Photosmart, Officejet, and  
LaserJet–as well as legacy printers approximately five years old or newer.  
Make sure your printer is turned on and that both your device and the  
printer are connected to your local or corporate wireless network. For  
personal printers, see the instructions that came with your printer for  
information about setting up a printer on a wireless network  
App Catalog. App Catalog is located in the Launcher on webOS devices.  
Applications that have been reviewed by HP and meet specific  
development standards are included in App Catalog searches. They  
appear with a blue background on the App Catalog details page for the  
application.  
Web distribution. Web distribution apps are located on the Internet and  
can be found by visiting precentral.net. Web-distributed apps are  
delivered to the device via links and are downloaded and installed using  
App Catalog on the device. The app details page for a web app appears  
with a gray background. Because web-distributed apps have not been  
reviewed by HP, they cannot be found in App Catalog on the device; they  
may, however, appear in Software Manager after they are installed.  
If you are having trouble printing, make sure of the following:  
Your printer is on and is connected to the same network as your HP  
TouchPad.  
The printer is connected to the network over Wi-Fi or through an  
Ethernet cable. You cannot print using a printer connected via USB to a  
computer or a router.  
Chapter 15 : Troubleshooting 187  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Beta apps. Beta apps are prerelease versions of applications that are in  
the final stages of development. Beta apps are usually delivered to the  
device via links and are downloaded and installed using App Catalog on  
the device. The app details page for a beta app appears with a green  
background and displays a banner that says BETA APP. Beta apps cannot  
be found in App Catalog; they may, however, appear in Software  
Manager after they are installed.  
If the app name you used in previous searches was not correct, go  
to precentral.net and repeat the steps with the correct name and  
spelling. If the app still doesn’t appear, the app is not currently  
available for your device through the webOS distribution  
channels. There are several reasons why this may occur. For  
example, the app may not be compatible with your device model,  
the app may not be supported in your region, or the app may be  
a homebrew app. .  
Homebrew or preware. Homebrew or preware applications are  
applications that are developed outside the webOS developer network.  
HP cannot assist with finding, purchasing, downloading, installing,  
updating, or removing these applications. See I want to install an app on  
information about homebrew apps.  
Try looking for another app that provides similar features.  
I am having trouble purchasing an app  
If you see a charge of exactly $1.00, the $1.00 charge has been  
applied by the online retailer as a credit validation charge. This is a  
temporary charge that should be removed shortly. If the charge is not  
removed after 24 hours, get help by doing the following: Go to  
hpwebos.com/support. Select your device and click Support Services.  
Select one of the support options.  
If you have been charged multiple times for the same app, you must  
provide proof to HP. If the charge is not removed after 24 hours, get  
help by doing the following: Go to hpwebos.com/support. Select your  
device and click Support Services. Select one of the support options.  
If you can’t find an application using App Catalog, try the following  
steps.  
Make sure your device is connected to a Wi-Fi network (see Icons in the  
Close HP App Catalog, reopen HP App Catalog, and then try the  
search again.  
On a computer, go to precentral.net. On precentral.net, do the  
following:  
Click the apps link at the top of the page and select App Gallery.  
Under App Catalog Apps, enter the name of the application, and  
click Search.  
Under Web Dist Apps, enter the app name and click Search.  
Under Beta apps, enter the app name and click Search.  
If you find the app, click the link Download Now - webOS Link  
below the application image. When prompted, enter your mobile  
phone number. Click Send to my phone. HP sends a text message  
to your device with a link to the application in App Catalog. After  
the text message arrives, tap the link.  
If App Catalog requests that you enter your billing information after you  
already entered it, this means that HP reset your account due to billing  
address inconsistencies. Re-enter your billing address in App Catalog  
If you receive an alert that says “Card Validation” (credit card number  
and card type do not match), this means that the credit card number is  
valid, but does not match the credit card type. Verify and correct your  
card information (see Update or delete a billing account).  
If you receive an alert that says “Card Validation” (country and credit  
information are set incorrectly), this means that the credit card number  
is not valid for the country in which your device was activated. Verify  
and correct your credit card information (see Update or delete a billing  
account).  
Go to the app developer’s website and confirm the app name  
(including spelling) and that the app is available for webOS.  
If the app is not available for webOS, contact the developer to  
find out if a webOS version will be available soon.  
188 Chapter 15 : Troubleshooting  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If you receive an alert that says “Couldn’t Add Credit Card,” this means  
that the credit card information could not be added to your account.  
The Address Validation Service is temporarily unavailable. Try again  
later to add the credit card information (see Update or delete a billing  
account).  
If you receive an alert that says “Couldn’t update,” try again later to  
update your credit card information (see Update or delete a billing  
account).  
Table 1. App Download Status Icons  
Icon  
Description  
The download or installation of the app failed. Tap the  
icon and follow the prompts to fix the issue.  
The app is currently downloading.  
The app download is currently paused. Tap the icon to  
resume the download.  
The application is already on your device. The icon  
indicates that a new version is available. You can tap the  
icon to download and install the new version at any  
time. Look on the bottom of the Downloads page in the  
Launcher to find your app.  
I’m having trouble downloading an application through HP  
webOS App Catalog  
If you have another version of the app installed on the device without  
using App Catalog, delete it before installing the App Catalog version.  
All applications have a unique App ID, even those that did not originate  
in App Catalog. Your webOS device can serve only one App ID  
instance at any given time.  
If you received an error message that there is not enough room to install  
the app, make space for the new application by deleting another  
application (see Delete an application).  
Make sure your device is connected to a Wi-Fi network (see Icons in the  
Restart your device, and then try the download again (see Restart your  
device).  
I’m having trouble installing an app from HP webOS App  
Catalog  
IMPORTANT Information stored in an application is stored only within the  
application, so you cannot access this info after you delete the app. Before you  
delete an app, write down any info you want to save. Alternatively, you can  
save a screen capture of relevant info by briefly pressing and holding the power  
button + Center. Screens you capture are saved in the screencaptures folder in  
Photos & Videos.  
If you received one of the following errors, the app is not compatible  
with your device:  
This application is not available for your model.  
This application is not available for your carrier.  
This application is not available in your country.  
TIP If you delete an app purchased from App Catalog, you don’t have to  
purchase the application again. Purchased applications are associated with  
your HP webOS Account (see Reinstall a deleted application).  
This application cannot run on your current operating system. Use  
the System Updates app to install the system update and try again.  
Look for the app in Software Manager (see Manage applications with  
Software Manager). You may see one of the following icons to the right  
of the app name:  
This is not a valid webOS application.  
If you received an error message other than the ones shown above,  
follow the prompts to reinstall the app.  
Delete the application (see Delete an application).  
Chapter 15 : Troubleshooting 189  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If you see issues with your device after a webOS update and you have a  
homebrew application installed, use webOS Doctor to restore your device  
to factory default settings. A partial or full erase does not return the device  
to factory settings after some homebrew apps have been installed. See  
TIP If you delete an app purchased from App Catalog, you don’t have to  
purchase the application again. Purchased applications are associated with  
your HP webOS Account (see Reinstall a deleted application).  
Restart your device, and then try the download again (see Restart your  
device).  
Using your HP TouchPad with an HP webOS  
smartphone  
I want to install an app on my device from a source other  
than HP webOS App Catalog  
App Catalog, which includes the on-device catalog and the associated  
web and beta distribution channels, is the only officially supported  
mechanism for installing applications on your HP TouchPad. Third-party  
sources may make applications available for installation on your device  
via alternative mechanisms. These apps are sometimes referred to as  
“homebrew” apps. Homebrew apps have not been tested and certified  
by HP. HP cannot assist with the finding, purchasing, downloading,  
installing, or removing of applications that are not from App Catalog.  
The person on the other end of the line hears an echo  
Try decreasing the volume on your device—whether you are using the  
microphone or a headset—to avoid coupling or feedback on the other  
person’s end.  
I hear my own voice echo  
Installing homebrew applications can modify your webOS device in any  
number of ways that may cause your device to behave erratically over  
time. While your device may work fine with these applications on the  
current version of webOS, it is possible that the application could cause  
issues with your device in future versions of webOS.  
Ask the person on the other end of the call to turn down the volume on his  
or her phone or to hold the phone closer to his or her ear.  
My voice is too quiet on the other end  
If you installed an application via a mechanism other than App Catalog,  
you may find that you cannot download or install software updates, but  
the device continues to prompt you to update. If you have installed such  
an application, you need to remove the app before attempting to update  
your webOS device. Follow the developer’s instructions on how to  
uninstall these apps.  
Be sure to position the microphone, which is on the top of the device,  
close to your mouth. Make sure you are not covering the microphone with  
your finger.  
My device doesn’t ring  
NOTE Be sure to make a backup copy of any information stored in the app  
before you uninstall it. If the developer does not provide a way to back up the  
data, you can write down the information to save it. Alternatively, press the  
power button + Center to save screen captures of important data to the  
screencaptures folder in Photos & Videos.  
Make sure sounds are turned on: Open Sounds & Ringtones  
appears next to Sounds, tap Off to change the setting from Off to On.  
Check the ringtone volume: Open Sounds & Ringtones and drag  
the Ringtone Volume slider to the right to increase the ringtone volume.  
. If Off  
190 Chapter 15 : Troubleshooting  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
If you are using a ringtone you installed, open Sounds & Ringtones  
and tap Ringtone. Tap the default ringtone for your device. If selecting  
the default ringtone solves the problem, the ringtone you installed is not  
working properly. Delete the ringtone you installed from your device by  
When I open the folder representing my device on my  
computer, I see subfolders. Do I need to move my files into  
these folders?  
The default folders are there to help you organize files you copy to and  
from your computer. But you can copy files from your computer into any  
folder you want—you can create your own folders, or just drag your files  
to the top level of the drive. As long as the file is in a supported format,  
your device can detect and open it.  
My device doesn’t vibrate  
Make sure the vibrate setting is turned on: Open Sounds & Ringtones  
. If Off appears next to Vibrate, tap Off to change the setting from  
Off to On.  
Tap, hold, and drag the Ringtone Volume slider in either direction. The  
device should vibrate, and the ringtone should play.  
I want to transfer files from my device to my computer, but the  
screen is cracked or doesn’t respond to taps, so I can’t access  
USB Drive mode  
If you can’t put your device in USB Drive mode using the screen, you can  
use a button combination. Connect your device to your computer using  
the USB cable, and then press and hold the power button + volume  
down.  
Transferring information to and from your  
computer  
When I connect my device to my computer, I don’t get the  
prompt to put the device in USB Drive mode  
Backing up and restoring data  
Check the title bar at the top of the screen. If the USB  
tap the icon to open the dashboard. To put your device in USB Drive  
mode, tap the USB Drive dashboard item.  
icon is displayed,  
I need to reset my device but don’t understand the difference  
among the erase options  
The four erase options are as follows:  
I copied files from my computer, but I can’t see or play them  
on my device  
Erase Apps & Data: Erases all application data and settings, as well as  
any applications you installed from App Catalog.  
When you connect your device to your computer in USB Drive mode, you  
can copy any file onto your device. However, each media application on  
your device—Photos & Videos and Music—can display or play files in  
certain file formats only. If your media file is in an unsupported format,  
you can’t use it on your device.  
Erase USB Drive: Erases all files stored in USB drive storage, such as  
pictures, videos, and music.  
Full Erase: Erases application data and settings, apps you installed, and  
USB drive storage files. Select this option if you want a clean erase of  
your currently installed apps and files but plan to continue using the  
device.  
For a list of supported photo and video file types, see Photos & Videos.  
For a list of supported music file types, see Music.  
Chapter 15 : Troubleshooting 191  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Secure Full Erase: Erases application data and settings, apps you  
installed, and USB drive storage files. Select this option if you are  
planning to give the device away, and you want your data and files to be  
unrecoverable even using a third-party tool.  
My bookmarks were restored, but the thumbnail icon is not  
displaying  
Web bookmarks are part of the data backed up to your HP webOS  
Account. After a partial or full erase, a bookmark is restored with a  
generic thumbnail icon. After you revisit the page for which you created  
the bookmark, the thumbnail icon is restored.  
For more information, see Erase data and reset your device.  
How do I get my data back after a full or partial erase?  
System Updates  
After you perform one of the erase options, on your device, enter your  
existing HP webOS Account email address and password—don’t create a  
new one! When you do this, all data that has been backed up to your  
profile—contacts, and calendar events, as well as apps you bought  
through App Catalog—is restored to your device. To restore information  
about your online accounts to your device, simply enter the password for  
each account when prompted after the erase—synchronization begins  
again.  
I dismissed a system update notification, and now I don’t  
know how to get the update on my device  
If you have a Wi-Fi network connection and the battery has at least a  
30% charge, you can start the update yourself: Open System Updates  
. Your device checks for the availability of the update, and if one is  
available, tap Download Now. The download happens in the  
background, so you can continue to use your device until the actual  
installation takes over.  
The Erase USB Drive option and the two full erase options delete  
everything stored in your device’s USB drive (pictures, videos, music,  
documents, PDF files, and so on). You need to have copies of those files  
available elsewhere if you want to restore them to your device. For  
example, you can save copies on your computer and then transfer them  
Your device continues to remind you to install the update after it has been  
downloaded. You are also reminded that the device will install the update  
automatically the next time you charge your device. An update  
installation cannot begin unless you have at least a 30% charge on your  
battery. If you tap Install Later, the update will automatically install the  
next time the following conditions are true: the device is charging and  
idle, and the battery has at least a 30% charge.  
I want to do a full erase, but the screen is cracked or doesn’t  
respond to taps  
If you can’t do a full erase using the screen, you can use a button  
combination. Press and hold the power button + volume down +  
My device froze while I was downloading or installing a  
system update  
Center  
for 10 seconds.  
If this happens, you can use webOS Doctor to restore your device and  
install the system update from your computer using the USB cable. On  
your computer, go to hpwebos.com/support to download webOS Doctor.  
192 Chapter 15 : Troubleshooting  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
I lost the connection between my device and my Bluetooth  
headset  
Hands-free devices  
If your headset isn’t working, delete the existing pairing (see Delete a  
device) and create a new one (see Set up and use a Bluetooth®  
I can’t make or receive calls using a Bluetooth® hands-free  
device  
If you are making and receiving calls through a connected HP webOS  
smartphone, you can’t use your device to transfer the audio from your  
device to a Bluetooth headset. You can, however, connect the smartphone  
to a Bluetooth headset—this automatically disconnects the smartphone  
from your device and transfers the call audio to the headset.  
I hear static or interference when using my hands-free device  
Be sure your hands-free device has a sufficient battery charge.  
Move to a quieter location to reduce environmental noise.  
Try placing the device and the headset on the same side of the body.  
Try moving your HP TouchPad closer to the hands-free device. Audio  
quality degrades as the distance between your device and the  
hands-free device increases. The effective range for a hands-free device  
varies among manufacturers.  
Confirm that no obstructions, including your body, are between the HP  
TouchPad and your hands-free device. Items such as furniture, people,  
or walls that are in the path between the headset and the device will  
impair audio quality.  
If you are on a Skype voice call and are having trouble using a Bluetooth  
headset, try the following:  
If you have earphones connected to your device, disconnect them.  
Restart your device (see Restart your device).  
Verify that the hands-free device is compatible with your device. Go to  
hpwebos.com/support to see a list of supported devices.  
NOTE This list contains only devices that have been tested for compatibility. It is  
possible that a device that does not appear on the list may be compatible with  
your HP TouchPad.  
Some features of my hands-free device don’t work with my HP  
TouchPad  
Make sure that the Bluetooth feature is turned on (see Turn the Bluetooth  
Make sure that your device is paired with your hands-free device, and  
the hands-free device appears in the Devices list (see Connect with a  
Make sure that the volume on the hands-free device and on your device  
is set loud enough to hear.  
Make sure your Bluetooth hands-free device is charged and turned on.  
Make sure that your device is within range of the hands-free device.  
Bluetooth range is up to 30 feet (10 meters) in optimum environmental  
conditions, which include the absence of obstacles, radio interference  
from nearby electronic equipment, and other factors.  
Check the compatibility list at hpwebos.com/support to ensure that  
your device is compatible with your HP TouchPad.  
Even if the hands-free device is compatible with your HP TouchPad, your  
HP TouchPad may not support all the features of the device. Check the  
documentation that came with your hands-free device or the  
manufacturer’s website for feature-compatibility information between  
the device and your HP TouchPad.  
Make sure that you are away from other devices using the 2.4GHz  
radio frequency, such as cordless phones and microwaves. If this is  
impossible, move the device closer to the hands-free device.  
Chapter 15 : Troubleshooting 193  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Making room on your device  
If you store a large number of files, or install many applications, the  
internal memory on your device may fill up. Here are some ways to clear  
space on your device:  
Photos & Videos, Music, Quickoffice, Adobe Reader: Large files take up  
a lot of memory. Move files to your computer (see Copy files between  
your device and your computer), or delete them from your device.  
Email: Email attachments can be large and consume lots of memory.  
Copy attachments to your computer (see Copy files between your  
device and your computer), or delete large files from your device  
(see Delete a message). You may also want to empty the deleted items  
folder.  
Messaging: If you do a lot of text messaging, delete messages or  
conversations (see Delete a message or Delete a conversation).  
Web: Delete stored web browsing information by clearing your history,  
cookies, and cache (see Customize web browser settings).  
Third-party applications: You can delete infrequently used applications  
194 Chapter 15 : Troubleshooting  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
A Terms  
airplane mode  
Card view  
A mode in which all the wireless services on your device are turned off.  
Wireless services include the Wi-Fi feature, VPN, and Bluetooth® wireless  
The view on your device that displays all open applications as minimized  
cards, allowing you to easily move among and reorder them. The  
background of Card view is your wallpaper. Don’t confuse Card view  
with the Launcher (see Launcher), which shows you all the apps installed  
on your device, not just the open ones. To get to Card view when an app  
application menu  
is displayed full-screen, press Center  
.
A menu hidden in the upper-left corner of the screen that lists items  
available in an application, such as preferences and application help. To  
open the application menu, drag down from the upper-left corner of the  
device (above the screen) onto the screen, or tap the application name in  
the upper-left corner of the screen. See Use the application menu for  
details. See also system menu.  
Center  
The button in the center of the area below the screen. Press to display  
Card view or the Launcher, or to turn on the screen if it is turned off.  
dashboard  
application search  
A list of all your notifications. When one or more notification icons  
appear at the top of the screen, tap the icons to open the dashboard. Tap  
a dashboard item to act on it. See also notification.  
A search feature that is available after you open certain applications. To  
search, simply tap the search field (where available) and begin typing a  
search term—for example, a contact name or phone number, the subject  
text of an email message, or a few words from a memo. See also Just  
Type.  
drag  
A slow movement of your finger on the touchscreen used, for example, to  
scroll slowly through a list or move an icon in the Launcher. See Use  
application update  
An update from the developer of an application you installed through HP  
webOS App Catalog on your device. You can check for application  
updates manually in Software Manager. Additional fees may apply. See  
DRM-free file  
A file that is not protected by Digital Rights Management. DRM-free files  
can be copied as many times as you like and can be played on your  
device.  
card  
A minimized view of an open application. You can easily move among  
and reorder cards in Card view. To reduce the app you’re working in to a  
Exhibition  
A feature of your device that allows you to access apps specially  
designed for use while the device is placed on an HP Touchstone (see  
card, press Center  
(see Center). Tap a card to restore the full-screen  
view of the application and continue working in it. See also Card view. A  
group of related cards appears in Card view as a card stack. See Work  
with stacked cards for information.  
A : Terms 195  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
favorite  
. In the Launcher, tap Apps to see all your core apps, tap Downloads  
to see apps you downloaded, or tap Settings to see all your preference  
apps. Tap, hold, and drag an app icon from any page to add it to your  
Favorites page. Tap an app icon to open the application.  
A contact that you identify as someone you want to be able to quickly  
reach. Creating a favorite from a contact lets you view and touch base  
with that contact in just a few taps. You can create and manage favorites  
in Contacts (see Create a favorite) and in Phone & Video Calls (see Work  
linked contact  
A contact containing information from more than one source. For  
example, if you have a work contact in Exchange and a personal contact  
for the same person in Google, the Contacts application automatically  
recognizes the connection and links the two contacts so you can see all  
the information for a person in the same place—but the information is  
kept separate in the different accounts where it originated. You can also  
manually link and unlink contacts.  
flick  
A fast skimming of your finger vertically on the touchscreen used, for  
example, to scroll quickly up or down. See Use gestures: Tap, swipe,  
HP webOS  
The operating system of your HP TouchPad. Key features of HP webOS  
include gestures, cards, merged views, and linked contacts.  
merged view  
A feature on your device that displays data from several sources in a  
single view, but keeps the sources of your data separate.  
HP webOS Account  
An HP webOS Account gives you access to services like automatic  
updates, backup of your data, and more. You create an HP webOS  
Account by entering a working email address during initial setup of your  
HP TouchPad (see Set up your device). Your HP webOS Account also  
identifies the location on the web where the data you store in your HP  
webOS Account is backed up. (You cannot see or change this data on the  
web, however.)  
Let’s say you use Google calendar for your personal events and your  
company’s Exchange calendar for business events. Your device’s  
Calendar application displays events from both calendars in a single  
view.  
Likewise, if you set up multiple email accounts, the Email application  
displays the messages from all your account inboxes in a single folder,  
called All Inboxes, that can be set up to appear at the top of the Account  
List panel in the Email app (see Set email preferences). And in  
Messaging, all your messages with the same person show up in a single  
conversation, whether they are text or instant messages. See also linked  
You can assign contacts and calendar events to your HP webOS Account.  
HP webOS Account items are included in the daily backup of information  
to your HP webOS Account online but do not synchronize with any of  
your online accounts.  
Just Type  
The feature, formerly known as universal search, that enables you to  
search for applications and contacts on your device, and search the web  
simply by tapping Just type in Card view and typing the search term. You  
can also use Quick Actions to create new items such as email messages,  
calendar events, or memos by entering all or part of the item’s text. See  
notification  
A message that appears at the top of the screen alerting you of an  
incoming email or instant message; an upcoming event; and more. In  
most cases, you can tap a notification to act on it. See also dashboard.  
Throw a notification off the side of the screen to dismiss it.  
online account  
Launcher  
The HP Synergy feature makes it easy to synchronize all data from an  
online account. An online account is a web-based or server-based  
location where you keep contacts and/or calendar information, such as  
Google or Exchange. (Such web-based or server-based accounts are  
A group of screens (called pages) that display all your applications. To  
open the Launcher, tap  
the active application, press Center  
in Quick Launch (see Quick Launch), or from  
to get to Card view, and then tap  
196 A : Terms  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
sometimes talked about as being “in the cloud.”) You can access the info  
in those accounts in the Contacts and Calendar applications on your  
device. You can also set up your device to download contacts from online  
accounts such as Facebook, and to view photos and videos in online  
accounts such as Facebook or Snapfish. See Online accounts available  
technology, change the screen brightness, turn on/off the screen rotation  
lock, and turn system sounds on/off. To open the system menu, drag  
down from the upper-right corner of the device (above the screen) onto the  
screen, or tap the upper-right corner of the screen. See Use the system  
menu for details. See also application menu and airplane mode.  
system update  
pinch  
Updates provided to HP webOS and core applications such as Contacts  
and Calendar. When a system update is available, a notification appears  
on your device. You can also check for system updates manually. See  
A gesture used to zoom in for a magnified view or zoom out to see a  
larger area. To zoom in, you pinch out: Place the thumb and index  
fingertips close together on the touchscreen; then slowly spread them  
apart. To zoom out, you pinch in: Place the thumb and index fingertips  
apart on the touchscreen, and slowly bring them together.  
tap  
A light quick touch on the touchscreen used, for example, to open an app  
by tapping its icon. Use your fingertip to tap. Don’t use your fingernail,  
and don’t use a pen or pencil—the screen does not respond to touches  
like that. Also, don’t bear down. Make the tap firmly, but lightly. See Use  
Quick Launch  
A lineup of up to five icons, plus the Launcher, that give you quick access  
to your favorite applications. By default, Quick Launch displays icons for  
the following apps: Web, Email, Calendar, Messaging, and Photos &  
Videos. The sixth icon is the Launcher. You can easily drag icons onto and  
off of the Quick Launch bar to change the lineup of apps (see Line up your  
Touch to Share  
If you have a web page open on your HP TouchPad or on a webOS  
smartphone, simply touch the devices to transfer the page from one device  
to the other. If your smartphone and your HP TouchPad use the same HP  
webOS Account, you can also touch the two to create a Bluetooth pairing  
between them. Touch to Share works with certain webOS smartphones  
Quick Launch always appears at the bottom of Card view and the  
Launcher. Tap an icon to open the app.  
smart folder  
One of two folders—All Inboxes and All Flagged—that can be set to  
appear at the top of the Account List panel in the Email application. See  
swipe  
A light, fast horizontal skimming of your finger on the touchscreen used,  
for example, to go from page to page in the Launcher or from day to day  
Synergy feature  
The feature that lets you take advantage of merged views and linked  
contacts on your device. See Your HP TouchPad.  
system menu  
A menu hidden in the upper-right corner of the screen that lets you turn  
on/off wireless connection features such as Wi-Fi and Bluetooth® wireless  
A : Terms 197  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
198 A : Terms  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
B Online accounts available for webOS devices  
Table 1. Online accounts available for HP webOS devices*  
Account  
Applications that display Relationship between  
Can I edit and add data Can I edit and add data What happens when I  
data from this account  
device and online  
account**  
to this account on my  
device?  
to this account on the  
web?  
delete this account from  
one app?***  
AIM  
Messaging  
Sync  
Yes  
Yes  
The account is removed  
from all apps  
Box.net  
Adobe Reader,  
Quickoffice  
Adobe Reader: Transfer  
(from web to device)  
Adobe Reader: Delete  
files on device  
Yes  
The account is removed  
from all apps  
Quickoffice: Transfer  
(from web to device)  
Quickoffice: Delete files  
on device  
Dropbox  
Adobe Reader,  
Quickoffice  
Adobe Reader: Transfer  
(from web to device)  
Adobe Reader: Delete  
files on device  
Yes  
The account is removed  
from all apps  
Quickoffice: Transfer  
(from web to device)  
Quickoffice: Delete files  
on device  
Exchange  
Facebook  
Contacts, Calendar,  
Email  
Sync  
Yes  
Yes****  
Only info in that app is  
deleted; info remains in  
other apps  
Contacts, Calendar,  
Photos & Videos  
Contacts, Calendar:  
Transfer (from web to  
device)  
No  
Contacts and Calendar  
only  
Only info in that app is  
deleted; info remains in  
other apps  
Photos & Videos: Transfer  
(from web to device)  
Google  
Contacts, Calendar,  
Messaging, Email,  
Quickoffice, Adobe  
Reader  
Sync  
Yes  
Yes  
Only info in that app is  
deleted; info remains in  
other apps  
B : Online accounts available for webOS devices 199  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Table 1. Online accounts available for HP webOS devices*  
Account  
Applications that display Relationship between  
Can I edit and add data Can I edit and add data What happens when I  
data from this account  
device and online  
account**  
to this account on my  
device?  
to this account on the  
web?  
delete this account from  
one app?***  
HP webOS  
Account  
Contacts, Calendar,  
Memos; see Backup for  
full list of affected info  
See Backup for details  
Yes  
No  
See Backup for details  
LinkedIn  
Photobucket  
Skype  
Contacts  
Transfer (from web to  
device)  
No  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Only info in Contacts is  
deleted  
Photos & Videos  
Contacts, Messaging  
Transfer (from web to  
device)  
Only info in Photos &  
Videos is deleted  
Contacts: Transfer (from  
web to device)  
Contacts: No  
Messaging: Yes  
Contacts: Yes  
Messaging: Yes  
The account is removed  
from all apps  
Messaging: Sync  
Snapfish  
Yahoo!  
Photos & Videos  
Transfer (from web to  
device)  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Only info in Photos &  
Videos is deleted  
Contacts, Calendar,  
Messaging, Email  
Contacts: Transfer (from  
web to device)  
Calendar: Sync  
Contacts: No  
Calendar: Yes  
Only info in that app is  
deleted; info remains in  
other apps  
The frequency with which data is synced or transferred between the device and online accounts depends on the account you are using. For information about  
account sync intervals, go to kb.hpwebos.com and search for article number 47817.  
*The information contained in this table is subject to change with webOS updates.  
**Sync: A two-way exchange and update of your data. What you add or change in one location is automatically added or changed in the other.  
Transfer: A one-way update of your data. You can add or change data only in one location; the data is then copied to the other location.  
***Only the data on your device is deleted. The data source is not affected. If you delete an account from your device using the Accounts app, all data from that  
account is removed from all apps associated with the account.  
****You can also edit and add data to an Exchange account from a desktop application, such as Outlook.  
200 B : Online accounts available for webOS devices  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
C Specifications  
Table 1. Specifications  
Category  
Description  
Processor technologies  
Battery  
Qualcomm Snapdragon dual-CPU APQ8060  
Rechargeable lithium-polymer (nonremovable)  
6300 mA/hr power capacity typical  
Operating system  
HP webOS 3.0  
Camera  
Front-facing 1.3-megapixel webcam  
9.45 in. x 7.48 in. x 0.54 in. (240 mm x 190 mm x 13.7 mm)  
1.6 pounds (740 grams)  
Size  
Weight  
Operating temperature range  
32°F to 104°F (0°C to 40°C)  
10% to 90% RH  
Connectivity  
Display  
Wi-Fi 802.11 a/b/g/n with WPA, WPA2, WEP, 802.1x authentication  
Bluetooth® wireless technology 2.1 + EDR with A2DP (stereo Bluetooth) support  
9.7 inch (246.38 mm) XGA capacitive, multitouch screen with IPS (In-Plane Switching)  
18-bit color  
Resolution: 1024 x 768  
User-adjustable brightness  
Keyboard  
Sensors  
Virtual  
Ambient light  
Accelerometer  
Compass (magnetometer)  
Gyroscope  
C : Specifications 201  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Table 1. Specifications  
Category  
Memory  
Description  
16GB or 32GB*  
USB mass storage support  
1GB RAM  
Connector  
microUSB connector with USB 2.0 Hi-Speed  
Speakers  
Internal stereo speakers with Beats AudioTM  
Back cover (nonremovable)  
Compatible with the HP Touchstone for TouchPad charging dock (sold separately)  
Included HP webOS applications Calendar  
(at time of purchase)  
Contacts  
Email  
HP webOS App Catalog  
Memos  
Messaging  
Music  
Phone & Video Calls  
Photos & Videos  
VPN  
Web  
202 C : Specifications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table 1. Specifications  
Category  
Description  
Included configuration and  
preference applications (at time of  
purchase)  
Accounts  
Backup  
Bluetooth  
Date & Time  
Device Info  
Exhibition  
Help  
Just Type  
Location Services  
Print Manager  
Regional Settings  
Screen & Lock  
Software Manager  
Sounds & Ringtones  
System Updates  
Text Assist  
Wi-Fi  
Included third-party applications  
(at time of purchase)  
Adobe Reader  
Maps  
Quickoffice (DOC, DOCX, XLS, XLSX, PPT, PPTX)  
* To find out how much memory your device has: Open Device Info  
and look at the Memory field under Device.  
C : Specifications 203  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
204 C : Specifications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D Important safety and legal information  
Software Update shall be deemed Software under this Agreement, and all the same terms  
END USER LICENSE AGREEMENT  
and conditions shall apply as they would to any Software under this Agreement.  
Occasionally, you may also be asked if you would like to accept a Paid Software Update,  
which may provide additional functionality. These updates will not be mandatory and you  
will always be asked for your consent. Upon your consent and installation of any Paid  
Software Update, the update shall be deemed Software under this Agreement, and all the  
same terms and conditions shall apply as they would to any Software under this Agreement.  
CAREFULLY READ THE FOLLOWING TERMS AND CONDITIONS (“AGREEMENT”) BEFORE  
USING, DOWNLOADING OR OTHERWISE ACCESSING THE SOFTWARE OR SERVICES  
PROVIDED ON OR THROUGH YOUR HEWLETT-PACKARD COMPANY (“HP”) DEVICE. THE  
SOFTWARE AND SERVICES PROVIDED ON OR THROUGH YOUR HP DEVICE ARE  
LICENSED BY HP TO YOU, THE ORIGINAL END USER, SOLELY FOR YOUR PERSONAL USE  
THIS AGREEMENT, DO NOT USE, DOWNLOAD OR OTHERWISE ACCESS THE  
SOFTWARE OR SERVICES. USING, DOWNLOADING, OR OTHERWISE ACCESSING ANY  
PART OF THE SOFTWARE OR SERVICES INDICATES THAT YOU ACCEPT THESE TERMS.  
RESTRICTIONS: The Software is licensed for use only on the single HP device you originally  
purchased, and you may not distribute or make the Software available over a network or for  
use with multiple devices. The Software and supporting documentation may be copied only  
as necessary for backup or archive purposes in support of your use of the Software. You  
must reproduce and include all copyright notices and any other proprietary rights notices  
appearing on the Software on any copies that you make. You may not modify or alter the  
Software in any way, and may only use the Software as expressly set forth above. You agree  
that you will not attempt to, or assist or encourage any other person or entity to circumvent,  
disable or modify any security technology or software that is part of the Software or is used  
on your HP device. Except as set forth above, HP and its licensors reserve all other rights in  
or to the Software. If applicable law permits you to copy or modify the Software, then you  
may copy and modify the Software solely to the extent, and for such purposes as, expressly  
permitted by applicable law. For further information on the circumstances in which such  
copying and modification may be permissible, please contact your local authority, trading  
standards department, citizens’ advice bureau or local equivalent.  
PLEASE NOTE THAT IF YOU ARE A CONSUMER IN THE EUROPEAN ECONOMIC AREA,  
SWITZERLAND or AUSTRALIA, THIS AGREEMENT DOES NOT AFFECT YOUR STATUTORY  
RIGHTS. For further information about your statutory rights contact your local authority,  
Trading Standards Department or Citizens Advice Bureau (OR LOCAL EQUIVALENT).  
LICENSE: HP grants you a limited, nonexclusive license to use HP proprietary software  
program(s) and services found on your HP device and/or packaged with, provided with, or  
made accessible through your HP device, or provided by HP for use with your HP device,  
including any updates to such software provided to you through any means, including but  
not limited to downloads or over-the-air updates (the “Software”), subject to the terms and  
conditions set forth in this Agreement, as well as any other terms that may be incorporated  
by reference herein or otherwise presented to you prior to your use of the Software. You are  
not permitted to use the Software in any manner not expressly authorized by this Agreement.  
You acknowledge and agree that ownership of the Software, end user documentation and  
all subsequent copies thereof, regardless of the form or media, is retained by HP or its  
suppliers, and are protected by law, including but not limited to United States copyright,  
trade secret, and trademark law, as well as other applicable laws and international treaty  
provisions. You shall not remove any product identification, copyright notices or proprietary  
restrictions from the Software or any end user documentation.  
HP HAS THE RIGHT TO MODIFY, CHANGE OR TERMINATE YOUR USE OF ANY SOFTWARE  
OR APPLICATIONS FOUND ON OR USED THROUGH THE DEVICE: HP reserves the right, at its  
sole discretion and at any time, to add, remove, or modify any Software, and to add,  
remove or modify any applications found on the device or services accessed through the  
device. HP may be required to take these actions due to changes in the obligations or  
restrictions from its third party licensors or partners, or due to safety or security concerns or  
any governmental restriction or court order.  
HP HAS THE RIGHT TO MODIFY THESE TERMS: HP reserves the right to modify the terms of  
this Agreement at its sole discretion at any time to the maximum extent permitted by  
applicable law. Any such modification will be effective upon HP’s sending notice to you by  
email, text message, or postal mail. Your continued use of the Software after such notice will  
constitute your binding acceptance of the Agreement as revised. Additionally, some  
Software may be subject to different or additional terms (including fees) presented to you  
through a separate click-through or other type of agreement or notice prior to your use of  
such Software.  
SOFTWARE UPDATES: From time to time, you may receive Software updates for your HP  
device through either tangible media, download or over the air (a “Software Update”). Such  
Software Updates either will be mandatory and free of additional charge (“Mandatory  
Software Update”) or may require an additional fee (“Paid Software Update”). Mandatory  
Software Updates will provide patches or error corrections or enable new functionality for  
your HP device. In many cases, Mandatory Software Updates will be pushed to you during  
periods of decreased usage, e.g., at night or early morning. You hereby acknowledge and  
agree that such Mandatory Software Updates may be installed on your HP device without  
any further notification to you or consent from you. Upon installation, the Mandatory  
D : Important safety and legal information 205  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
THIRD PARTY SOFTWARE AND SERVICES: Some of the software or services which may be  
packaged with, provided with, or made accessible through your HP device, may be  
provided by third parties (the “Third Party Software”) and may be subject to different or  
additional terms and conditions of use. Third Party Software may also be available from  
application stores which can be accessed from your device. Third Party Software is not  
provided by HP, and the terms and conditions of use for Third Party Software may be  
presented to you through click-through or another type of agreement prior to your use of the  
Third Party Software. Third Party Software may contain ads, and you acknowledge that such  
ads are not provided by HP or its distribution partners. Additionally, you should be aware  
that such Third Party Software may implement third party technologies in accordance with  
one or more industry standards (“Standards-Based Software”). Such Standards- Based  
Software may require licenses from one or more third party entities. Such licenses are not  
provided by HP and you should contact the provider of such Third Party Software for more  
information on how to obtain such licenses. You solely are responsible for obtaining any  
such licenses.  
HP may require an administrative fee to provide physical copies of such Open Source  
Software. This offer is valid for a period of three (3) years from the date of your acceptance  
of this Agreement.  
CONSENT TO USE OF DATA: You agree that HP, its affiliates and designated agent may  
collect and use technical and related information, gathered in any manner, as part of  
product support services related to the Software. HP, its affiliates and designated agent may  
use this information solely to improve its products or to provide customized services or  
technologies to you. HP will collect and use this information in accordance with its privacy  
policy and in accordance with applicable data protection laws. Palm, its affiliates and  
designated agent may disclose this information to others, but not in a form that personally  
identifies you.  
ASSIGNMENT: You may transfer the Software to another party together with the transfer of  
any device, if such party accepts the terms and conditions of this Agreement. If you transfer  
the Software, you must at the same time either transfer all copies of the Software as well as  
the supporting documentation to the same party or destroy any such materials not  
transferred. Upon transfer of the Software, your license is automatically terminated.  
USE OF THIRD PARTY WEB SITES AND SERVICES: The HP device will enable you to access  
data and information from your new or existing third party websites and service provider  
accounts, such as email, social networking, and product purchasing accounts. Some of  
these services or accounts may be made available to you through an application on the HP  
device, without having to use the browser. You acknowledge and agree that by entering  
your user name and password or account information to access such accounts, you agree to  
abide by the terms and conditions under which such services are made available to you by  
the third party providing such services. If you do not agree to the terms under which such  
services are made available to you by such third parties, you should not access such  
accounts or services through your HP device.  
REVERSE ENGINEERING: You may not reverse engineer, decompile, or disassemble the  
Software, except and only to the extent that such activity is mandated under applicable law.  
WARRANTY AND DISCLAIMERS: IF SOFTWARE IS BEING PROVIDED TO YOU IN  
CONNECTION WITH A HP DEVICE WHICH YOU HAVE NEWLY PURCHASED FROM HP OR ITS  
AUTHORIZED DISTRIBUTORS, THE SOFTWARE MAY BE UNDER A WARRANTY, AS PROVIDED  
ON A LIMITED WARRANTY CARD PROVIDED WITH YOUR NEW DEVICE. SOME STATES/  
JURISDICTIONS DO NOT ALLOW EXCLUSION OF IMPLIED WARRANTIES OR  
DIGITAL CERTIFICATES: The Software contains functionality that allows it to accept digital  
certificates issued from HP or third parties. YOU ARE SOLELY RESPONSIBLE FOR DECIDING  
WHETHER TO RELY ON A CERTIFICATE ISSUED BY HP OR ANY THIRD PARTY. YOUR USE  
OF DIGITAL CERTIFICATES IS AT YOUR SOLE RISK AND, TO THE MAXIMUM EXTENT  
PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, HP EXCLUDES ALL IMPLIED OR STATUTORY TERMS,  
CONDITIONS OR WARRANTIES INCLUDING THOSE AS TO MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS  
FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, ACCURACY, SECURITY, OR RELIABILITY OF SUCH DIGITAL  
CERTIFICATES.  
LIMITATIONS ON THE DURATION OF IMPLIED WARRANTIES, SO THE ABOVE  
DISCLAIMER MAY NOT APPLY TO YOU IN ITS ENTIRETY. ADDITIONALLY, PLEASE NOTE  
THAT IF YOU ARE DEALING AS A CONSUMER IN THE EUROPEAN ECONOMIC AREA  
OR SWITZERLAND, SUCH LIMITED WARRANTY DOES NOT AFFECT YOUR STATUTORY  
RIGHTS. FOR FURTHER INFORMATION ABOUT YOUR STATUTORY RIGHTS, PLEASE  
CONTACT YOUR LOCAL AUTHORITY, TRADING STANDARDS DEPARTMENT, CITIZENS’  
ADVICE BUREAU OR LOCAL EQUIVALENT. EXCEPT AS MAY BE PROVIDED UNDER SUCH  
A WARRANTY FOR NEWLY PURCHASED DEVICES, AND TO THE MAXIMUM EXTENT  
PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, YOU EXPRESSLY ACKNOWLEDGE AND AGREE THAT  
USE OF THE SOFTWARE IS AT YOUR SOLE RISK AND THAT THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED  
TO YOU ON AN “AS IS” AND “AS AVAILABLE” BASIS AND WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY  
OF ANY KIND OR NATURE. HP DOES NOT WARRANT THAT USE OF THE SOFTWARE  
WILL BE UNINTERRUPTED, FAULT-TOLERANT OR ERROR FREE. TO THE MAXIMUM EXTENT  
PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, HP AND ITS SUPPLIERS EXPRESSLY 5 DISCLAIM ANY  
IMPLIED OR STATUTORY TERMS, CONDITIONS OR WARRANTIES, INCLUDING  
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, TITLE,  
ACCURACY, CORRESPONDENCE WITH DESCRIPTION, SATISFACTORY QUALITY AND  
NON-INFRINGEMENT. HP MAKES NO WARRANTY, TERM OR CONDITION OF ANY  
KIND, WHETHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, WITH REGARD TO ANY THIRD PARTY SOFTWARE  
OR OPEN SOURCE SOFTWARE. ALL THIRD PARTY SOFTWARE AND OPEN SOURCE  
SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED AS-IS,” WITHOUT WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND BY HP.  
OPEN SOURCE SOFTWARE: This device includes certain open source software (“Open  
Source Software”), which are licensed to you subject to the GNU General Public License  
(“GPL”), GNU Library/Lesser General Public License (“LGPL”) and/or other licenses,  
disclaimers and notices (“Open Source License Terms”). The applicable Open Source  
License Terms for the corresponding Open Source Software are reproduced and can be  
viewed on your device and are also available at http://opensource.palm.com. Please refer  
to the Open Source License Terms regarding your rights under such licenses to the Open  
terms and conditions of the corresponding Open Source License Terms. Questions regarding  
Open Source Software included or incorporated in the Software can be directed to  
opensourcequestions@palm.com. Source code for certain of the Open Source Software is  
available at http://opensource.palm.com. You may obtain a machine-readable copy of that  
source code by written request to HP’s subsidiary, Palm, Inc. at:  
LIMITATION OF LIABILITY: NOTHING IN THIS LIMITATION OF LIABILITY LIMITS OR  
EXCLUDES HP’S OR ITS SUPPLIERS’ LIABILITY FOR DEATH OR PERSONAL INJURY CAUSED  
BY NEGLIGENCE, FOR REPRESENTATIONS MADE FRAUDULENTLY, OR FOR ANY OTHER  
LIABILITY WHICH CANNOT BE LIMITED OR EXCLUDED BY APPLICABLE LAW. TO THE  
MAXIMUM EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, NEITHER HPNOR ITS SUPPLIERS  
Palm, Inc.  
Attention: Open Source Compliance  
950 W. Maude Ave  
Sunnyvale, CA 94085 USA  
206 D : Important safety and legal information  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SHALL BE LIABLE FOR INCIDENTAL, CONSEQUENTIAL, INDIRECT, SPECIAL, OR PUNITIVE  
DAMAGES OF ANY KIND, LOSS OF INFORMATION OR DATA, LOSS OF REVENUE, LOSS  
OF BUSINESS OR OTHER FINANCIAL LOSS ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION  
WITH THE LICENSE OR USE OF THE SOFTWARE, WHETHER BASED IN CONTRACT, TORT  
(INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE), STRICT PRODUCT LIABILITY OR ANY OTHER THEORY, EVEN  
IF HP HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES AND EVEN IF ANY  
LIMITED REMEDY IS DEEMED TO HAVE FAILED OF ITS ESSENTIAL PURPOSE. HP’S ENTIRE  
LIABILITY SHALL BE LIMITED TO REPLACEMENT, REPAIR, OR REFUND OF THE PURCHASE  
PRICE PAID, AT HP’S OPTION. IN NO EVENT WILL HPBE LIABLE TO YOU OR ANY THIRD  
PARTY FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, PUNITIVE, EXEMPLARY, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, OR  
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE THIRD PARTY SOFTWARE OR OPEN  
SOURCE SOFTWARE, EVEN IF HP HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH  
DAMAGES OR LOSSES. Some countries, states, or provinces do not allow the exclusion or  
limitation of implied warranties or the limitation of incidental or consequential damages so  
the above limitations and exclusions may be limited in their application to you.  
SEVERABILITY: In the event any provision of this Agreement is found to be invalid, illegal or  
unenforceable, the validity, legality and enforceability of any of the remaining provisions  
shall not in any way be affected or impaired.  
ENTIRE AGREEMENT: By accepting this Agreement and the accompanying Limited Warranty  
(if any), you agree that the Agreement and Limited Warranty set forth the entire agreement  
between you and HP, and supersede all prior agreements, whether written or oral, with  
respect to the Software, notwithstanding the terms or conditions of any such prior  
agreements. Nothing in this Agreement limits or excludes liability for representations made  
fraudulently.  
This document includes Regulatory, health and safety Compliance and environmental  
statements required to be used in Regulatory booklet or user guide.  
Regulatory notices  
EXPORT RESTRICTIONS: You shall comply with all laws and regulations of the United States,  
European Union and other countries (“Export Laws”) to assure that the Software Product is  
not (1) exported, directly or indirectly, in violation of Export Laws, or (2) used for any  
purpose prohibited by Export Laws, including, without limitation, nuclear, chemical, or  
biological weapons proliferation.  
This section contains the legal notices required by the regulatory bodies of your country.  
United States  
Federal Communications Commission Notice  
TERM AND TERMINATION: This Agreement is effective until terminated. You may terminate it  
at any time by destroying the Software and documentation together with all copies and  
merged portions in any form. It will also terminate immediately if you commit a material  
breach of this Agreement. Upon such termination you agree to destroy the Software and  
documentation, together with all copies. Some countries, states, or provinces do not allow  
the termination of this type of Agreement, so the above provision may be limited in its  
application to you.  
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital  
device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide  
reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential installation. This  
equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and  
used in accordance with the instructions may cause harmful interference to radio  
communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a  
particular installation.  
SPECIAL RIGHTS FOR THE LICENSE OR USE BY THE U.S. GOVERNMENT: If this Software is  
being used by or licensed to the United States Government, the following shall apply: The  
Software licensed under this Agreement is “commercial computer software” as the term is  
described in 48 C.F.R. 252.227- 7014(a)(1). If acquired by or on behalf of a civilian agency,  
the U.S. Government acquires this commercial computer software and/or commercial  
computer software documentation subject to the terms of this Agreement as specified in 48  
C.F.R. 12.212 (Computer Software) and 48 C.F.R. 12.211 (Technical Data) of the Federal  
Acquisition Regulations (“FAR”) and its successors. If acquired by or on behalf of any  
agency within the Department of Defense (“DOD”), the U.S. Government acquires this  
commercial computer software and/ or commercial computer software documentation  
subject to the terms of this Agreement as specified in 48 C.F.R. 227.7202-3 of the DOD FAR  
Supplement (“DFAR”) and its successors.  
If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can  
be determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct  
the interference by one or more of the following measures:  
• Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna  
• Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver  
• Connect the equipment to an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is  
connected  
• Consult the dealer or an experienced radio or television technician for help  
Modifications  
GOVERNING LAW: This Agreement shall be governed by the laws of the State of California  
and by the federal laws of the United States, excluding their conflicts of laws provisions. The  
United Nations Convention on Contracts for the International Sale of Goods (1980) is hereby  
excluded in its entirety from application to this Agreement. If you acquired this Software or  
the HP device in the European Economic Area or Switzerland, this Agreement shall be  
governed by the law of the country in which you purchased the Software or the HP device.  
The FCC requires the user to be notified that any changes or modifications made to this  
device that are not expressly approved by HP may void the user’s authority to operate the  
equipment. The FCC has granted an Equipment Authorization for this model device with all  
reported SAR levels evaluated as in compliance with the FCC RF exposure guidelines. SAR  
information on this model is on file with the FCC and can be found under the Display Grant  
section of http://www.fcc.gov/oet/ea/fccid/ after searching for FCC ID B94HHI29C.  
CAPACITY AND AUTHORITY TO CONTRACT: You represent that you are of legal age of  
majority in your state of residence and, if applicable, you are duly authorized by your  
employer to enter into this Agreement.  
D : Important safety and legal information 207  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Declaration of Conformity for Products Marked with the FCC Logo (United States Only)  
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two  
conditions:  
L ‘utilisation de ce dispositif est autorisée seulement aux conditions suivantes : (1) il ne doit  
pas produire de brouillage et (2) l’ utilisateur du dispositif doit étre prêt à accepter tout  
brouillage radioélectrique reçu, même si ce brouillage est susceptible de compromettre le  
fonctionnement du dispositif.  
1 This device may not cause harmful interference.  
2 This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause  
undesired operation.  
Canadian Notice/Avis Canadien  
This Class B digital apparatus meets all requirements of the Canadian Interference-Causing  
Equipment Regulations.  
If you have questions about the product or this FCC declaration, write to:  
Hewlett-Packard Company, 950 W. Maude Ave, Sunnyvale, CA 94085  
Cet appareil numérique de la classe B respecte toutes les exigences du Règlement sur le  
matériel brouilleur du Canada.  
European Union Notice  
Products bearing the CE marking comply with the following EU Directives:  
For questions regarding this FCC declaration, call HP at 1-281-514-3333. For general  
questions about the product, call 1-800-HP-INVENT (1-800-474-6836).  
• Low Voltage Directive 2006/95/EC  
• EMC Directive 2004/108/EC  
To identify your product, refer to the part, series, or model number located on the product.  
Cables  
To maintain compliance with FCC Rules and Regulations, connections to this device must be  
made with shielded cables having metallic RFI/EMI connector hoods.  
CE compliance of this product is valid only if powered with the correct CE-marked AC  
adapter provided by HP.  
WARNING! Exposure to Radio Frequency (RF) Radiation The radiated output power  
of this device is below the FCC radio frequency exposure limits. Nevertheless, the  
device should be used in such a manner that the potential for human contact during  
normal operation is minimized.  
If this product has telecommunications functionality, it also complies with the essential  
requirements of the following EU Directive:  
• R&TTE Directive 1999/5/EC  
Compliance with these directives implies conformity to harmonized European standards  
(European Norms) that are listed in the EU Declaration of Conformity issued by HP for this  
product or product family. This compliance is indicated by one of the following conformity  
markings placed on the product.  
The exposure standard for wireless devices employs a unit of measurement known as the  
Specific Absorption Rate, or SAR. The SAR limit set by the FCC is 1.6 W/Kg. Tests for SAR  
are conducted using standard operating positions accepted by the FCC with the device  
transmitting at its highest certified power level in all tested frequency bands. Although the  
SAR is determined at the highest certified power level, the actual SAR level of the device  
while operating can be well below the maximum value. This is because the device is  
designed to operate at multiple power levels so as to use only the power required to reach  
the network. In general, the closer you are to a wireless base station antenna, the lower the  
power output. To avoid the possibility of exceeding the FCC radio frequency exposure limits,  
human proximity to the antenna should be minimized. This device has been tested and  
demonstrated compliance when Bluetooth and WiFi are transmitting simultaneously. The  
highest FCC SAR value for this device when tested for use at the body is 1.29 W/kg. This  
device must not be co-located or operating in conjunction with any other antenna or  
transmitter.  
• This CE marking is valid for non-telecommunications products and for EU harmonized  
telecommunications products, such as Bluetooth®.  
• This CE marking is valid for EU non-harmonized telecommunications products.  
Battery replacement (for product with non removable battery)  
Do not attempt to replace the rechargeable battery, the battery may only be replaced by HP  
Authorized Service Provider.  
*If applicable, a notified body number is used. Refer to the regulatory label provided on this  
product.  
Hewlett-Packard GmbH, HQ-TRE, Herrenberger Strasse 140, D-71034 Böblingen, Germany  
Canada  
The telecommunications functionality of this product may be used in the following EU and  
EFTA countries:  
Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause  
interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference, including interference that  
may cause undesired operation of the device.  
Austria, Belgium, Bulgaria, Cyprus, Czech Republic, Denmark, Estonia, Finland, France,  
Germany, Greece, Hungary, Iceland, Ireland, Italy, Latvia, Liechtenstein, Lithuania,  
208 D : Important safety and legal information  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Luxembourg, Malta, Netherlands, Norway, Poland, Portugal, Romania, Slovak Republic,  
Slovenia, Spain, Sweden, Switzerland, and United Kingdom.  
Italy  
E’ necessaria una concessione ministeriale anche per l’uso del prodotto. Verifici per favore  
con il proprio distributore o direttamente presso la Direzione Generale Pianificazione e  
Gestione Frequenze.  
The official EU CE declaration of conformity for this device may be found at  
Health and Safety  
EU SAR Notice  
To reduce the risk of bodily injury, electric shock, fire, and damage to the equipment,  
observe the safety precautions in this document.  
THIS DEVICE MEETS INTERNATIONAL GUIDELINES FOR EXPOSURE TO RADIO WAVES.  
Your device is a radio transmitter and receiver. It is designed and manufactured not to  
exceed the limits for exposure to radio frequency (RF) recommended by international  
guidelines (ICNIRP). These limits are part of comprehensive guidelines and establish  
permitted levels of RF energy for the general population. The guidelines were developed by  
independent scientific organizations through periodic and thorough evaluation of scientific  
studies. The guidelines include a substantial safety margin designed to assure the safety of  
all persons, regardless of age and health.  
Acoustics Warning  
WARNING! Listening to this device at high volume levels and for extended  
durations may damage your hearing. In order to reduce the risk of damage to  
hearing, you should lower the volume to a safe, comfortable level, and reduce the  
amount of time listening at high levels.  
The exposure standard for devices employs a unit of measurement known as the Specific  
Absorption Rate, or SAR. The SAR limit stated in the international guidelines is 2.0 W/kg*.  
Tests for SAR are conducted using standard operating positions with the device transmitting  
at its highest certified power level in all tested frequency bands. Although the SAR is  
determined at the highest certified power level, the actual SAR of the device while operating  
can be well below the maximum value. This is because the device is designed to operate at  
multiple power levels so as to use only the power required to reach the network. In general,  
the closer you are to a base station, the lower the power output of the device. Before a  
device is available for sale to the public, compliance with the European R&TTE directive must  
be shown. This directive includes as one essential requirement the protection of the health  
and the safety for the user and any other person. The highest EU SAR value for this device  
when tested for use at the body is 0.434 W/kg.  
• For your own safety, before using headsets or earphones, always reset he volume. Some  
headphones are louder than other headphones, even if the volume control setting is the  
same.  
• Changing the default audio or equalizer settings might lead to higher volume and should  
only be done with caution.  
• HP recommends using the headset delivered with your device or offered through HP as  
aftermarket options that are in compliance with EN 50332-1 and EN 50332-2.  
General Safety Precautions  
*The EU SAR limit for mobile devices used by the public is 2.0 W/kg averaged over ten  
grams of body tissue. The guidelines incorporate a substantial margin of safety to give  
additional protection for the public and to account for any variations in measurements. SAR  
values may vary depending on national reporting requirements and the network band.  
IMPORTANT INFORMATION ON SAFE AND EFFICIENT OPERATION. Read this  
information before using your device. For the safe and efficient operation of your device,  
observe these guidelines:  
Potentially explosive atmospheres: Turn off your device when you are in any areas with a  
potentially explosive atmosphere, such as fuelling areas (gas or petrol stations, below deck  
on boats), storage facilities for fuel or chemicals, blasting areas and areas near electrical  
blasting caps, and areas where there are chemicals or particles (such as metal powders,  
grains and dust) in the air.  
Wireless Notices  
In some environments, the use of wireless devices may be restricted. Such restrictions may  
apply on board airplanes, in hospitals, near explosives, in hazardous locations, etc. If you  
are uncertain of the policy that applies to the use of this device, please ask for authorization  
to use it prior to turning on the device.  
Interference to personal medical equipment: If you use personal medical equipment, consult  
the equipment manufacture to determine if it is shielded from RF signals emission from your  
device.  
Airline Travel Notice  
Use of electronic equipment aboard commercial aircraft is at the discretion of the airline  
Audio safety: This device is capable of producing loud noises which may damage your  
hearing. playing music, at high volume settings for long durations may lead to permanent  
noise-induced hearing loss. When using the speakerphone feature, it is recommended that  
you place your device at a safe distance from your ear. Other medical devices, hospitals: If  
you use any other personal medical device, consult the manufacturer of your device to  
determine if it is adequately shielded from external RF energy. Your doctor may be able to  
assist you in obtaining this information. Turn your device OFF in health care facilities when  
any regulations posted in these areas instruct you to do so.  
France  
L’utilisation de cet équipement (2,4 GHz Wireless LAN) est soumise a certaines restrictions :  
Cet équipement peut être utilisé à l’intérieur d’un bâtiment en utilisant toutes les fréquences  
de 2400 à 2483,5 MHz (Chaîne 1-13). Pour une utilisation en environnement extérieur, les  
fréquences comprises entre 2400-2454 MHz (Chaîne 1-9) peuvent être utilisées. Pour les  
dernières restrictions, voir http://www.arcep.fr.  
D : Important safety and legal information 209  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Hospitals or health care facilities may be using equipment that could be sensitive to external  
RF energy.  
Only qualified personnel must service or repair the device or its accessories. If your device  
or an accessory has been submerged in water, punctured or subjected to a severe fall, do  
not use it until you have taken it to be checked at an authorized service centre.  
Repetitive motion injuries: When using the keyboard or playing games on your device, you  
may experience discomfort in your neck, shoulders, hands, arms or other parts of the body.  
ESD Safety: Electrostatic discharge (ESD) can cause damage to electronic devices if  
discharged into the device, so you should take steps to avoid such an occurrence. Make sure  
you discharge any built-up static electricity from yourself and your electronic devices before  
touching an electronic device or connecting one device to another.  
To avoid injuries such as tendonitis, carpal tunnel syndrome and other musculoskeletal  
disorders,  
To minimise the risk of Repetitive Motion Injuries, when texting or playing games with your  
device make sure to take lots of breaks to stretch and relax.  
Specific Safety Precautions  
The following safety precautions need to be taken while using your device.  
Operating machinery: Do not use your device while operating machinery. Full attention must  
be given to operating the machinery in order to reduce the risk of an accident.  
Power Cords and Accessories  
WARNING! To reduce the risk of electric shock, fire, or damage to the equipment,  
do not attempt to power the product with a voltage converter kit sold for  
appliances. Use the correct external power source: A product should be operated  
only from the type of power source indicated on the electrical ratings label. If you are not  
sure of the type of power source required, call Customer Care, your service partner, or local  
power company. For a product that operates from battery power or other sources, refer to  
the operating instructions that are included with the product.  
Vehicles with air bags: Air bags will inflate with great force and care should be taken to  
protect yourself and your device within a vehicle that has air bags. Do not place the device  
or any of its accessories in the area over the air bag or in the air bag deployment area.  
Driving–Do not use the device while driving.  
Hearing aids: People with hearing aids or cochlear implants may experience interference  
when using wireless devices or when one is nearby. The level of interference will depend on  
the type of hearing device and the distance from the interference source. Increasing the  
separation between them may reduce the interference. You may also consult your hearing  
aid manufacturer to discuss alternatives.  
Avoid overloading the electrical circuit: Do not overload an electrical outlet, power strip, or  
convenience receptacle. The overall system load must not exceed 80% of the branch circuit  
rating.  
If power strips are used, the load should not exceed 80% of the input rating of the power  
strip.  
Small children: Do not leave your device and its accessories within the reach of small  
children or allow them to play with it. They could hurt themselves or others, or could  
accidentally damage the device. Your device contains small parts that may cause an injury  
or that could become detached and create a choking hazard. Keep the device away from  
the abdomens of pregnant women and adolescents, particularly when using the device  
Use an approved AC adapter: Only the AC adapter provided with the product, a  
replacement AC adapter provided by HP, or an AC adapter purchased as an accessory  
from HP should be used with the product.  
hands-free. To reduce exposure to radiation, use your device in good reception areas.  
Unplug the power properly: Disconnect power from the product by unplugging the power  
cord from the electrical outlet. Do not pull on cords and cables. When unplugging the cord  
from an electrical outlet, grasp and pull the cord by the plug.  
General statement on handling and use:  
• Always treat your device and its accessories with care and keep it in a clean and dust-free  
place.  
Battery notices  
• Do not expose your device or its accessories to any heat source or any product that  
produce heat.  
WARNING! The device contains a rechargeable lithium battery which can only be  
replaced by HP authorized service personal. To reduce the risk of fire or burns, do  
not disassemble the unit.  
• Do not expose your device or its accessories to liquid, moisture or high humidity.  
• Do not drop your device or its accessories.  
Handle battery packs carefully: The device contains a rechargeable lithium battery which  
can only be replaced by HP authorized service personal.  
• Do not use harsh chemicals, cleaning solvents or aerosols to clean the device or its  
accessories.  
When a battery pack has reached the end of its useful life, do not dispose of the  
battery pack in general household waste. Follow the local laws and regulations in  
your area for battery pack disposal. In Europe, dispose of or recycle the battery  
packs by using the public collection system or by returning them to HP, your service  
partner, or their agents.  
• Do not paint your device or its accessories.  
Device heating: Your device may become warm during charging and during normal use.  
Faulty and damaged products: Do not attempt to disassemble the device or its accessories.  
210 D : Important safety and legal information  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Equipment Warning  
This HP product is designed to comply with the Waste Electrical and Electronic Equipment  
(WEEE) Directive—2002/96/EC.  
WARNING! To reduce the risk of personal injury, electrical shock, fire or damage to  
the equipment:  
The EU WEEE directive (2002/95/EC) requires manufacturers to provide treatment  
information for each product type for use by treatment facilities. This information (product  
disassembly instructions) is posted on the Hewlett-Packard website at: http://www.hp.com/  
Plug the AC adapter into an AC outlet that is easily accessible at all times.  
Disconnect power from the equipment by unplugging the AC adapter from the AC outlet or  
unplugging the synchronization cable from the host computer.  
These instructions may be used by recyclers and other WEEE treatment facilities as well as  
HP OEM customers who integrate and re-sell HP equipment.  
Do not use converter kits sold for appliances to power your device.  
Environmental  
This product does not contain any of the following substances in excess of regulatory limits  
(for reference of these limits please refer to the HP General Specification for the Environment  
Environmental and recycling information  
For decades HP has worked to manage its environmental impact by adopting  
environmentally responsible practices in product development, operations, and supply  
chain. The company strives to be a global leader in reducing its carbon footprint, limiting  
waste, and recycling responsibly.  
Asbestos, certain azo colorants, certain brominated flame retardants (may not be used as  
flame retardants in plastics), cadmium, chlorinated hydrocarbons, chlorinated paraffins,  
formaldehyde, halogenated diphenyl methanes, lead carbonates and sulfates, lead and  
lead compounds, mercuric oxide batteries, nickel (finishes must not be used on the external  
surface designed to be frequently handled or carried by the user), ozone depleting  
substances, polybrominated biphenyls (PBBs), polybrominated biphenyl ethers (PBBEs),  
polybrominated biphenyl oxides (PBBOs), polychlorinated biphenyl (PCB), polychlorinated  
terphenyls (PCT), polyvinyl chloride (PVC) (except for wires and cables, and certain retail  
packaging has been voluntarily removed from most applications), radioactive substances,  
tributyl tin (TBT), triphenyl tin (TPT), and tributyl tin oxide (TBTO).  
For more information about HP’s commitment to the environment, refer to the following  
websites:  
• Environmental website: http://www.hp.com/environment  
Owner’s Record  
The Regulatory Model Number (RMN), US FCC ID, Canada IC number and serial number  
are located on the SIM tray. Record the serial number in the space provided below. This will  
be helpful if you need to contact us about your device in the future.  
• Material Substitution and Elimination: http://www.hp.com/hpinfo/globalcitizenship/  
Model: HP TouchPad  
Recycling and Disposal  
Serial No.:  
This symbol means do not dispose of your product with your other household  
waste. Instead, you should protect human health and the environment by handing  
over your waste equipment to designated collection, please contact your  
household waste disposal service.  
HP encourages customers to recycle used electronic hardware, HP original print cartridges,  
and rechargeable batteries. For more information about recycling programs, go to  
Chemical Substances (REACH)  
HP is committed to providing our customers with information about the chemical substances  
in our products as needed to comply with legal requirements such as REACH (Regulation EC  
No 1907/2006 of the European Parliament and the Council). A chemical information report  
for this product can be found at: http://www.hp.com/go/reach  
Hazardous Substances  
This product is in compliance with the Restrictions of Hazardous Substances (RoHS)  
directive—2002/95/EC.  
D : Important safety and legal information 211  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
212 D : Important safety and legal information  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
E Use Adobe search  
Whole Words Only: By default, the search tool returns any words  
that contain your search term, even if the term is part of a longer  
word—for example, searching on app returns application also.  
Select this option if you want search results that match exactly the  
term you enter only.  
Search one instance at a time  
Adobe search provides a convenient tool for finding information in this  
User Guide. You have several options for using the search tool: searching  
for items that match your search term one at a time, or displaying a list of  
all matching items.  
Case Sensitive: By default, the search tool ignores the case of the  
term you enter—so entering email returns both email and Email.  
Select this option if you want search results that match the case of  
the term you enter only.  
The following instructions apply to Adobe Reader 9 and Adobe Acrobat  
9. These instructions are for the full versions of these apps available for  
your computer, not for the Adobe Reader app installed on your HP  
TouchPad. If you have a different version of Adobe Reader or Adobe  
Acrobat, click Help in the application menu bar for instructions on using  
search.  
Include Bookmarks/Include Comments: By default, the search tool  
searches document text only. Select either or both of these options to  
include bookmarks and/or comments in your search results.  
4
5
Press Enter on your keyboard. The search tool highlights the first  
instance of your term.  
TIP To find out what version of Adobe Reader or Adobe Acrobat you have, click  
Help in the application menu bar and look for the option About Adobe Reader x  
or About Acrobat x. The x represents the version number.  
To find the next instance of the term, click  
instance, click  
. To find the previous  
.
To search one item at a time, do the following:  
Display a list of all matching instances  
1
With the User Guide open, click the Find box at the top of the  
screen.  
To see all items that match your search term in a single list, do the  
following:  
2
3
Enter a search term.  
To refine your search, click the arrow to the right of the Find box and  
select any of the following:  
1
With the User Guide open, click the arrow to the right of the Find  
box at the top of the screen.  
E : Use Adobe search 213  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2
Click Open Full Reader Search or Open Full Acrobat Search. A  
separate search window opens  
3
4
5
Make sure In the current document is selected.  
Enter a search term.  
To refine your search, check the boxes to select any of the following:  
Whole words only: By default, the search tool returns any words that  
contain your search term, even if the term is part of a longer word—  
for example, searching on app returns application also. Select this  
option if you want search results that match exactly the term you  
enter only.  
Case-Sensitive: By default, the search tool ignores the case of the  
term you enter—so entering email returns both email and Email.  
Select this option if you want search results that match the case of  
the term you enter only.  
Include Bookmarks/Include Comments: By default, the search tool  
searches document text only. Select either or both of these options to  
include bookmarks and/or comments in your search results.  
6
7
Click Search. A list of all instances of your term appears in the  
search window.  
Double-click an entry in the list to jump to that instance of the term in  
the User Guide.  
TIP Click Use Advanced Search Options at the bottom of the search window to  
access additional search features. With these options, you can enter a  
multi-word search term and then choose whether to search all, or any of, the  
words in the term. You can also choose to search on only part of a search term  
(known as “stemming”). So if you search on application, the search tool would  
return app also.  
214 E : Use Adobe search  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Graco Bouncy Seat PD162824A User Manual
Graco Inc Heat Pump 3A1450D User Manual
Graham Field Scale LF1007 User Manual
Harbor Freight Tools Pressure Washer 93889 User Manual
Heath Zenith Work Light SL 5656 User Manual
HP Hewlett Packard Photo Printer A430 User Manual
Huffy Fitness Equipment M881104 User Manual
Hypertec Computer Drive Z12658ZHY User Manual
Hyundai CRT Television H TV2910SPF User Manual
Impex Home Gym MWM 8150 User Manual